Insert version number and date into documentation at build time. Bug 1318.
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46
47 .set previousversion "4.80"
48 .include ./local_params
49
50 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
51 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
52
53
54 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
55 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
56 . provided in the xfpt library.
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58
59 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
60
61 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
62
63 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
64 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
65
66 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
67 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
68
69 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
70 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
71 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
72 . --- index entry.
73
74 .macro option
75 .arg 5
76 .oindex "&%$5%&"
77 .endarg
78 .arg -5
79 .oindex "&%$1%&"
80 .endarg
81 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
82 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
83 .endtable
84 .endmacro
85
86 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
87 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
88 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
89
90 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
91 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
92 .endmacro
93
94 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
95 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
96 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
97
98 .macro irow
99 .arg 4
100 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
101 .endarg
102 .arg -4
103 .arg 3
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -3
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
108 .endarg
109 .endarg
110 .endmacro
111
112 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
113 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
114 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
115 . --- ID that ties them together.
116
117 .macro cindex
118 &<indexterm role="concept">&
119 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
120 .arg 2
121 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
122 .endarg
123 &</indexterm>&
124 .endmacro
125
126 .macro scindex
127 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
128 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
129 .arg 3
130 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
131 .endarg
132 &</indexterm>&
133 .endmacro
134
135 .macro ecindex
136 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro oindex
140 &<indexterm role="option">&
141 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
142 .arg 2
143 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
144 .endarg
145 &</indexterm>&
146 .endmacro
147
148 .macro vindex
149 &<indexterm role="variable">&
150 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
151 .arg 2
152 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 .endarg
154 &</indexterm>&
155 .endmacro
156
157 .macro index
158 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
159 .endmacro
160 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
161
162
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
165 . output formats.
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167
168 .literal xml
169 <bookinfo>
170 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
171 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
172 <date>
173 .fulldate
174 </date>
175 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
176 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
177 <revhistory><revision>
178 <revnumber>
179 .version
180 </revnumber>
181 <date>
182 .fulldate
183 </date>
184 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
185 </revision></revhistory>
186 <copyright><year>
187 .year
188 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
189 </bookinfo>
190 .literal off
191
192
193 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
194 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
195 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
196 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
197 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198
199 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
200 .literal xml
201
202 <indexterm role="variable">
203 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
204 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 </indexterm>
206 <indexterm role="concept">
207 <primary>address</primary>
208 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
209 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 </indexterm>
211 <indexterm role="concept">
212 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
213 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 </indexterm>
215 <indexterm role="concept">
216 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
217 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 </indexterm>
219 <indexterm role="concept">
220 <primary>CR character</primary>
221 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 </indexterm>
223 <indexterm role="concept">
224 <primary>CRL</primary>
225 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 </indexterm>
227 <indexterm role="concept">
228 <primary>delivery</primary>
229 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
230 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 </indexterm>
232 <indexterm role="concept">
233 <primary>dialup</primary>
234 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 </indexterm>
236 <indexterm role="concept">
237 <primary>exiscan</primary>
238 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 </indexterm>
240 <indexterm role="concept">
241 <primary>failover</primary>
242 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 </indexterm>
244 <indexterm role="concept">
245 <primary>fallover</primary>
246 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 </indexterm>
248 <indexterm role="concept">
249 <primary>filter</primary>
250 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
251 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 </indexterm>
253 <indexterm role="concept">
254 <primary>ident</primary>
255 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 </indexterm>
257 <indexterm role="concept">
258 <primary>LF character</primary>
259 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 </indexterm>
261 <indexterm role="concept">
262 <primary>maximum</primary>
263 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 </indexterm>
265 <indexterm role="concept">
266 <primary>monitor</primary>
267 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 </indexterm>
269 <indexterm role="concept">
270 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
271 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 </indexterm>
273 <indexterm role="concept">
274 <primary>NUL</primary>
275 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 </indexterm>
277 <indexterm role="concept">
278 <primary>passwd file</primary>
279 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 </indexterm>
281 <indexterm role="concept">
282 <primary>process id</primary>
283 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 </indexterm>
285 <indexterm role="concept">
286 <primary>RBL</primary>
287 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 </indexterm>
289 <indexterm role="concept">
290 <primary>redirection</primary>
291 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 </indexterm>
293 <indexterm role="concept">
294 <primary>return path</primary>
295 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 </indexterm>
297 <indexterm role="concept">
298 <primary>scanning</primary>
299 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 </indexterm>
301 <indexterm role="concept">
302 <primary>SSL</primary>
303 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 </indexterm>
305 <indexterm role="concept">
306 <primary>string</primary>
307 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
308 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 </indexterm>
310 <indexterm role="concept">
311 <primary>top bit</primary>
312 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 </indexterm>
314 <indexterm role="concept">
315 <primary>variables</primary>
316 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 </indexterm>
318 <indexterm role="concept">
319 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
320 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
321 </indexterm>
322
323 .literal off
324
325
326 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
327 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
328 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
329 . chapter "Introduction"
330 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331
332 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
333 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
334 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
335 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336
337 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
338 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
339 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
340 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
341 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
342 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
343 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344
345 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
346 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
347 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348
349 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
350 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
351 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352
353 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
354 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
355 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
356 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
357 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358
359 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
360 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
361 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
362 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
363 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364
365 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
366 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
367 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
368 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
369 contributors.
370
371
372 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
373 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
374
375 .new
376 .cindex "documentation"
377 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
378 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
379 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
380 capable of showing a change indicator.
381 .wen
382
383 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
384 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
385 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
386 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
387 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
388 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
389 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
390 very wide interest.
391
392 .cindex "books about Exim"
393 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
394 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
395 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
396 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397
398 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
399 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
400 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
401 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402
403 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
404 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
405 Debian-specific features in the file
406 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
407 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
408 information.
409
410 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
411 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 .cindex "change log"
413 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
414 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
415 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
416 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
417 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418
419 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
420 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
421 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
422 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423
424 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
425 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426
427 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
428 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
429 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
430 directory are:
431
432 .table2 100pt
433 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
434 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
435 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
436 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
437 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
438 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
439 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458 .cindex "wiki"
459 .cindex "FAQ"
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466 .cindex Bugzilla
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477 .table2 140pt
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482 .endtable
483
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 via this web page:
490 .display
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 .endd
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 lists.
495
496 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
497 .cindex "training courses"
498 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
499 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
500 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
501 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502
503 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
504 .cindex "bug reports"
505 .cindex "reporting bugs"
506 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
507 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
508 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
509 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
510
511
512
513 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "FTP site"
515 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
516 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 .display
518 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
519 .endd
520 This is mirrored by
521 .display
522 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 .endd
524 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
525 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
526 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527
528 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
529 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
530 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
531 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
532 .display
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 .endd
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539
540 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
541 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
542 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
543 .new
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
549 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
554 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
555 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
556 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
557 .wen
558
559 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 .display
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563 .endd
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572 .display
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 .endd
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
580
581
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583 .ilist
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591 .next
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598 arrival.
599 .next
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608 .next
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612 other means.
613 .next
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
619 .endlist
620
621
622 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
656
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
665
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669 otherwise.
670
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674 until a later time.
675
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695 line.
696
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712 message's envelope.
713
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744 .cindex "PCRE"
745 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
746
747 .ilist
748 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
749 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
750 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
751 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
752 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
753 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
754 .next
755 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
756 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
757 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
758 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
759 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
760 following statements:
761
762 .blockquote
763 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
764
765 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
766 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
767 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
768 version.
769 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
770 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
771 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
772 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
773 restrictions applied to it).
774 .endblockquote
775 .next
776 .cindex "SPA authentication"
777 .cindex "Samba project"
778 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
779 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
780 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
781 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
782 under the Gnu GPL.
783 .next
784 .cindex "Cyrus"
785 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
786 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
787 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
788 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
789 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
790 conditions expressed therein.
791
792 .blockquote
793 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
794
795 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
796 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
797 are met:
798
799 .olist
800 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
801 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
802 .next
803 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
805 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
806 distribution.
807 .next
808 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
809 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
810 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
811 details, please contact
812 .display
813 Office of Technology Transfer
814 Carnegie Mellon University
815 5000 Forbes Avenue
816 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
817 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
818 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
819 .endd
820 .next
821 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
822 acknowledgment:
823
824 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
825 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
826
827 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
828 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
829 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
830 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
831 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
832 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
833 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
834 .endlist
835 .endblockquote
836
837 .next
838 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
839 .cindex "X-windows"
840 .cindex "Athena"
841 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
842 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
843 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
844 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
845
846 .blockquote
847 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
848 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
849
850 All Rights Reserved
851
852 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
853 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
854 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
855 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
856 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
857 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
858 software without specific, written prior permission.
859
860 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
861 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
862 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
863 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
864 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
865 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
866 SOFTWARE.
867 .endblockquote
868
869 .next
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873 .endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904 .ilist
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914 error code.
915 .next
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918 .next
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923 .next
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929 .next
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933 .next
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
937 .endlist
938
939
940
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
950
951 .ilist
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953 by RFC 3028.
954 .next
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957 .endlist
958
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
967 .cindex "base62"
968 .cindex "base36"
969 .cindex "Darwin"
970 .cindex "Cygwin"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
979
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986 somewhat eccentric:
987
988 .ilist
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
993 .next
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
996 .next
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998 .olist
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004 .next
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1008 .endlist
1009 .endlist
1010
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1025
1026 .ilist
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030 .next
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037 .next
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043 .next
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048 .endlist
1049
1050
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1103
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140 to be sent.
1141
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158 systems.
1159
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1198
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203 to be bounced.
1204
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222 configuration.
1223
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1233
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279 the following:
1280
1281 .ilist
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290 end of routing.
1291
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297 .next
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303 .next
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309 .next
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313 .next
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318 .next
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321 .endlist
1322
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355 .ilist
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366 address.
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification
1372 for this purpose.
1373 .next
1374 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1375 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1376 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1377 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1378 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1379 .next
1380 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1381 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1382 Again, cutthrough delibery counts as a verification.
1383 .next
1384 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1385 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1386 .next
1387 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1388 of domains that it defines.
1389 .next
1390 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1392 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1393 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1394 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1395 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1396 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1397 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1398 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1399 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1400 .next
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1403 .vindex "&$home$&"
1404 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1405 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1406 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1407 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1408 remaining preconditions.
1409 .next
1410 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1411 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1412 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1413 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1414 could lead to confusion.
1415 .next
1416 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1417 set of addresses that it defines.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1420 specified files is tested.
1421 .next
1422 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1423 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1424 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1425 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1426 .endlist
1427
1428
1429 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1430 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1431 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1432 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1433 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1434 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1435 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1436
1437
1438
1439 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1440 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1441 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1442
1443 .ilist
1444 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1445 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1446 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1447 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1448 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1449 filtering'&.
1450 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1451 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1452
1453 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1454 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1455 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1456 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1457 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1458 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1459 filter.
1460 .next
1461 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1462 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1463 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1464 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1465 processed entirely independently of each other.
1466 .next
1467 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1468 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1469 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1470 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1471 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1472 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1473 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1474 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1475 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1476 .next
1477 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1478 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1479 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1480 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1481 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1482 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1483 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1484 addresses to the same domain.
1485 .next
1486 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1487 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1488 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1489 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1490 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1491 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1492 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1493 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1494 .next
1495 .cindex "queue runner"
1496 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1497 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1498 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1499 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1500 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1501 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1502 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1503 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1504 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1505 .next
1506 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1507 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1508 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1509 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1510 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1511 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1512 .next
1513 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1514 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1515 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1516 messages to other addresses.
1517 .next
1518 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1519 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1520 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1521 &'deferred'&.
1522 .next
1523 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1524 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1525 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1526 .endlist
1527
1528
1529
1530
1531 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1533 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1534 .cindex "queue runner"
1535 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1536 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1537 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1538 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1539 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1540 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1541 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1542 passed its retry time.
1543 You can run several queue runners at once.
1544
1545 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1546 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1547 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1548 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1549 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1550 as permanent.
1551
1552
1553
1554 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1555 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1556 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1557 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1558 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1559 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1560 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1561 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1562 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1563 also apply.
1564
1565 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1566 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1567 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1568 deferred,
1569 .cindex "hints database"
1570 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1571 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1572 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1573 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1574 one connection.
1575
1576
1577
1578 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1579 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1580 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1581 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1582 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1583 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1584 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1585 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1586 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1587 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1588 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1589
1590 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1591 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1592 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1593 automatically.
1594
1595 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1596 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1597 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1598 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1599 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1600 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1601 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1602 of the list.
1603
1604
1605
1606 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1607 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1608 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1609 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1610 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1611 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1612 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1613 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1621
1622 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1623 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1624
1625 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1626 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1627 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1628 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1629
1630 .table2 140pt
1631 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1632 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1633 documented"
1634 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1635 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1636 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1637 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1638 instructions"
1639 .endtable
1640
1641 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1642 following subdirectories are created:
1643
1644 .table2 140pt
1645 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1646 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1647 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1648 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1649 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1650 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1651 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1652 .endtable
1653
1654 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1655 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1656 that may be useful to some sites.
1657
1658
1659 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1660 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1661 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1662 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1663 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1664 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1665 system.
1666 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1667 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1668 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1669 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1670 overridden if necessary.
1671
1672
1673 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1674 .cindex "PCRE library"
1675 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1676 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1677 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1678 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1679 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1680 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1681 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1682 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1683 If your operating system has no
1684 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1685 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1686 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1687
1688 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1689 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1690 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1691 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1692 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1693 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1694 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1695
1696 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1697 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1698 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1700 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1701 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1702 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1703 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1704
1705 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1706 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1707 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1708 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1709 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1710 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1711 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1712 Berkeley DB library.
1713
1714 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1715 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1716 possibilities:
1717
1718 .olist
1719 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1720 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1721 .next
1722 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1723 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1724 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1725 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1726 file name is used unmodified.
1727 .next
1728 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1729 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1730 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1731 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1732 .next
1733 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1734 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1735 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1736 .next
1737 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1738 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1739 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1740 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1741 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1742 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1743 .next
1744 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1745 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1746 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1747 operates on a single file.
1748 .endlist
1749
1750 .cindex "USE_DB"
1751 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1752 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1753 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1754 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1755 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1756 .code
1757 USE_DB=yes
1758 .endd
1759 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1760 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1761
1762 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1763 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1764 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1765 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1766 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1767 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1768
1769 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1770 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1771 in one of these lines:
1772 .code
1773 DBMLIB = -ldb
1774 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1775 .endd
1776 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1777 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1778 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1779 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1780 this example:
1781 .code
1782 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1783 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1784 .endd
1785 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1786 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1787
1788
1789
1790 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1791 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1792 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1793 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1794 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1795 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1796 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1797 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1798 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1799 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1800 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1801 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1802
1803 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1804 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1805 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1806 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1807 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1808 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1809
1810 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1811 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1812 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1813 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1814 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1815 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1816 be logged.
1817
1818 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1819 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1820 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1821 facilities, you need to set
1822 .code
1823 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1824 .endd
1825 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1826 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1827
1828
1829 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1830 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1831 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1832 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1833 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1834 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1835 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1836
1837 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1838 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1839 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1840 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1841 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1842 do this.
1843
1844
1845
1846 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1847 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1848 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1849 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1850 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1851 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1852 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1853 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1854 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1855 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1856
1857 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1858 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1859 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1860 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1861 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1862 .code
1863 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1864 .endd
1865 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1866
1867
1868
1869 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1870 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1871 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1872 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1873 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1874 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1875 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1876 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1877 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1878 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1879 line option).
1880
1881 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1882 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1883 implementing SSL.
1884
1885 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1886 .code
1887 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1888 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1889 .endd
1890 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1891 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1892 .code
1893 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1894 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1895 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1896 .endd
1897 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1898 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1899 .code
1900 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1901 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1902 .endd
1903 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1904 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1905 .code
1906 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1907 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1908 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1909 .endd
1910 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1911 library and include files. For example:
1912 .code
1913 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1914 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1915 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1916 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1917 .endd
1918 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1919 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1920 .code
1921 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1922 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1924 .endd
1925
1926 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1927 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1928 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1929
1930
1931
1932
1933 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1934
1935 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1936 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1937 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1938 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1939 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1940 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1941 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1942 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1943 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1944 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1945 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1946 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1947 you might have
1948 .code
1949 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1950 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1951 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1952 .endd
1953 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1954 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1955 .code
1956 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1957 .endd
1958 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1959 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1960 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1961 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1962 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1963 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1964 further details.
1965
1966
1967 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1968 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1969 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1970 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1971 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1972 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1973 library files.
1974
1975 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1976 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1977 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1978 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1979 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1980 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1981 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1982 support has not been tested for some time.
1983
1984
1985
1986 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1987 .cindex "lookup modules"
1988 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1989 .cindex ".so building"
1990 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1991 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1992 on demand.
1993 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1994 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1995 dependencies.
1996 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1997
1998 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1999 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2000 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2001 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2002 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2003 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2004
2005 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2006 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2007 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2008 on demand:
2009 .code
2010 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2011 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2012 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2013 .endd
2014
2015
2016 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2017 .cindex "build directory"
2018 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2019 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2020 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2021 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2022 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2023 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2024 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2025
2026 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2027 building process fails if it is set.
2028
2029 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2030 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2031 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2032 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2033 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2034 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2035 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2036 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2037
2038 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2039 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2040 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2041
2042
2043
2044 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2045 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2046 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2047 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2048 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2049 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2050 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2051 .code
2052 FULLECHO='' make -e
2053 .endd
2054 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2055 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2056 given in addition to the short output.
2057
2058
2059
2060 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2061 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2062 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2063 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2064 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2065 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2066 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2067 order:
2068 .display
2069 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2070 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2071 &_Local/Makefile_&
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2076 .endd
2077 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2079 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2080 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2081 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2082 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2083 and are often not needed.
2084
2085 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2086 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2087 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2088 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2089 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2090 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2091 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2092 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2093 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2094
2095
2096 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2097 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2098 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2099 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2100 default values are.
2101
2102
2103 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2104 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2105 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2106 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2107 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2108 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2109 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2110 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2111 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2112 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2113 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2114 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2115 containing the lines
2116 .code
2117 CC=cc
2118 CFLAGS=-std1
2119 .endd
2120 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2121 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2122
2123 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2124 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2125 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2126
2127
2128 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2131 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2132 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2133 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2134 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2135 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2136 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2137 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2138 .code
2139 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2140 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2141 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2142 .endd
2143 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2144 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2145 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2146 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2147 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2148 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2149 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2150 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2151 errors.
2152
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2154 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2155 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2156 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2157 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2158 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2159 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2160 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2161 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2162 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2163 syntax. For instance:
2164 .code
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2166 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2167 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2168 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2170 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2171 .endd
2172
2173 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2174 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2175 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2176 .code
2177 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2178 .endd
2179 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2180 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2181
2182 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2183 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2184 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2185 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2186 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2187 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2188 .code
2189 X11=/usr/X11R6
2190 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2191 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2192 .endd
2193 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2194 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2195 .code
2196 X11=/usr/openwin
2197 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2198 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2199 .endd
2200 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2201 definition of all three of these variables into your
2202 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2203
2204 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2205 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2206 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2207 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2208 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2209
2210 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2211 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2212 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2213 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2214 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2215 libraries.
2216
2217 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2218 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2219 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2220 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2221 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2222
2223
2224 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2225 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2226 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2227 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2228 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2229 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2230 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2231 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2232
2233
2234
2235 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2236 .cindex "building Eximon"
2237 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2238 where the files that are involved are
2239 .display
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2241 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2245 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2246 .endd
2247 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2248 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2251 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2252 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2253 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2254 .ecindex IIDbuex
2255
2256
2257 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2258 .cindex "installing Exim"
2259 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2260 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2261 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2262 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2263 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2264 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2265 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2266 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2267 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2268 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2269 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2270 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2271
2272 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2273 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2274 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2275 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2276 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2277 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2278 alternative files, no default is installed.
2279
2280 .cindex "system aliases file"
2281 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2282 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2283 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2284 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2285 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2286 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2287 and outputs a comment to the user.
2288
2289 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2290 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2291 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2292 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2293 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2294
2295 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2296 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2297 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2298 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2299 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2300 over SMTP.
2301
2302 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2303 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2304 command such as
2305 .code
2306 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2307 .endd
2308 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2309 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2310 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2311 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2312 but this usage is deprecated.
2313
2314 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2315 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2316 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2317 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2318 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2319 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2320
2321 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2322 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2323 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2324 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2325 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2326 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2327 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2328
2329 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2330 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2331 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2332 command:
2333 .code
2334 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2335 .endd
2336 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2337 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2338 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2339 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2340 command:
2341 .code
2342 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2343 .endd
2344 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2345 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2346
2347 .ilist
2348 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2349 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2350 .next
2351 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2352 installed binary.
2353 .endlist
2354
2355 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2356 .code
2357 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2358 .endd
2359 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2360 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2361 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2364 .endd
2365
2366
2367
2368 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2369 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2370 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2371 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2372 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2373 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2374
2375 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2376 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2377 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2378
2379
2380
2381 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2382 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2383 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2384 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2385 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2386 necessary.
2387
2388
2389
2390
2391 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2392 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2393 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2394 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2395 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2396 .code
2397 exim -bV
2398 .endd
2399 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2400 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2401 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2402 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2403 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2404 example,
2405 .display
2406 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2407 .endd
2408 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2409 .display
2410 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2411 .endd
2412 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2413 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2414 user agent. For example:
2415 .code
2416 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2417 From: user@your.domain.example
2418 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2419 Subject: Testing Exim
2420
2421 This is a test message.
2422 ^D
2423 .endd
2424 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2425 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2426 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2427
2428 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2429 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2430 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2431 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2432 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2433 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2434 .display
2435 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2436 .endd
2437 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2438 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2439 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2440 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2441 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2442
2443 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2444 .cindex "lock files"
2445 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2446 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2447 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2448 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2449 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2450 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2451 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2452 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2453 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2454 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2455 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2456 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2457
2458 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2459 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2460 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2461 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2462 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2463 incoming SMTP mail.
2464
2465 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2466 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2467 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2468 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2469 production version.
2470
2471
2472 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2473 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2474 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2475 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2476 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2477 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2478 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2479 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2480 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2481 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2482 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2483 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2484 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2485
2486 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2487 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2488 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2489 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2490 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2491 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2492 as follows:
2493 .code
2494 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2496 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2497 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2498 .endd
2499 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2500 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2501 favourite user agent.
2502
2503 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2504 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2505 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2506 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2507 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2508 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2509
2510
2511
2512 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2513 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2514 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2515 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2516 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2517 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2518 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2519 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2520 configuration file.
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2526 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2527 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2528 .code
2529 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2530 .endd
2531 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2532 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2533 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2534 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2535 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2536 .code
2537 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2538 .endd
2539 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2540
2541 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2542 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2543 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2544
2545
2546
2547
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2550
2551 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2552 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2553 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2554 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2555 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2556 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2557 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2558 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2559 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2560
2561
2562 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2563 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2564 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2565 were present before any other options.
2566 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2567 standard output.
2568 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2569 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2570 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2571
2572 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2574 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2575 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2576 format.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2580 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2581 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2582
2583 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2584 .cindex "queue runner"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2586 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2587 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2590 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2591 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2592 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2593 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2594 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2595 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2596 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2597
2598
2599 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2600 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2601 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2602 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2603 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2604 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2605
2606 .ilist
2607 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2608 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2609 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2610 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2611 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2612 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2613
2614 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2615 .cindex "envelope sender"
2616 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2617 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2618 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2619 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2620 users to set envelope senders.
2621
2622 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2624 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2625 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2626 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2627
2628 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2629 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2630 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2631 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2632 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2633 that are available to trusted users.
2634 .next
2635 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2636 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2637 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2638 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2639 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2640
2641 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2642 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2643 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2644 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2645
2646 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2647 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2648 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2649 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2650
2651 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2652 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2653 false.
2654 .endlist
2655
2656
2657 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2658 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2659 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2660 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2666 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2667 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2668 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2669 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2670 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2671 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2672 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2673
2674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2675 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2676 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2677 . creates a man page for the options.
2678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2679
2680 .literal xml
2681 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2682 .literal off
2683
2684
2685 .vlist
2686 .vitem &%--%&
2687 .oindex "--"
2688 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2689 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2690 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2691 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2692
2693 .vitem &%--help%&
2694 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2695 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2696 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2697 no arguments.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--version%&
2700 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2701 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2702 displayed.
2703
2704 .new
2705 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2706 &%-Am%&
2707 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2708 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2710 ignored by Exim.
2711 .wen
2712
2713 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2714 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2715 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2716 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2717 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2718 clean; it ignores this option.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-bd%&
2721 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2722 .cindex "daemon"
2723 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2724 .cindex "queue runner"
2725 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2726 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2727 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2728
2729 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2730 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2731 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2732 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2733
2734 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2735 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2736 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2737 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2738
2739 When a listening daemon
2740 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2741 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2742 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2743 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2744 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2745 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2746 running as root.
2747
2748 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2749 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2750 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2751
2752 The SIGHUP signal
2753 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2754 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2755 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2756 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2757 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2758 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2759 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2760 because these are reread each time they are used.
2761
2762 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2763 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2764 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2765 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2766
2767 .vitem &%-be%&
2768 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2769 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2770 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2771 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2772 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2773 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2774 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2775
2776 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2777 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2778 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2779 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2780 test data. A line history is supported.
2781
2782 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2783 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2784 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2785 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2786 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2787 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2788 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2789
2790 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2791 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2792 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2793 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2794
2795 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2796 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2797 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2798 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2799 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2800 of a file. For example:
2801 .code
2802 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2803 .endd
2804 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2805 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2806 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2807 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2808 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2809 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2810 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2811 &%-be%&).
2812
2813 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2814 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2815 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2816 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2817 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2818 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2819 system filters are recognized.
2820
2821 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2822 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2823 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2824 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2825 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2826 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2827 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2828 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2829 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2830 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2831 supplied.
2832
2833 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2834 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2835 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2836 .code
2837 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2838 .endd
2839 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2840 variables that are used by the user filter.
2841
2842 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2843 .code
2844 # Exim filter
2845 # Sieve filter
2846 .endd
2847 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2848 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2849 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2850 redirection lists.
2851
2852 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2853 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2854 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2855 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2856
2857 When testing a filter file,
2858 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2859 .cindex "envelope sender"
2860 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2861 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2862 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2863 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2864 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2865 options).
2866
2867 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2868 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2869 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2870 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2871 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2872 &$qualify_domain$&.
2873
2874 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2875 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2876 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2877 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2878 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2879 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2880 actually being delivered.
2881
2882 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2883 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2884 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2885 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2886 prefix.
2887
2888 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2889 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2890 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2891 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 suffix.
2893
2894 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2895 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2896 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2897 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2898 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2899 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2900 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2901 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2902 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2903 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2904 after a full stop. For example:
2905 .code
2906 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2907 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2908 .endd
2909 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2910 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2911 conversion to the canonical form is
2912 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2913
2914 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2915 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2916 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2917 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2918 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2919
2920 &*Warning 1*&:
2921 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2922 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2923 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2924 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2925 connection.
2926
2927 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2928 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2929 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2930
2931 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2932 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2933 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2934 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2935 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2936 session were authenticated.
2937
2938 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2939 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2940 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2941
2942 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2943 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2944 specialized SMTP test program such as
2945 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2946
2947 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2948 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2949 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2950 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2951 updating the callout cache database.
2952
2953 .vitem &%-bi%&
2954 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2955 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2956 .cindex "building alias file"
2957 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2958 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2959 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2960 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2961 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2962 recognized.
2963
2964 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2965 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2966 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2967 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2968 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2969 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2970 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2971
2972 .new
2973 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2974 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2975 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2976 .cindex "querying exim information"
2977 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2978 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2979 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2980 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2981 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2982
2983 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2984 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2985 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2986 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2987 recognised DSCP names.
2988
2989 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2991 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2993 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2994 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2995 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2996 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2997 way to guarantee a correct response.
2998 .wen
2999
3000 .vitem &%-bm%&
3001 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3002 .cindex "local message reception"
3003 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3004 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3005 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3006 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3007 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3008 if no other conflicting option is present.
3009
3010 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3011 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3012 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3013 suppressing this for special cases.
3014
3015 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3016 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3017
3018 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3019 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3020 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3021
3022 The format
3023 .cindex "message" "format"
3024 .cindex "format" "message"
3025 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3026 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3027 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3028 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3029 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3030 .code
3031 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3032 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3033 .endd
3034 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3035 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3036 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3037 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3038 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3039
3040 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3041 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3042 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3043 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3044 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3045
3046 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3047 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3048 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3049 .cindex "malware scan test"
3050 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3051 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3052 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3053 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3054 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3055 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3056
3057 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3058 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3059 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3060 This option requires admin privileges.
3061
3062 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3063 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3064 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3065
3066 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3067 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3068 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3069 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3070 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3071 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3072 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3073 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3074 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3075
3076 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3077 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3078 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3079 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3080 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3081
3082 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3083 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3084 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3085 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3086
3087
3088 .vitem &%-bP%&
3089 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3090 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3091 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3092 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3093 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3094 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3095 arguments, for example:
3096 .code
3097 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3098 .endd
3099 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3100 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3101 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3102 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3103 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3104 users, the output is as in this example:
3105 .code
3106 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3107 .endd
3108 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3109 configuration file is output.
3110 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3111 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3112
3113 .new
3114 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3115 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3116 name will not be output.
3117 .wen
3118
3119 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3120 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3121 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3122 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3123 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3124 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3125 written directly into the spool directory.
3126
3127 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3128 .code
3129 exim -bP +local_domains
3130 .endd
3131 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3132 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3133
3134 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3135 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3136 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3137 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3138 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3139 that driver are output. For example:
3140 .code
3141 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3142 .endd
3143 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3144 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3145 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3146 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3147 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3148 &%authenticators%&.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3151 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3152 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3153 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3154 The output format is one item per line.
3155
3156 .vitem &%-bp%&
3157 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3158 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3159 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3160 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3161 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3162 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3163 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3164 to allow any user to see the queue.
3165
3166 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3167 .code
3168 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3169 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3170 <other addresses>
3171 .endd
3172 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3173 .cindex "size" "of message"
3174 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3175 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3176 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3177 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3178 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3179 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3180 before the sender address.
3181
3182 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3183 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3184 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3185
3186 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3187 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3188 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3189 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3190 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3191 complete.
3192
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3196 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3197 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3198 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3199 of just &"D"&.
3200
3201
3202 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3203 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3204 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3205 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3206 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3207 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3208
3209
3210 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3211 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3212 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3213 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3214 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3215 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3216
3217 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3218 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3219 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3224
3225
3226 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3227 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3228 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3229 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3230 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3231 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3232
3233
3234 .vitem &%-brt%&
3235 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3236 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3237 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3238 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3239 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3240 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3241 .code
3242 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3243 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3244 .endd
3245 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3246 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3247 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3248 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3249 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3250 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3251 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3252 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3253 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3254 .code
3255 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3256 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3257 .endd
3258
3259 .vitem &%-brw%&
3260 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3261 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3262 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3263 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3264 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3265 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3266 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3267 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3268
3269 .vitem &%-bS%&
3270 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3271 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3272 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3273 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3274 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3275 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3276 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3277 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3278 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3279 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3280
3281 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3282 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3283 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3284
3285 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3286 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3287 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3288 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3289
3290 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3291 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3292 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3293
3294 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3295 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3296 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3297 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3298 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3299
3300 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3301 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3302
3303 .vitem &%-bs%&
3304 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3305 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3306 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3307 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3308 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3309 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3310 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3311 messages to the MTA.
3312
3313 In
3314 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3315 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3316 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3317 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3318 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3319 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3320 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3321
3322 .cindex "inetd"
3323 The
3324 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3325 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3326 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3327 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3328 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3329 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3330 the listening daemon.
3331
3332 .vitem &%-bt%&
3333 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3334 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3335 .cindex "address" "testing"
3336 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3337 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3338 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3339 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3340 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3341
3342 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3343 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3344
3345 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3346 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3347 security issues.
3348
3349 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3350 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3351 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3352 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3353 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3354 program.
3355
3356 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3357 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3358 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3359 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3360
3361 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3362 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3363 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3364 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3365 always shown.
3366
3367 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3368 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3369 message,
3370 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3371 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3372 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3373 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3374 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3375 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3376 doing such tests.
3377
3378 .vitem &%-bV%&
3379 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3380 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3381 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3382 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3383 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3384 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3385 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3386
3387 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3388 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3389 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3390 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3391 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3392 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3393 dynamic testing facilities.
3394
3395 .vitem &%-bv%&
3396 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3397 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3398 .cindex "address" "verification"
3399 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3400 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3401 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3402 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3403 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3404 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3405
3406 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3407 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3408 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3409
3410 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3411 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3412
3413 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3414 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3415 security issues.
3416
3417 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3418 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3419 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3420 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3421 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3422
3423 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3424 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3425 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3426 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3427 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3428 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3429 to succeed.
3430
3431 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3432 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3433 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3434
3435 The
3436 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3437 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3438 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3439 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3440
3441 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3442 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3443 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3444 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3445
3446 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3447 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3448 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3449 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3450 might happen.
3451
3452 .vitem &%-bw%&
3453 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3454 .cindex "daemon"
3455 .cindex "inetd"
3456 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3457 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3458 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3459 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3460
3461 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3462 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3463 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3464 each port only when the first connection is received.
3465
3466 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3467 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3468
3469 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3470 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3471 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3472 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3473 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3474 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3475 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3476 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3477 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3478 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3479 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3480
3481 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3482 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3483 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3484 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3485 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3486 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3487 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3488 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3489 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3490
3491 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3492 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3493 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3494 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3495 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3496 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3497 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3498
3499 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3500 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3501 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3502 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3503 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3504 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3505 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3506
3507 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3508 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3509 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3510 configuration file.
3511
3512 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3513 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3514 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3515 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3516 specified by this option.
3517
3518
3519 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3520 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3521 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3522 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3523 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3524 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3525 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3526 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3527
3528 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3529 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3530 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3531 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3532 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3533 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3534 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3535
3536 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3537 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3538 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3539 synonymous:
3540 .code
3541 exim -DABC ...
3542 exim -DABC= ...
3543 .endd
3544 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3545 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3546 example:
3547 .code
3548 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3549 .endd
3550 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3551
3552
3553 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3554 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3555 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3556 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3557 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3558 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3559 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3560 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3561 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3562 return code.
3563
3564 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3565 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3566 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3567 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3568 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3569 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3570 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3571 are:
3572 .display
3573 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3574 &`auth `& authenticators
3575 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3576 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3577 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3578 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3579 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3580 &`filter `& filter handling
3581 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3582 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3583 &`ident `& ident lookup
3584 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3585 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3586 &`load `& system load checks
3587 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3588 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3589 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3590 &`memory `& memory handling
3591 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3592 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3593 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3594 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3595 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3596 &`retry `& retry handling
3597 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3598 &`route `& address routing
3599 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3600 &`tls `& TLS logic
3601 &`transport `& transports
3602 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3603 &`verify `& address verification logic
3604 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3605 .endd
3606 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3607 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3608 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3609 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3610 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3611 turn everything off.
3612
3613 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3614 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3615 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3616 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3617 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3618 rather than stderr.
3619
3620 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3621 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3622 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3623 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3624 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3625 run in parallel.
3626
3627 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3628 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3629 in processing.
3630
3631 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3632 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3633
3634 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3635 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3636 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3637 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3638 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3639 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3642 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3643 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3644 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3645 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3646
3647 .vitem &%-E%&
3648 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3649 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3650 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3651 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3652 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3653 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3654 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3655 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3656 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3659 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3660 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3661 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3662 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3663 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3666 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3667 .cindex "sender" "name"
3668 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3669 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3670 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3671 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3672 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3673 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3674
3675 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3676 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3677 .cindex "sender" "address"
3678 .cindex "address" "sender"
3679 .cindex "trusted users"
3680 .cindex "envelope sender"
3681 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3682 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3683 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3684 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3685 users to use it.
3686
3687 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3688 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3689 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3690 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3691 domain.
3692
3693 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3694 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3695 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3696 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3697 examples of shell commands:
3698 .code
3699 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3700 exim -f "" user@domain
3701 .endd
3702 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3703 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3704 &%-bv%& options.
3705
3706 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3707 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3708 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3709 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3710
3711 White
3712 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3713 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3714 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3715 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3716 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3717 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3718
3719 .vitem &%-G%&
3720 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3721 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3722 .new
3723 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3724 .code
3725 control = suppress_local_fixups
3726 .endd
3727 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3728 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3729 in future.
3730
3731 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3732 this option.
3733 .wen
3734
3735 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3736 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3738 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3739 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3740 headers.)
3741
3742 .vitem &%-i%&
3743 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3744 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3745 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3746 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3747 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3748 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3749 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3750
3751 .new
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762 .wen
3763
3764 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3765 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3766 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3767 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3768 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3769 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3770 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3771 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3772 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3773
3774 Retry
3775 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3776 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3777 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3778 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3779 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3780 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3781
3782 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3783 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3784 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3785 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3786
3787 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3788 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3789 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3790 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3791 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3792 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3793 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3794 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3795 can be used only by an admin user.
3796
3797 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3798 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3799 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3801 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3802 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3803 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3804 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3805 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3806 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3807 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3808
3809 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3810 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3811 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3812 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3813 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3814
3815 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3816 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3817 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3818 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3819 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3820
3821 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3822 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3823 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3825 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3826 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3827 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3828 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3829
3830 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3831 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3832 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3833 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3834 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3835 connection.
3836
3837 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3838 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3839 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3840 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3841 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3842
3843 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3844 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3845 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3846 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3847 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3848 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3849 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3850 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3851 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3852 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3853 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3854 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3855 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3856 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3857 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3860 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3861 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3862 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3863 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3864 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3865 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3866 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3867 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3868 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3869
3870 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3871 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3872 .cindex "freezing messages"
3873 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3874 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3875 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3876 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3877 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3878 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3879 user.
3880
3881 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3882 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3883 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3884 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3885 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3886 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3887 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3888 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3889 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3890 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3891 user.
3892
3893 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3894 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3895 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3896 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3897 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3898 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3899 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3900
3901 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3902 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3903 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3904 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3905 .cindex "removing recipients"
3906 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3907 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3908 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3909 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3910 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3911 can be used only by an admin user.
3912
3913 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3915 .cindex "removing messages"
3916 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3917 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3918 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3919 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3920 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3921 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3922 placed on the queue.
3923
3924 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3925 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3926 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3927 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3928 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3929 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3930 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3931 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3932 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3933 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3934 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3935
3936 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3937 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3938 .cindex "thawing messages"
3939 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3940 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3941 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3942 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3943 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3944 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3945 by an admin user.
3946
3947 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3948 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3949 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3950 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3951 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3952 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3953
3954 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3955 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3956 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3957 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3958 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3959 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3960 only by an admin user.
3961
3962 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3963 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3964 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3965 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3966 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3967 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3968 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969
3970 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3971 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3972 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3973 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3974 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3975 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3976
3977 .vitem &%-m%&
3978 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3979 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3980 treats it that way too.
3981
3982 .vitem &%-N%&
3983 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3984 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3985 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3986 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3987 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3988 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3989 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3990 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3991 than &"=>"&.
3992
3993 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3994 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3995 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3996 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3997 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3998 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3999 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4000 for that message.
4001
4002 .vitem &%-n%&
4003 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4004 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4005 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4006 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4007
4008 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4009 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4010 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4011 Exim.
4012
4013 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4014 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4015 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4016 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4017 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4018 description above.
4019
4020 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4021 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4022 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4023 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4024 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4025 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4026 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4027 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4028
4029 .vitem &%-odb%&
4030 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4031 .cindex "background delivery"
4032 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4033 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4034 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4035 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4036 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4037 processes to finish.
4038
4039 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4040 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4041 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4042 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4043
4044 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4045 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4046 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4047 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4048
4049 .vitem &%-odf%&
4050 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4051 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4052 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4053 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4054 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4055 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4056 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4057
4058 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4059 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4060 during deliveries.
4061
4062 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4063 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4064
4065 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4066 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4067 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4068 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4069
4070
4071 .vitem &%-odi%&
4072 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4073 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4074 Sendmail.
4075
4076 .vitem &%-odq%&
4077 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4078 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4079 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4080 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4081 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4082 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4083 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4084 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4085 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4086 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4087 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4088 forces queueing.
4089
4090 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4091 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4092 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4093 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4094 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4095 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4096 configuration file is in effect.
4097
4098 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4099 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4100 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4101 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4102 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4103 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4104 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4105 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4106 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4107 &%-qq%& option.
4108
4109 .vitem &%-oee%&
4110 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4111 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4112 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4113 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4114 message.
4115
4116 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4117 Provided
4118 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4119 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4120 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4121 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4122
4123 .vitem &%-oem%&
4124 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4125 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4126 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4127 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4128 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4129 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4130
4131 .vitem &%-oep%&
4132 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4133 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4134 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4135 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4136 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4137 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4138
4139 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4140 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4141 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4142 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4143 effect as &%-oep%&.
4144
4145 .vitem &%-oew%&
4146 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4147 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4148 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4149 effect as &%-oem%&.
4150
4151 .vitem &%-oi%&
4152 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4153 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4154 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4155 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4156 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4157 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4158 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4162 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4163
4164 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4165 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4166 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4167 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4168 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4169 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4170 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4171 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4172
4173 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4174 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4175 .code
4176 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4177 .endd
4178 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4179 followed by a colon and the port number:
4180 .code
4181 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4182 .endd
4183 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4184 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4185 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4186 whichever one is last.
4187
4188 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4189 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4190 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4191 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4192 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4193 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4194 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4195 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4199 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4200 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4201 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4202 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4203 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4204 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4205
4206 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4207 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4208 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4209 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4210 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4211 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4212 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4213 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4214 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4215 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4216
4217 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4218 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4219 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4220 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4221 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4222 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4223 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4224
4225 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4226 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4227 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4228 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4229 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4230 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4231 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4232 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4233 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4234 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4235 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4236 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4237
4238 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4239 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4240 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4241 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4242 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4243 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4244 uses the name it is given.
4245
4246 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4247 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4248 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4249 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4250 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4251 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4252 used, when there is no default.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-om%&
4255 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4256 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4257 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4258 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4259 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4260
4261 .vitem &%-oo%&
4262 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4263 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4264 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4265 whatever that means.
4266
4267 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4268 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4269 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4270 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4271 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4272 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4273 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4274 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4275 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4278 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4279 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4280 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4281 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4282 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4283 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4284
4285 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4286 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4287 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4288 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4289 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4290 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4291 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4292 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4293
4294 .vitem &%-ov%&
4295 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4296 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4297
4298 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4299 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4300 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4301 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4302 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4303 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4304 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4305 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4306 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4307 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4308
4309 .vitem &%-pd%&
4310 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4311 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4312 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4313 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4314 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4315 needed.
4316
4317 .vitem &%-ps%&
4318 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4319 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4320 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4321 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4322 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4323 started.
4324
4325 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4326 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4327 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4328 .display
4329 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4330 .endd
4331 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4332 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4333 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4334 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4335 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4336
4337 .vitem &%-q%&
4338 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4339 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4340 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4341 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4342 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4343 and &%-S%& options).
4344
4345 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4346 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4347 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4348 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4349 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4350 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4351
4352 If
4353 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4354 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4355 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4356 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4357 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4358 proceeding.
4359
4360 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4361 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4362 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4363 this to be repeated periodically.
4364
4365 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4366 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4367 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4368 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4369
4370 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4371 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4372 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4373
4374 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4375 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4376 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4377 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4378
4379 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4380 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4381 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4382 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4383 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4384 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4385 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4386 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4387 transports are run.
4388
4389 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4390 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4391 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4392 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4393 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4394 delivered down a single SMTP
4395 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4396 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4397 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4398 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4399 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4400 intermittently.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4403 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4404 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4405 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4406 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4407 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4408 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4409
4410 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4411 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4412 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4413 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4414 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4415 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4416 their retry times are tried.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4419 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4420 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4421 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4422 frozen or not.
4423
4424 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4425 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4426 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4427 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4428 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4429 for later delivery.
4430
4431 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4432 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4433 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4434 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4435 starting message id. For example:
4436 .code
4437 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4438 .endd
4439 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4440 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4441 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4442 .code
4443 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4444 .endd
4445 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4446 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4447 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4448 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4449 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4450 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4451
4452 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4453 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4454 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4455 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4456 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4457 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4458 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4459 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4460 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4461 .code
4462 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4463 .endd
4464 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4465 process every 30 minutes.
4466
4467 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4468 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4469
4470 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4471 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4472 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4473 compatibility.
4474
4475 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4476 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4477 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4478
4479 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4480 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4481 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4482 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4483 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4484 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4485 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4486 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4487 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4488
4489 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4490 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4491 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4492 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4493 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4494 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4495
4496 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4497 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4498 .code
4499 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4500 .endd
4501 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4502 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4503 applied to each queue run.
4504
4505 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4506 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4507 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4508 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4509 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4510 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4511 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4512 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4513 address will be skipped.
4514
4515 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4516 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4517 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4518 &'ff'& is present.
4519
4520 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4521 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4522 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4523 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4524 an arbitrary command instead.
4525
4526 .vitem &%-r%&
4527 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4528 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4529
4530 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4531 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4532 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4533 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4534 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4535 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4536 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4537 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4538
4539 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4540 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4541 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4542 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4543 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4544
4545 .vitem &%-t%&
4546 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4547 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4548 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4549 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4550 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4551 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4552 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4553 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4554 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4555 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4556
4557 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4558 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4559 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4560 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4561 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4562 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4563 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4564 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4565 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4566 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4567 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4568
4569 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4570 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4571 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4572 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4573 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4574 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4575
4576 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4577 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4578 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4579 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4580 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4581 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4582 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4583 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4584 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4585
4586 .vitem &%-ti%&
4587 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4588 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4589 compatibility with Sendmail.
4590
4591 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4592 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4593 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4594 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4595 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4596 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4597 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4598 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4599
4600
4601 .vitem &%-U%&
4602 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4603 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4604 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4605 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4606 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4607 set. Exim ignores this option.
4608
4609 .vitem &%-v%&
4610 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4611 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4612 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4613 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4614 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4615 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4616 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4617 unconditional.
4618
4619 .vitem &%-x%&
4620 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4621 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4622 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4623 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4624 this option.
4625
4626 .new
4627 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4628 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4629 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4630 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4631 .wen
4632 .endlist
4633
4634 .ecindex IIDclo1
4635 .ecindex IIDclo2
4636
4637
4638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4639 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4640 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4641 . creates a man page for the options.
4642 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4643
4644 .literal xml
4645 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4646 .literal off
4647
4648
4649
4650
4651
4652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4654
4655
4656 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4657 "The runtime configuration file"
4658
4659 .cindex "run time configuration"
4660 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4661 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4662 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4663 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4664 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4665 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4666 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4667 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4668 control.
4669
4670 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4671 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4672 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4673 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4674 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4675 actually alter the string.
4676
4677 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4678 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4679 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4680 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4681 existing file in the list.
4682
4683 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4684 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4685 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4686 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4687 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4688 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4689 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4690 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4691 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4692 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4693 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4694
4695 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4696 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4697 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4698 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4699 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4700
4701 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4702 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4703 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4704 compromise the Exim user account.
4705
4706 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4707 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4708 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4709 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4710 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4711 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4712 configuration.
4713
4714
4715
4716 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4717 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4718 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4719 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4720 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4721 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4722 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4723 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4724 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4725 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4726 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4727
4728 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4729 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4730 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4731 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4732 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4733 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4734 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4735 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4736 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4737 &%-M%&).
4738
4739 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4740 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4741 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4742 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4743 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4744
4745 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4746 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4747 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4748 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4749 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4750 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4751
4752 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4753 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4754 necessarily be discarded.
4755 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4756 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4757 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4758 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4759 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4760 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4761
4762 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4763 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4764 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4765 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4766 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4767 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4768 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4769
4770 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4771 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4772 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4773
4774
4775
4776 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4777 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4778 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4779 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4780 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4781 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4782 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4783 optional parts are:
4784
4785 .ilist
4786 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4787 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4788 .next
4789 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4790 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4791 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4792 .next
4793 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4794 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4795 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4796 .next
4797 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4798 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4799 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4800 .next
4801 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4802 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4803 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4804 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4805 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4806 .next
4807 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4808 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4809 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4810 .next
4811 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4812 want to use this feature, you must set
4813 .code
4814 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4815 .endd
4816 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4817 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4818 .endlist
4819
4820 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4821 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4822 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4823 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4824
4825 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4826 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4827 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4828 and does not introduce a comment.
4829
4830 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4831 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4832 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4833 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4834 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4835
4836 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4837 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4838 change settings as required.
4839
4840 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4841 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4842 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4843 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4844 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4845 described.
4846
4847
4848
4849 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4850 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4851 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4852 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4853 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4854 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4855 using this syntax:
4856 .display
4857 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4858 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4859 .endd
4860 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4861 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4862 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4863 name is required.
4864
4865 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4866 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4867 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4868 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4869
4870 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4871 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4872 for example:
4873 .code
4874 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4875 .include /some/file
4876 .endd
4877 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4878 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4879 inclusion appears.
4880
4881
4882
4883 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4884 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4885 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4886 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4887 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4888 definition, and must be of the form
4889 .display
4890 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4891 .endd
4892 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4893 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4894 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4895 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4896 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4897
4898 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4899 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4900 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4901
4902 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4903 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4904 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4905 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4906 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4907 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4908 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4909 define
4910 .display
4911 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4912 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4913 .endd
4914 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4915 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4916 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4917 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4918 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4919 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4920
4921
4922 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4923 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4924 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4925 &'='&. For example:
4926 .code
4927 MAC = initial value
4928 ...
4929 MAC == updated value
4930 .endd
4931 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4932 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4933 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4934 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4935 .code
4936 MAC = initial value
4937 ...
4938 MAC == MAC and something added
4939 .endd
4940 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4941 from a number of other files.
4942
4943 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4944 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4945 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4946 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4947 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4948 file to be ignored.
4949
4950
4951
4952 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4953 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4954 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4955 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4956 .code
4957 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4958 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4959 .endd
4960 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4961 .code
4962 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4963 .endd
4964 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4965 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4966 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4967
4968
4969 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4970 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4971 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4972 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4973 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4974 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4975 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4976
4977 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4978 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4979 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4980 line. Thus:
4981 .code
4982 .ifdef AAA
4983 message_size_limit = 50M
4984 .else
4985 message_size_limit = 100M
4986 .endif
4987 .endd
4988 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4989 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4990 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4991 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4992
4993 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4994 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4995 in this line"& will always be true.
4996
4997 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4998 to clarify complicated nestings.
4999
5000
5001
5002 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5003 .cindex "common option syntax"
5004 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5005 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5006 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5007 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5008 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5009 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5010 space) and then the value. For example:
5011 .code
5012 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5013 .endd
5014 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5015 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5016 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5017 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5018 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5019 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5020 word &"hide"&. For example:
5021 .code
5022 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5023 .endd
5024 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5025 .code
5026 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5027 .endd
5028 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5029 all instances of the same driver.
5030
5031 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5032 that are found in option settings.
5033
5034
5035 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5036 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5037 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5038 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5039 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5040 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5041 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5042 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5043 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5044 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5045 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5046 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5047 .code
5048 queue_only
5049 queue_only = true
5050 .endd
5051 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5052 .code
5053 no_queue_only
5054 queue_only = false
5055 .endd
5056 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5057
5058
5059
5060
5061 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5062 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5063 .cindex "format" "integer"
5064 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5065 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5066 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5067 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5068 hexadecimal number.
5069
5070 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5071 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5072 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5073 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5074 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5075 used.
5076
5077
5078 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5079 .cindex "integer format"
5080 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5081 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5082 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5083 Such options are always output in octal.
5084
5085
5086 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5087 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5088 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5089 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5090 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5091
5092
5093
5094 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5095 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5096 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5097 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5098 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5099
5100 .table2 30pt
5101 .irow &%s%& seconds
5102 .irow &%m%& minutes
5103 .irow &%h%& hours
5104 .irow &%d%& days
5105 .irow &%w%& weeks
5106 .endtable
5107
5108 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5109 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5110 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5111
5112
5113
5114 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5115 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5116 .cindex "format" "string"
5117 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5118 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5119 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5120 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5121 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5122 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5123 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5124 therefore equivalent:
5125 .code
5126 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5127 trusted_users = uucp:\
5128 # This comment line is ignored
5129 mail
5130 .endd
5131 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5132 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5133 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5134 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5135 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5136
5137 .table2 100pt
5138 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5139 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5140 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5141 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5142 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5143 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5144 character"
5145 .endtable
5146
5147 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5148 character, that character replaces the pair.
5149
5150 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5151 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5152 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5153 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5154 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5155 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5156
5157
5158 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5159 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5160 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5161 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5162 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5163 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5164 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5165 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5166 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5167 within a quoted configuration string.
5168
5169
5170 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5171 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5172 .cindex "format" "user name"
5173 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5174 .cindex "format" "group name"
5175 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5176 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5177 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5178 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5179
5180
5181 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5182 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5183 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5184 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5185 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5186 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5187 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5188 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5189 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5190 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5191 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5192
5193 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5194 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5195 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5196 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5197 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5198 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5199 example, the list
5200 .code
5201 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5202 .endd
5203 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5204
5205 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5206 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5207 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5208 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5209
5210 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5211 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5212 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5213 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5214 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5215 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5216 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5217 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5218 .code
5219 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5220 .endd
5221 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5222 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5223 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5224
5225 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5226 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5227 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5228 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5229 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5230 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5231 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5232 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5233 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5234 .code
5235 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5236 .endd
5237 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5238 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5239 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5240 the value in quotes. For example:
5241 .code
5242 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5243 .endd
5244 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5245 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5246 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5247 enclosing an empty list item.
5248
5249
5250
5251 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5252 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5253 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5254 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5255 .code
5256 senders = user@domain :
5257 .endd
5258 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5259 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5260 items, the second of which is empty:
5261 .code
5262 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5263 .endd
5264 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5265 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5266 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5267 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5268 .code
5269 senders = :
5270 .endd
5271 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5272 is at the end of the list.
5273
5274
5275
5276
5277 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5278 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5279 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5280 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5281 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5282 a sequence of lines like this:
5283 .display
5284 <&'instance name'&>:
5285 <&'option'&>
5286 ...
5287 <&'option'&>
5288 .endd
5289 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5290 followed by three options settings:
5291 .code
5292 localuser:
5293 driver = accept
5294 check_local_user
5295 transport = local_delivery
5296 .endd
5297 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5298 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5299 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5300 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5301 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5302 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5303
5304 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5305 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5306
5307 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5308 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5309 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5310 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5311 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5312 server.
5313
5314 .cindex "generic options"
5315 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5316 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5317 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5318 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5319 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5320 .cindex "private options"
5321 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5322 they all have default values.
5323
5324 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5325 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5326 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5327
5328 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5329 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5330 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5331 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5332 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5333 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5334 configuration lines:
5335 .code
5336 remote_smtp:
5337 driver = smtp
5338 .endd
5339 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5340 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5341 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5342 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5343 thus:
5344 .code
5345 special_smtp:
5346 driver = smtp
5347 port = 1234
5348 command_timeout = 10s
5349 .endd
5350 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5351 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5352 lines.
5353
5354 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5355 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5356 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5357 option.
5358
5359
5360
5361
5362
5363
5364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5366
5367 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5368 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5369 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5370 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5371 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5372 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5373 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5374 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5375 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5376 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5377 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5378
5379
5380
5381 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5382 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5383 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5384 the line
5385 .code
5386 # primary_hostname =
5387 .endd
5388 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5389 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5390 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5391 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5392
5393 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5394 .code
5395 domainlist local_domains = @
5396 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5397 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5398 .endd
5399 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5400 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5401 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5402 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5403
5404 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5405 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5406 on the local host.
5407
5408 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5409 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5410 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5411 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5412 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5413 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5414
5415 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5416 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5417 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5418 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5419 domain is permitted.
5420
5421 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5422 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5423 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5424 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5425 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5426 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5427
5428 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5429 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5430 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5431
5432 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5433 .code
5434 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5435 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5436 .endd
5437 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5438 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5439 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5440 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5441 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5442 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5443 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5444 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5445 contents of a message to be checked.
5446
5447 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5448 .code
5449 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5450 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5451 .endd
5452 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5453 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5454 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5455 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5456
5457 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5458 .code
5459 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5460 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5461 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5462 .endd
5463 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5464 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5465 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5466 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5467 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5468 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5469 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5470
5471 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5472 .code
5473 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5474 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5475 .endd
5476 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5477 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5478 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5479 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5480 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5481 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5482 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5483 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5484 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5485 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5486 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5487 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5488 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5489 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5490 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5491 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5492
5493 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5494 .code
5495 # qualify_domain =
5496 # qualify_recipient =
5497 .endd
5498 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5499 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5500 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5501 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5502 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5503 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5504
5505 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5506 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5507 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5508 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5509 .code
5510 # allow_domain_literals
5511 .endd
5512 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5513 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5514 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5515 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5516 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5517 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5518
5519 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5520 .code
5521 never_users = root
5522 .endd
5523 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5524 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5525 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5526 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5527 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5528 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5529 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5530 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5531
5532 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5533 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5534 line,
5535 .code
5536 host_lookup = *
5537 .endd
5538 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5539 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5540 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5541 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5542 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5543 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5544 unreachable.
5545
5546 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5547 1413 (hence their names):
5548 .code
5549 rfc1413_hosts = *
5550 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5551 .endd
5552 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5553 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5554 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5555 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5556 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5557 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5558 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5559
5560 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5561 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5562 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5563 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5564 .code
5565 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5566 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5567 .endd
5568 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5569 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5570
5571 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5572 .code
5573 # percent_hack_domains =
5574 .endd
5575 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5576 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5577 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5578
5579 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5580 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5581 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5582 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5583 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5584 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5585 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5586 always bounce messages.
5587 .code
5588 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5589 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5590 .endd
5591 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5592 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5593 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5594 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5595 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5596
5597
5598
5599 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5600 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5601 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5602 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5603 It starts with the line
5604 .code
5605 begin acl
5606 .endd
5607 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5608 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5609 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5610
5611 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5612 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5613 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5614 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5615 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5616 result of the ACL processing.
5617 .code
5618 acl_check_rcpt:
5619 .endd
5620 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5621 ACL, and names it.
5622 .code
5623 accept hosts = :
5624 .endd
5625 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5626 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5627 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5628 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5629 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5630 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5631
5632 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5633 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5634 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5635 manner.
5636 .code
5637 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5638 domains = +local_domains
5639 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5640
5641 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5642 domains = !+local_domains
5643 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5644 .endd
5645 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5646 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5647 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5648 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5649 in Internet mail addresses.
5650
5651 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5652 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5653 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5654 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5655 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5656 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5657 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5658 policy of being as safe as possible.
5659
5660 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5661 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5662 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5663 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5664 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5665 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5666
5667 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5668 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5669 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5670 have to modify this rule.
5671
5672 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5673 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5674 common convention of local parts constructed as
5675 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5676 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5677 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5678 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5679 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5680 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5681
5682 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5683 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5684 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5685 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5686 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5687 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5688 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5689 .code
5690 accept local_parts = postmaster
5691 domains = +local_domains
5692 .endd
5693 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5694 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5695 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5696 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5697 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5698
5699 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5700 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5701 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5702 .code
5703 require verify = sender
5704 .endd
5705 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5706 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5707 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5708 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5709 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5710 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5711 discusses the details of address verification.
5712 .code
5713 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5714 control = submission
5715 .endd
5716 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5717 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5718 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5719 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5720 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5721 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5722 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5723 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5724 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5725 .code
5726 accept authenticated = *
5727 control = submission
5728 .endd
5729 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5730 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5731 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5732 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5733 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5734 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5735 .code
5736 require message = relay not permitted
5737 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5738 .endd
5739 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5740 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5741 .code
5742 require verify = recipient
5743 .endd
5744 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5745 fails, the address is rejected.
5746 .code
5747 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5748 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5749 # $dnslist_text
5750 # dnslists = black.list.example
5751 #
5752 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5753 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5754 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5755 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5756 .endd
5757 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5758 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5759 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5760 line.
5761 .code
5762 # require verify = csa
5763 .endd
5764 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5765 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5766 records.
5767 .code
5768 accept
5769 .endd
5770 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5771 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5772 .code
5773 acl_check_data:
5774 .endd
5775 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5776 of this ACL are commented out:
5777 .code
5778 # deny malware = *
5779 # message = This message contains a virus \
5780 # ($malware_name).
5781 .endd
5782 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5783 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5784 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5785 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5786 .code
5787 # warn spam = nobody
5788 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5789 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5790 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5791 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5792 .endd
5793 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5794 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5795 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5796 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5797 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5798 whatever the spam score.
5799 .code
5800 accept
5801 .endd
5802 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5803
5804
5805 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5806 .cindex "default" "routers"
5807 .cindex "routers" "default"
5808 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5809 by the line
5810 .code
5811 begin routers
5812 .endd
5813 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5814 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5815 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5816 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5817 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5818 .code
5819 # domain_literal:
5820 # driver = ipliteral
5821 # domains = !+local_domains
5822 # transport = remote_smtp
5823 .endd
5824 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5825 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5826 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5827 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5828 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5829 .code
5830 dnslookup:
5831 driver = dnslookup
5832 domains = ! +local_domains
5833 transport = remote_smtp
5834 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5835 no_more
5836 .endd
5837 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5838 domains. This is specified by the line
5839 .code
5840 domains = ! +local_domains
5841 .endd
5842 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5843 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5844 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5845 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5846 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5847 passed on to the following routers.
5848
5849 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5850 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5851 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5852 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5853 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5854
5855 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5856 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5857 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5858 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5859 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5860 the address fails and is bounced.
5861
5862 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5863 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5864 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5865 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5866 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5867 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5868 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5869 out.
5870 .code
5871 system_aliases:
5872 driver = redirect
5873 allow_fail
5874 allow_defer
5875 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5876 # user = exim
5877 file_transport = address_file
5878 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5879 .endd
5880 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5881 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5882 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5883 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5884 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5885 the next router.
5886
5887 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5888 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5889 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5890 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5891 .code
5892 userforward:
5893 driver = redirect
5894 check_local_user
5895 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5896 # local_part_suffix_optional
5897 file = $home/.forward
5898 # allow_filter
5899 no_verify
5900 no_expn
5901 check_ancestor
5902 file_transport = address_file
5903 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5904 reply_transport = address_reply
5905 .endd
5906 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5907 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5908 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5909 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5910 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5911 namely:
5912 .code
5913 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5914 # local_part_suffix_optional
5915 .endd
5916 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5917 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5918 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5919 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5920 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5921 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5922 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5923
5924 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5925 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5926 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5927 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5928
5929 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5930 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5931 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5932 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5933 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5934 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5935 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5936
5937 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5938 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5939 There are two reasons for doing this:
5940
5941 .olist
5942 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5943 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5944 unnecessary work.
5945 .next
5946 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5947 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5948 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5949 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5950 this time.
5951 .endlist
5952
5953 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5954 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5955 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5956 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5957
5958 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5959 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5960 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5961 .code
5962 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5963 .endd
5964 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5965 transport.
5966 .code
5967 localuser:
5968 driver = accept
5969 check_local_user
5970 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5971 # local_part_suffix_optional
5972 transport = local_delivery
5973 .endd
5974 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5975 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5976 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5977 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5978 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5979
5980
5981 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5982 .cindex "default" "transports"
5983 .cindex "transports" "default"
5984 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5985 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5986 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5987 .code
5988 begin transports
5989 .endd
5990 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5991 .code
5992 remote_smtp:
5993 driver = smtp
5994 .endd
5995 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5996 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5997 .code
5998 local_delivery:
5999 driver = appendfile
6000 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6001 delivery_date_add
6002 envelope_to_add
6003 return_path_add
6004 # group = mail
6005 # mode = 0660
6006 .endd
6007 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6008 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6009 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6010 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6011 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6012 show how this can be done.
6013
6014 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6015 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6016 similarly-named options above.
6017 .code
6018 address_pipe:
6019 driver = pipe
6020 return_output
6021 .endd
6022 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6023 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6024 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6025 sender.
6026 .code
6027 address_file:
6028 driver = appendfile
6029 delivery_date_add
6030 envelope_to_add
6031 return_path_add
6032 .endd
6033 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6034 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6035 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6036 .code
6037 address_reply:
6038 driver = autoreply
6039 .endd
6040 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6041 filter files.
6042
6043
6044
6045 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6046 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6047 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6048 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6049 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6050 introduced by the line
6051 .code
6052 begin retry
6053 .endd
6054 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6055 errors:
6056 .code
6057 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6058 .endd
6059 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6060 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6061 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6062 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6063
6064 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6065 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6066 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6067
6068
6069 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6070 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6071 .code
6072 begin rewrite
6073 .endd
6074 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6075 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6076
6077
6078
6079 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6080 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6081 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6082 .code
6083 begin authenticators
6084 .endd
6085 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6086 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6087 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6088 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6089 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6090 to support most MUA software.
6091
6092 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6093 .code
6094 #PLAIN:
6095 # driver = plaintext
6096 # server_set_id = $auth2
6097 # server_prompts = :
6098 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6099 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6100 .endd
6101 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6102 .code
6103 #LOGIN:
6104 # driver = plaintext
6105 # server_set_id = $auth1
6106 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6107 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6108 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6109 .endd
6110
6111 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6112 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6113 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6114 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6115 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6116 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6117 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6118 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6119
6120 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6121 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6122 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6123 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6124
6125 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6126 usercode and password are in different positions.
6127 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6128
6129 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6130
6131
6132
6133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6135
6136 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6137
6138 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6139 .cindex "PCRE"
6140 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6141 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6142 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6143 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6144 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6145 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6146
6147 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6148 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6149 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6150 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6151 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6152 case-insensitive.
6153
6154 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6155 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6156 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6157 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6158 .code
6159 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6160 .endd
6161 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6162 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6163 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6164 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6165 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6166 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6167 matched.
6168
6169 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6170 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6171 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6172 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6173 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6174 match anywhere in the subject string.
6175
6176 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6177 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6178 .code
6179 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6180 .endd
6181 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6182 You need to use:
6183 .code
6184 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6185 .endd
6186 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6187 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6188
6189
6190
6191 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6193
6194 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6195 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6196 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6197 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6198 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6199 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6200
6201 .olist
6202 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6203 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6204 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6205 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6206 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6207 .next
6208 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6209 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6210 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6211 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6212 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6213 .endlist
6214
6215 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6216 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6217 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6218 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6219 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6220 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6221
6222 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6223 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6224 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6225 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6226 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6227 .code
6228 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6229 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6230 .endd
6231 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6232 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6233 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6234 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6235 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6236 .code
6237 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6238 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6239 .endd
6240 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6241 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6242
6243 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6244 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6245 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6246 .code
6247 domain1:
6248 domain2:
6249 .endd
6250 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6251 matches the list item.
6252
6253 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6254 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6255 .code
6256 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6257 .endd
6258 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6259 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6260 causes a second lookup to occur.
6261
6262 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6263 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6264 lookup is permitted.
6265
6266
6267 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6268 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6269 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6270 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6271
6272 .ilist
6273 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6274 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6275 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6276 .next
6277 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6278 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6279 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6280 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6281 .endlist
6282
6283 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6284 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6285 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6286 .code
6287 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6288 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6289 .endd
6290 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6291 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6292 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6293
6294
6295
6296
6297 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6298 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6299 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6300 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6301
6302 .ilist
6303 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6304 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6305 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6306 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6307 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6308 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6309 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6310 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6311 be found in several places:
6312 .display
6313 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6314 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6315 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6316 .endd
6317 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6318 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6319 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6320 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6321 .next
6322 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6323 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6324 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6325 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6326 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6327 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6328 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6329
6330 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6331 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6332 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6333 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6334 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6335 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6336 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6337 .next
6338 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6339 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6340 .cindex "sasldb2"
6341 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6342 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6343 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6344 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6345 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6346 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6347 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6348 .next
6349 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6350 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6351 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6352 .cindex "Courier"
6353 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6354 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6355 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6356 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6357 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6358 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6359 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6360 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6361 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6362 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6363 .next
6364 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6365 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6366 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6367 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6368 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6369 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6370 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6371 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6372 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6373 .next
6374 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6375 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6376 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6377 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6378 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6379 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6380 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6381 .code
6382 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6383 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6384 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6385 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6386 .endd
6387 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6388 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6389 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6390 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6391 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6392
6393 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6394 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6395 lookup types support only literal keys.
6396
6397 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6398 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6399 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6400 .next
6401 .cindex "linear search"
6402 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6403 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6404 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6405 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6406 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6407 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6408 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6409 in the file is used.
6410
6411 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6412 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6413 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6414 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6415 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6416 colon, for example:
6417 .code
6418 baduser: :fail:
6419 .endd
6420 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6421 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6422 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6423 wildcarding of any kind.
6424
6425 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6426 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6427 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6428 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6429 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6430 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6431 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6432 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6433 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6434
6435 .next
6436 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6437 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6438 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6439 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6440 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6441 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6442 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6443 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6444
6445 .next
6446 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6447 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6448 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6449 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6450 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6451 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6452 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6453 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6454 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6455
6456 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6457 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6458 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6459 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6460
6461 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6462 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6463
6464 .olist
6465 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6466 .code
6467 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6468 *fish data for anythingfish
6469 .endd
6470 .next
6471 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6472 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6473 .code
6474 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6475 .endd
6476 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6477 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6478 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6479 .code
6480 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6481 .endd
6482 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6483 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6484 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6485 .code
6486 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6487 .endd
6488
6489 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6490 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6491 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6492 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6493 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6494
6495 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6496 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6497 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6498 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6499 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6500
6501 .next
6502 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6503 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6504 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6505 example:
6506 .code
6507 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6508 .endd
6509 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6510 .endlist olist
6511
6512 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6513 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6514 be followed by optional colons.
6515
6516 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6517 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6518 lookup types support only literal keys.
6519 .endlist ilist
6520
6521
6522 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6523 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6524 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6525 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6526 many of them are given in later sections.
6527
6528 .ilist
6529 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6530 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6531 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6532 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6533 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6534 .next
6535 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6536 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6537 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6538 .next
6539 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6540 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6541 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6542 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6543 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6544 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6545 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6546 .next
6547 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6548 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6549 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6550 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6551 .next
6552 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6553 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6554 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6555 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6556 .next
6557 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6558 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6559 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6560 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6561 .next
6562 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6563 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6564 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6565 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6566 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6567 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6568 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6569 password value. For example:
6570 .code
6571 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6572 .endd
6573 .next
6574 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6575 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6576 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6577 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6578
6579 .next
6580 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6581 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6582 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6583 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6584
6585 .next
6586 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6587 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6588 .next
6589 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6590 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6591 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6592 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6593 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6594 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6595 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6596 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6597 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6598 .code
6599 require condition = \
6600 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6601 .endd
6602 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6603 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6604 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6605 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6606 .endlist
6607
6608
6609
6610 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6611 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6612 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6613 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6614 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6615 options such as a list of local domains.
6616
6617 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6618 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6619 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6620 or may give up altogether.
6621
6622
6623
6624 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6625 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6626 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6627 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6628 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6629 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6630 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6631 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6632
6633 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6634 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6635 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6636
6637 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6638 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6639 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6640
6641 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6642 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6643 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6644 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6645 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6646 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6647 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6648 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6649 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6650 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6651 .code
6652 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6653 .endd
6654 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6655 looks up these keys, in this order:
6656 .code
6657 jane@eyre.example
6658 *@eyre.example
6659 *
6660 .endd
6661 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6662 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6663 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6664 Exim move on to try the next key.
6665
6666
6667
6668 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6669 .cindex "partial matching"
6670 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6671 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6672 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6673 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6674 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6675 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6676 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6677 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6678 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6679 a key in a DBM file is
6680 .code
6681 *.dates.fict.example
6682 .endd
6683 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6684 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6685 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6686 file.
6687
6688 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6689 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6690 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6691
6692 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6693 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6694 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6695 partial matching keys
6696 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6697 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6698 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6699
6700 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6701 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6702 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6703 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6704 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6705 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6706 remains.
6707
6708 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6709 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6710 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6711 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6712 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6713 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6714 .code
6715 2250.dates.fict.example
6716 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6717 *.dates.fict.example
6718 *.fict.example
6719 .endd
6720 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6721 finishes.
6722
6723 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6724 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6725 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6726 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6727 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6728 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6729 .code
6730 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6731 .endd
6732 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6733 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6734 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6735 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6736 .code
6737 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6738 .endd
6739 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6740 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6741
6742 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6743 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6744 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6745
6746 .ilist
6747 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6748 .next
6749 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6750 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6751 .next
6752 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6753 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6754 for &"*"& on its own.
6755 .next
6756 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6757 .endlist
6758
6759
6760 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6761 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6762 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6763 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6764 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6765 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6766 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6767
6768 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6769 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6770 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6771 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6772 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6773
6774
6775
6776
6777 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6778 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6779 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6780 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6781 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6782 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6783 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6784
6785 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6786 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6787 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6788 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6789 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6790 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6791
6792 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6793 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6794 complete.
6795
6796
6797
6798
6799 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6800 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6801 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6802 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6803 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6804 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6805 .code
6806 [name=$local_part]
6807 .endd
6808 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6809 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6810 .code
6811 [name="$local_part"]
6812 .endd
6813 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6814 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6815 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6816 of the following form is provided:
6817 .code
6818 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6819 .endd
6820 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6821 .code
6822 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6823 .endd
6824 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6825 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6826 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6827
6828
6829
6830
6831 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6832 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6833 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6834 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6835 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6836 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6837 an expansion string could contain:
6838 .code
6839 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6840 .endd
6841 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6842 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6843 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6844 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6845
6846 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6847 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6848 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6849 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6850 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6851 .code
6852 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6853 .endd
6854 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6855 altered and nothing is added.
6856
6857 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6858 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6859 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6860 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6861 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6862
6863 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6864 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6865 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6866 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6867 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6868 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6869 .code
6870 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6871 .endd
6872 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6873 white space is ignored.
6874
6875 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6876 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6877 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6878 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6879 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6880 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6881 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6882 .code
6883 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6884 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6885 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6886 .endd
6887 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6888 white space is ignored.
6889
6890 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6891 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6892 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6893 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6894 the pseudo-type MXH:
6895 .code
6896 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6897 .endd
6898 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6899 returned.
6900
6901 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6902 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6903 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6904 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6905 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6906 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6907 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6908 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6909 .code
6910 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6911 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6912 .endd
6913 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6914 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6915 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6916
6917 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6918 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6919 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6920 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6921 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6922 such a list.
6923
6924 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6925 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6926 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6927 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6928 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6929 result of a successful lookup such as:
6930 .code
6931 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6932 .endd
6933 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6934 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6935 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6936
6937 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6938 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6939 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6940 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6941 .code
6942 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6943 .endd
6944
6945
6946 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6947 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6948 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6949 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6950 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6951 .code
6952 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6953 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6954 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6955 .endd
6956 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6957 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6958 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6959 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6960
6961 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6962 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6963 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6964
6965 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6966 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6967 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6968 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6969 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6970 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6971 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6972 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6973 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6974 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6975 .code
6976 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6977 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6978 .endd
6979 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6980 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6981
6982
6983
6984
6985 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6986 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6987 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6988 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6989 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6990 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6991 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6992 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6993 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6994 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6995 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6996 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6997 .code
6998 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6999 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7000 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7001 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7002 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7003 .endd
7004 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7005 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7006
7007 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7008 the way they handle the results of a query:
7009
7010 .ilist
7011 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7012 gives an error.
7013 .next
7014 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7015 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7016 .next
7017 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7018 from all of them are returned.
7019 .endlist
7020
7021
7022 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7023 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7024 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7025 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7026
7027
7028 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7029 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7030 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7031 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7032 .code
7033 data = ${lookup ldap \
7034 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7035 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7036 .endd
7037 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7038 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7039 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7040 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7041
7042 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7043 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7044 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7045
7046
7047 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7048 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7049 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7050 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7051 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7052 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7053
7054 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7055 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7056 the string:
7057 .code
7058 * => \2A
7059 ( => \28
7060 ) => \29
7061 \ => \5C
7062 .endd
7063 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7064 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7065 .code
7066 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7067 .endd
7068 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7069 .code
7070 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7071 .endd
7072 yields
7073 .code
7074 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7075 .endd
7076 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7077 .code
7078 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7079 .endd
7080 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7081 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7082 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7083 .code
7084 , + " \ < > ;
7085 .endd
7086 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7087 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7088 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7089 .code
7090 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7091 .endd
7092 yields
7093 .code
7094 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7095 .endd
7096 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7097 .code
7098 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7099 .endd
7100 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7101 authentication below.
7102
7103
7104 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7105 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7106 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7107 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7108 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7109 by starting it with
7110 .code
7111 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7112 .endd
7113 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7114 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7115 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7116 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7117 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7118 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7119 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7120 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7121 failures, and timeouts.
7122
7123 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7124 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7125 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7126 doubled. For example
7127 .code
7128 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7129 .endd
7130 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7131 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7132 the local host) is used.
7133
7134 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7135 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7136 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7137 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7138 not available.
7139
7140 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7141 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7142 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7143 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7144 .code
7145 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7146 .endd
7147 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7148 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7149 .code
7150 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7151 .endd
7152 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7153 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7154 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7155 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7156 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7157 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7158 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7159 backup host.
7160
7161 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7162 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7163 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7164
7165 .ilist
7166 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7167 interface.
7168 .next
7169 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7170 .endlist
7171
7172
7173 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7174 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7175
7176
7177
7178 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7179 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7180 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7181 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7182 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7183 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7184 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7185 them. The following names are recognized:
7186 .display
7187 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7188 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7189 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7190 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7191 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7192 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7193 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7194 .endd
7195 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7196 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7197 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7198 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7199
7200 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7201 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7202 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7203 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7204 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7205 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7206 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7207 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7208 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7209
7210 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7211 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7212
7213
7214 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7215 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7216 .code
7217 ${lookup ldap
7218 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7219 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7220 {$value}fail}
7221 .endd
7222 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7223 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7224 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7225 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7226
7227 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7228 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7229 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7230
7231 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7232 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7233 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7234 quoting has two advantages:
7235
7236 .ilist
7237 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7238 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7239 .next
7240 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7241 .endlist
7242
7243 For example, a setting such as
7244 .code
7245 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7246 .endd
7247 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7248
7249 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7250 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7251 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7252 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7253 .code
7254 PASS=${quote:$3}
7255 .endd
7256 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7257 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7258 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7259
7260
7261
7262 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7263 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7264 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7265 as a sequence of values, for example
7266 .code
7267 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7268 .endd
7269 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7270 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7271 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7272 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7273 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7274 directory.
7275
7276 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7277 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7278 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7279
7280 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7281 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7282 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7283 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7284 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7285 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7286 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7287
7288 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7289 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7290 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7291 .code
7292 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7293 value1.1, value1.2
7294
7295 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7296 value two
7297
7298 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7299 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7300
7301 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7302 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7303 .endd
7304 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7305 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7306 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7307 results of LDAP lookups.
7308
7309
7310
7311
7312 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7313 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7314 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7315 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7316 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7317 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7318 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7319 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7320 .code
7321 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7322 .endd
7323 might return the string
7324 .code
7325 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7326 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7327 .endd
7328 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7329 .code
7330 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7331 .endd
7332 would just return
7333 .code
7334 Martin Guerre
7335 .endd
7336 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7337 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7338 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7339
7340
7341
7342 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7343 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7344 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7345 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7346 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7347 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7348 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7349 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7350 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7351 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7352 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7353 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7354 might be
7355 .code
7356 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7357 {$value}fail}
7358 .endd
7359 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7360 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7361 .code
7362 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7363 {$value}}
7364 .endd
7365 might be
7366 .code
7367 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7368 .endd
7369 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7370 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7371 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7372 .code
7373 Mister X
7374 .endd
7375 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7376 with a newline between the data for each row.
7377
7378
7379 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7380 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7381 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7382 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7383 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7384 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7385 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7386 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7387 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7388 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7389 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7390 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7391 information.
7392 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7393 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7394 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7395 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7396 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7397 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7398 .code
7399 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7400 .endd
7401 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7402 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7403 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7404 .code
7405 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7406 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7407 .endd
7408 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7409 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7410 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7411 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7412 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7413 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7414
7415 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7416 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7417 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7418 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7419 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7420 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7421 characters are not special.
7422
7423 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7424 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7425 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7426 done by starting the query with
7427 .display
7428 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7429 .endd
7430 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7431 .olist
7432 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7433 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7434 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7435 taken from there.
7436 .next
7437 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7438 .endlist
7439 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7440 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7441 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7442
7443 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7444 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7445 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7446 like this:
7447 .code
7448 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7449 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7450 master/db/name/pw
7451 .endd
7452 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7453 .code
7454 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7455 .endd
7456 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7457 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7458 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7459 .code
7460 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7461 .endd
7462
7463
7464 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7465 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7466 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7467 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7468 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7469 .display
7470 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7471 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7472 .endd
7473 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7474 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7475
7476 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7477 the queries.
7478
7479 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7480 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7481
7482 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7483 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7484 is zero because no rows are affected.
7485
7486
7487 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7488 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7489 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7490 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7491 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7492 looks like this:
7493 .code
7494 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7495 .endd
7496 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7497 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7498 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7499
7500 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7501 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7502 affected.
7503
7504 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7505 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7506 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7507 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7508 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7509 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7510 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7511 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7512 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7513 .code
7514 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7515 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7516 .endd
7517 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7518 .code
7519 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7520 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7521 .endd
7522 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7523 quote, which it doubles.
7524
7525 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7526 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7527 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7528 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7529 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7530 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7531 option.
7532 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7533 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7534
7535
7536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7537 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7538
7539 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7540 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7541 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7542 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7543 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7544 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7545 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7546 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7547 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7548
7549 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7550 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7551 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7552 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7553
7554
7555
7556 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7557 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7558 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7559 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7560 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7561 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7562 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7563 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7564
7565
7566 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7567 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7568 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7569
7570 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7571 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7572 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7573 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7574 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7575 .code
7576 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7577 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7578 .endd
7579 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7580 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7581 senders based on the receiving domain.
7582
7583
7584
7585
7586 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7587 .cindex "list" "negation"
7588 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7589 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7590 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7591 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7592 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7593 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7594
7595 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7596 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7597 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7598 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7599 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7600 .code
7601 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7602 .endd
7603 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7604 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7605 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7606 .code
7607 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7608 .endd
7609 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7610 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7611 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7612
7613 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7614 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7615 item.
7616
7617
7618
7619 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7620 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7621 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7622 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7623 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7624 file names are not allowed,
7625 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7626 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7627 lines:
7628
7629 .ilist
7630 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7631 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7632 .next
7633 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7634 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7635 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7636 .code
7637 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7638 .endd
7639 .endlist
7640
7641 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7642 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7643 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7644 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7645
7646 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7647 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7648 .code
7649 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7650 .endd
7651 and the file contains the lines
7652 .code
7653 !a.b.c
7654 *.b.c
7655 .endd
7656 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7657 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7658
7659
7660
7661 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7662 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7663 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7664 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7665 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7666 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7667 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7668 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7669
7670 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7671 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7672 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7673 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7674
7675
7676
7677
7678 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7679 .cindex "named lists"
7680 .cindex "list" "named"
7681 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7682 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7683 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7684 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7685 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7686 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7687 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7688 .code
7689 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7690 .endd
7691 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7692 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7693 configured with the line
7694 .code
7695 domains = +local_domains
7696 .endd
7697 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7698 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7699 .code
7700 dnslookup:
7701 driver = dnslookup
7702 domains = ! +local_domains
7703 transport = remote_smtp
7704 no_more
7705 .endd
7706 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7707 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7708 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7709 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7710 .code
7711 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7712 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7713 .endd
7714 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7715 .code
7716 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7717 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7718 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7719 .endd
7720 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7721 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7722 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7723 .code
7724 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7725 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7726 .endd
7727 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7728 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7729 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7730 .code
7731 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7732 .endd
7733 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7734 referenced lists if you can.
7735
7736 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7737 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7738 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7739 .code
7740 domains = +local_domains
7741 .endd
7742 on several of your routers
7743 or in several ACL statements,
7744 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7745 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7746 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7747 the same each time they are referenced.
7748
7749 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7750 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7751 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7752 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7753
7754
7755
7756 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7757 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7758 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7759 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7760 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7761 write
7762 .code
7763 ALIST = host1 : host2
7764 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7765 .endd
7766 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7767 .code
7768 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7769 .endd
7770 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7771 list, and write
7772 .code
7773 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7774 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7775 .endd
7776 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7777 .code
7778 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7779 .endd
7780
7781
7782 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7783 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7784 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7785 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7786 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7787 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7788 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7789 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7790 message. For example:
7791 .code
7792 domainlist special_domains = \
7793 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7794 .endd
7795 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7796 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7797 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7798 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7799 same list each time.
7800
7801 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7802 cache the result anyway. For example:
7803 .code
7804 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7805 .endd
7806 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7807 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7808
7809
7810
7811 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7812 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7813 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7814 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7815 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7816
7817 .ilist
7818 .cindex "primary host name"
7819 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7820 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7821 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7822 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7823 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7824 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7825 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7826 differ only in their names.
7827 .next
7828 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7829 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7830 .cindex "domain literal"
7831 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7832 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7833 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7834 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7835 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7836 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7837 .next
7838 .cindex "@mx_any"
7839 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7840 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7841 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7842 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7843 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7844 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7845 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7846 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7847 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7848 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7849 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7850
7851 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7852 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7853 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7854 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7855 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7856
7857 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7858 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7859 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7860 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7861 on a router). For example:
7862 .code
7863 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7864 .endd
7865 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7866 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7867
7868 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7869 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7870 contain negative items.
7871
7872 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7873 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7874 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7875 .code
7876 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7877 an.other.domain : ...
7878 .endd
7879 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7880 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7881 .code
7882 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7883 an.other.domain ? ...
7884 .endd
7885 .next
7886 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7887 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7888 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7889 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7890 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7891 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7892 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7893 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7894 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7895 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7896
7897 .next
7898 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7899 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7900 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7901 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7902 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7903 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7904 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7905 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7906 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7907
7908 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7909 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7910 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7911 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7912 expression by expansion, of course).
7913 .next
7914 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7915 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7916 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7917 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7918 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7919 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7920 .code
7921 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7922 .endd
7923 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7924 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7925 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7926 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7927 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7928 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7929 other statements in the same ACL.
7930
7931 .next
7932 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7933 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7934 .code
7935 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7936 .endd
7937 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7938 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7939
7940 .next
7941 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7942 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7943 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7944 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7945 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7946 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7947 expansion variable.
7948 .next
7949 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7950 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7951 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7952 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7953 .code
7954 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7955 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7956 .endd
7957 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7958 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7959 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7960 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7961 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7962 .next
7963 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7964 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7965 between the pattern and the domain.
7966 .endlist
7967
7968 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7969 .code
7970 domainlist funny_domains = \
7971 @ : \
7972 lib.unseen.edu : \
7973 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7974 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7975 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7976 nis;domains.byname : \
7977 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7978 .endd
7979 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7980 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7981 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7982 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7983 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7984 patterns earlier.
7985
7986
7987
7988 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7989 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7990 .cindex "list" "host list"
7991 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7992 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7993 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7994 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7995 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7996 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7997 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7998
7999
8000 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8001 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8002 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8003 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8004 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8005 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8006 not used.
8007
8008 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8009 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8010 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8011
8012
8013
8014 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8015 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8016 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8017 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8018 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8019 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8020 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8021 concerns.)
8022
8023 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8024 inspecting its IP address:
8025
8026 .ilist
8027 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8028 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8029 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8030 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8031 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8032 with the IP address of the subject host.
8033
8034 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8035 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8036 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8037 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8038 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8039
8040 .next
8041 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8042 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8043 domain name, as just described.
8044
8045 .next
8046 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8047 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8048 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8049 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8050 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8051 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8052 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8053 that can never match a client host.
8054
8055 .next
8056 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8057 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8058 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8059 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8060 .code
8061 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8062 accept hosts = @[]
8063 .endd
8064 .next
8065 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8066 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8067 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8068 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8069 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8070 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8071 significant end of the address.
8072
8073 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8074 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8075 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8076 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8077 .code
8078 192.168.23.236/31
8079 .endd
8080 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8081 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8082 matches.
8083
8084 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8085 .code
8086 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8087 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8088 .endd
8089 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8090 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8091 For example:
8092 .code
8093 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8094 .endd
8095 could make use of a file containing
8096 .code
8097 172.16.0.0/12
8098 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8099 .endd
8100 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8101 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8102 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8103 .code
8104 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8105 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8106 .endd
8107 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8108 list.
8109 .endlist
8110
8111
8112
8113 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8114 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8115 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8116 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8117 address, the pattern takes this form:
8118 .display
8119 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8120 .endd
8121 For example:
8122 .code
8123 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8124 .endd
8125 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8126 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8127 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8128 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8129 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8130 returned by the lookup is not used.
8131
8132 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8133 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8134 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8135 patterns of this form:
8136 .display
8137 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8138 .endd
8139 For example:
8140 .code
8141 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8142 .endd
8143 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8144 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8145 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8146 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8147 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8148
8149 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8150 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8151 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8152 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8153 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8154 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8155 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8156 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8157 addresses are always used.
8158
8159 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8160 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8161 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8162 configurations.
8163
8164 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8165 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8166 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8167 case the IP address is used on its own.
8168
8169
8170
8171 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8172 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8173 .cindex "unknown host name"
8174 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8175 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8176 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8177 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8178 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8179 above.)
8180
8181 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8182 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8183 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8184 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8185 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8186 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8187 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8188
8189 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8190 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8191
8192 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8193 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8194 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8195 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8196 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8197 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8198 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8199 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8200 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8201
8202 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8203 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8204
8205 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8206 .cindex "alias for host"
8207 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8208 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8209
8210 .ilist
8211 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8212 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8213 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8214 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8215 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8216 expression.
8217 .next
8218 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8219 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8220 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8221 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8222 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8223 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8224 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8225 example,
8226 .code
8227 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8228 .endd
8229 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8230 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8231 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8232 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8233 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8234 .code
8235 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8236 .endd
8237 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8238 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8239 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8240 required.
8241 .endlist
8242
8243
8244
8245
8246 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8247 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8248 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8249 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8250 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8251 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8252
8253 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8254 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8255
8256 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8257 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8258 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8259 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8260 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8261 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8262
8263 .ilist
8264 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8265 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8266 .code
8267 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8268 .endd
8269 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8270 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8271
8272 .next
8273 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8274 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8275 example:
8276 .code
8277 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8278 192.168.4.5
8279 .endd
8280 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8281 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8282 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8283 .endlist
8284
8285 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8286 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8287 list.
8288
8289
8290 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8291 "SECTtemdnserr"
8292 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8293 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8294 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8295 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8296 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8297 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8298 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8299 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8300 host lists such as whitelists.
8301
8302
8303
8304 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8305 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8306 .cindex "unknown host name"
8307 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8308 If a pattern is of the form
8309 .display
8310 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8311 .endd
8312 for example
8313 .code
8314 dbm;/host/accept/list
8315 .endd
8316 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8317 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8318 is not used.
8319
8320 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8321 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8322 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8323 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8324 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8325 lookup, both using the same file.
8326
8327
8328
8329 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8330 If a pattern is of the form
8331 .display
8332 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8333 .endd
8334 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8335 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8336 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8337 .code
8338 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8339 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8340 .endd
8341 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8342 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8343 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8344 operator.
8345
8346 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8347 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8348 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8349
8350 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8351 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8352 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8353 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8354 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8355 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8356
8357
8358
8359 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8360 "SECTmixwilhos"
8361 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8362 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8363 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8364 ACL you could have:
8365 .code
8366 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8367 .endd
8368 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8369 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8370 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8371 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8372 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8373 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8374
8375 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8376 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8377 .code
8378 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8379 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8380 .endd
8381 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8382 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8383
8384
8385
8386
8387
8388 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8389 .cindex "list" "address list"
8390 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8391 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8392 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8393 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8394 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8395 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8396 using this option setting:
8397 .code
8398 senders = :
8399 .endd
8400 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8401 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8402 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8403 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8404
8405 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8406 example:
8407 .code
8408 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8409 .endd
8410 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8411 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8412 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8413 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8414 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8415 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8416 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8417 .code
8418 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8419 *@+hostile_domains:\
8420 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8421 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8422 .endd
8423 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8424 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8425 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8426 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8427 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8428
8429 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8430 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8431 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8432 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8433 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8434 .code
8435 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8436 .endd
8437
8438 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8439 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8440 senders:
8441
8442 .ilist
8443 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8444 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8445 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8446 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8447 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8448 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8449 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8450 .code
8451 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8452 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8453 .endd
8454 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8455 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8456
8457 .next
8458 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8459 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8460 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8461 example:
8462 .code
8463 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8464 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8465 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8466 .endd
8467 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8468 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8469 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8470 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8471
8472 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8473 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8474 panic log.
8475 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8476 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8477 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8478 default. For example, with this lookup:
8479 .code
8480 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8481 .endd
8482 the file could contains lines like this:
8483 .code
8484 user1@domain1.example
8485 *@domain2.example
8486 .endd
8487 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8488 that are tried is:
8489 .code
8490 nimrod@jaeger.example
8491 *@jaeger.example
8492 *
8493 .endd
8494 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8495 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8496
8497 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8498 .code
8499 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8500 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8501 .endd
8502 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8503 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8504 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8505 .endlist
8506
8507
8508 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8509 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8510 always fails.
8511
8512
8513 .ilist
8514 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8515 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8516 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8517 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8518 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8519 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8520 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8521 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8522 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8523
8524 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8525 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8526 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8527 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8528 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8529 with
8530 .code
8531 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8532 .endd
8533 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8534 .code
8535 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8536 .endd
8537 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8538
8539 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8540 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8541 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8542 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8543 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8544 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8545 .code
8546 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8547 spammer3 : spammer4
8548 .endd
8549 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8550 doubling.
8551
8552 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8553 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8554 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8555 might have entries like
8556 .code
8557 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8558 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8559 *: ^\d{8}$
8560 .endd
8561 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8562 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8563 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8564 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8565
8566 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8567 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8568 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8569
8570 .next
8571 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8572 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8573 can only return a single list of local parts.
8574 .endlist
8575
8576 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8577 in these two examples:
8578 .code
8579 senders = +my_list
8580 senders = *@+my_list
8581 .endd
8582 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8583 example it is a named domain list.
8584
8585
8586
8587
8588 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8589 .cindex "case of local parts"
8590 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8591 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8592 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8593 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8594 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8595 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8596 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8597 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8598 default.
8599
8600 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8601 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8602 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8603 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8604 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8605 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8606 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8607 case-independent.
8608
8609 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8610 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8611 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8612 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8613 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8614 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8615 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8616 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8617
8618
8619
8620 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8621 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8622 .cindex "local part" "list"
8623 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8624 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8625 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8626 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8627 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8628 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8629 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8630 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8631
8632 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8633 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8634 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8635 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8636 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8637 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8638 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8639 types.
8640 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8641
8642
8643
8644
8645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8647
8648 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8649 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8650 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8651 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8652
8653 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8654 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8655 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8656 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8657 escape character, as described in the following section.
8658
8659 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8660 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8661 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8662 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8663 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8664 reasons.
8665
8666
8667
8668 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8669 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8670 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8671 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8672 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8673 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8674 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8675 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8676
8677 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8678 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8679 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8680 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8681 .code
8682 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8683 .endd
8684 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8685 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8686 string.
8687
8688
8689
8690 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8691 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8692 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8693 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8694 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8695 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8696 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8697 encoding.
8698
8699 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8700 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8701 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8702
8703
8704 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8705 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8706 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8707 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8708 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8709 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8710 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8711 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8712 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8713 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8714 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8715 and &%nhash%&.
8716
8717 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8718 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8719 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8720
8721 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8722 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8723 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8724 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8725 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8726 .code
8727 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8728 .endd
8729 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8730 Exim message identifier. For example:
8731 .code
8732 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8733 .endd
8734 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8735 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8736
8737
8738 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8739 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8740 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8741 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8742 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8743 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8744 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8745 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8746 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8747 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8748 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8749 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8750 being expanded.
8751
8752
8753
8754
8755 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8756 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8757 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8758 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8759 white space is significant.
8760
8761 .vlist
8762 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8763 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8764 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8765 .code
8766 $local_part
8767 ${domain}
8768 .endd
8769 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8770 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8771 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8772 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8773 given, the expansion fails.
8774
8775 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8776 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8777 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8778 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8779 .code
8780 ${lc:$local_part}
8781 .endd
8782 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8783 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8784 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8785 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8786 string easier to understand.
8787
8788 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8789 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8790 expansion item below.
8791
8792
8793 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8794 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8795 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8796 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8797 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8798 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8799 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8800 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8801 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8802 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8803 the result of the expansion.
8804 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8805 the expansion result is an empty string.
8806 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8807
8808
8809 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8810 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8811 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8812 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8813 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8814 .code
8815 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8816 .endd
8817 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8818 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8819 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8820
8821 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8822 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8823 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8824 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8825 must have the following type:
8826 .code
8827 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8828 .endd
8829 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8830 function should return one of the following values:
8831
8832 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8833 into the expanded string that is being built.
8834
8835 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8836 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8837
8838 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8839 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8840
8841 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8842
8843 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8844 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8845 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8846
8847 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8848 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8849 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8850 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8851 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8852 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8853 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8854 form:
8855 .display
8856 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8857 .endd
8858 .vindex "&$value$&"
8859 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8860 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8861 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8862 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8863 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8864 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8865 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8866 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8867 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8868
8869 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8870 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8871 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8872 yield &"2001"&:
8873 .code
8874 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8875 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8876 .endd
8877 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8878 appear, for example:
8879 .code
8880 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8881 .endd
8882 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8883 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8884
8885
8886 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8887 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8888 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8889 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8890 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8891 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8892 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8893 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8894 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8895 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8896 <&'string3'&> as before.
8897
8898 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8899 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8900 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8901 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8902 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8903 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8904 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8905 provided. For example:
8906 .code
8907 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8908 .endd
8909 yields &"42"&, and
8910 .code
8911 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8912 .endd
8913 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8914 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8915
8916
8917 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8918 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8919 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8920 .vindex "&$item$&"
8921 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8922 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8923 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8924 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8925 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8926 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8927 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8928 .code
8929 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8930 .endd
8931 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8932 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8933
8934
8935 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8936 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8937 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8938 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8939 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8940 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8941
8942 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8943 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8944 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8945 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8946 .code
8947 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8948 .endd
8949 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8950 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8951 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8952 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8953 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8954 .code
8955 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8956 .endd
8957 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8958 letters appear. For example:
8959 .display
8960 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8961 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8962 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8963 .endd
8964
8965 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8966 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8967 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8968 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8969 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8970 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8971 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8972 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8973 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8974 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8975 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8976 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8977 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8978 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8979 .code
8980 $header_reply-to:
8981 .endd
8982 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8983 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8984 lines) may be present.
8985
8986 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8987 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8988
8989 .ilist
8990 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8991 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8992 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8993
8994 .next
8995 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8996 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8997 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8998 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8999 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9000 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9001 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9002 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9003
9004 .next
9005 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9006 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9007 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9008 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9009 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9010 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9011 .endlist ilist
9012
9013 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9014 command of the following form:
9015 .code
9016 headers charset "UTF-8"
9017 .endd
9018 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9019 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9020 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9021 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9022 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9023 ISO-8859-1.
9024
9025 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9026 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9027 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9028 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9029
9030 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9031 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9032 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9033 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9034 router or transport are not accessible.
9035
9036 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9037 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9038 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9039 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9040 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9041 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9042
9043 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9044 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9045 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9046 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9047 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9048 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9049 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9050
9051 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9052 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9053 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9054 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9055 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9056 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9057 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9058 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9059
9060
9061 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9062 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9063 .cindex &%hmac%&
9064 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9065 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9066 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9067 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9068 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9069 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9070 present. For example:
9071 .code
9072 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9073 .endd
9074 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9075 produces:
9076 .code
9077 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9078 .endd
9079 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9080 an Exim configuration:
9081 .code
9082 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9083 .endd
9084 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9085 .code
9086 headers_add = \
9087 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9088 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9089 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9090 .endd
9091 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9092 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9093 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9094 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9095 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9096 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9097
9098
9099 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9100 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9101 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9102 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9103 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9104 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9105 .code
9106 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9107 .endd
9108 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9109 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9110 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9111 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9112 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9113
9114 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9115 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9116 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9117 .code
9118 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9119 .endd
9120 you can use
9121 .code
9122 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9123 .endd
9124
9125 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9126 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9127 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9128 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9129 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9130 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9131 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9132 some of the braces:
9133 .code
9134 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9135 .endd
9136 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9137 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9138 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9139
9140
9141 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9142 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9143 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9144 described in the next item.
9145
9146 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9147 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9148 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9149 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9150 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9151 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9152 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9153 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9154 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9155
9156 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9157 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9158 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9159 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9160 out by the system administrator.
9161
9162 .vindex "&$value$&"
9163 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9164 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9165 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9166 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9167 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9168 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9169 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9170 original lookup fails.
9171
9172 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9173 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9174 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9175 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9176 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9177 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9178 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9179 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9180
9181 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9182 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9183 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9184 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9185
9186 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9187 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9188 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9189 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9190
9191 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9192 .code
9193 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9194 .endd
9195 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9196 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9197 .code
9198 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9199 {$value}fail}
9200 .endd
9201
9202
9203 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9204 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9205 .vindex "&$item$&"
9206 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9207 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9208 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9209 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9210 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9211 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9212 .code
9213 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9214 .endd
9215 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9216 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9217 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9218
9219 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9220 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9221 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9222 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9223 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9224 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9225 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9226 .code
9227 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9228 .endd
9229 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9230 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9231 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9232 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9233 example,
9234 .code
9235 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9236 .endd
9237 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9238
9239
9240
9241 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9242 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9243 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9244 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9245 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9246 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9247 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9248 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9249
9250 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9251 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9252 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9253 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9254 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9255 not its contents.
9256
9257 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9258 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9259 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9260
9261 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9262 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9263
9264
9265 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9266 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9267 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9268 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9269 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9270 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9271 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9272 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9273
9274 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9275 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9276 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9277 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9278 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9279 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9280 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9281 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9282 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9283 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9284
9285 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9286 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9287 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9288 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9289
9290 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9291 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9292 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9293 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9294 is the expansion of the third argument.
9295
9296 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9297 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9298 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9299
9300 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9301 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9302 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9303 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9304 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9305 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9306 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9307 newlines are left in the string.
9308 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9309 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9310 the string expansion fails.
9311
9312 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9313 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9314
9315
9316
9317 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9318 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9319 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9320 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9321 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9322 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9323 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9324 examples:
9325 .code
9326 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9327 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9328 .endd
9329 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9330 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9331 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9332 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9333 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9334 example:
9335 .code
9336 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9337 .endd
9338 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9339 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9340 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9341 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9342 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9343 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9344 .code
9345 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9346 .endd
9347 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9348 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9349 turns them into spaces:
9350 .code
9351 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9352 .endd
9353 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9354 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9355 addition, the following errors can occur:
9356
9357 .ilist
9358 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9359 .next
9360 Failure to connect the socket;
9361 .next
9362 Failure to write the request string;
9363 .next
9364 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9365 .endlist
9366
9367 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9368 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9369 errors occurs. For example:
9370 .code
9371 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9372 {socket failure}}
9373 .endd
9374 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9375 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9376 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9377 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9378 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9379
9380 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9381 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9382
9383
9384 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9385 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9386 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9387 .vindex "&$value$&"
9388 .vindex "&$item$&"
9389 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9390 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9391 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9392 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9393 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9394 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9395 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9396 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9397 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9398 .code
9399 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9400 .endd
9401 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9402 can be found:
9403 .code
9404 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9405 .endd
9406 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9407 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9408 expansion items.
9409
9410 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9411 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9412 expansion item above.
9413
9414 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9415 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9416 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9417 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9418 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9419 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9420 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9421 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9422
9423 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9424 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9425 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9426 .vindex "&$value$&"
9427 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9428 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9429 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9430 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9431 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9432 &$value$&.
9433
9434 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9435 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9436 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9437 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9438
9439 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9440 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9441 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9442 troubleshoot:
9443 .code
9444 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9445 log_message = Output of id: $value
9446 .endd
9447 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9448 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9449 .code
9450 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9451 .endd
9452
9453 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9454 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9455 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9456 .code
9457 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9458 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9459 ...
9460 endif
9461 .endd
9462 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9463 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9464 commands.
9465
9466 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9467 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9468 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9469 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9470
9471 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9472 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9473
9474
9475 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9476 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9477 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9478 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9479 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9480 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9481 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9482 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9483 .code
9484 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9485 .endd
9486 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9487 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9488 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9489 .code
9490 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9491 .endd
9492 yields &"defabc"&, and
9493 .code
9494 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9495 .endd
9496 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9497 the regular expression from string expansion.
9498
9499
9500
9501 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9502 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9503 .cindex "substring extraction"
9504 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9505 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9506 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9507 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9508 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9509 .code
9510 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9511 .endd
9512 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9513 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9514 omitted.
9515
9516 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9517 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9518 length required. For example
9519 .code
9520 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9521 .endd
9522 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9523 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9524 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9525 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9526
9527 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9528 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9529 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9530 .code
9531 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9532 .endd
9533 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9534 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9535 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9536 .code
9537 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9538 .endd
9539 yields an empty string, but
9540 .code
9541 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9542 .endd
9543 yields &"1"&.
9544
9545 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9546 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9547 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9548 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9549 .code
9550 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9551 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9552 .endd
9553 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9554
9555
9556
9557 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9558 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9559 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9560 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9561 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9562 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9563 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9564 replacement list. For example
9565 .code
9566 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9567 .endd
9568 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9569 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9570 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9571 place.
9572 .endlist
9573
9574
9575
9576 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9577 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9578 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9579 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9580 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9581 following operations can be performed:
9582
9583 .vlist
9584 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9585 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9586 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9587 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9588 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9589 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9590
9591
9592 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9593 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9594 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9595 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9596 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9597 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9598 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9599 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9600 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9601
9602 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9603 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9604 character. For example:
9605 .code
9606 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9607 .endd
9608 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9609 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9610 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9611 processing lists.
9612
9613
9614 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9615 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9616 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9617 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9618 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9619 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9620 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9621 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9622 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9623
9624 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9625 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9626 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9627 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9628 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9629 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9630 string.
9631
9632
9633 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9634 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9635 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9636 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9637 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9638
9639
9640 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9641 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9642 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9643 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9644 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9645 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9646 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9647
9648
9649 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9650 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9651 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9652 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9653 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9654 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9655 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9656 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9657 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9658 C programming language):
9659 .table2 70pt 300pt
9660 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9661 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9662 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9663 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9664 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9665 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9666 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9667 .endtable
9668 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9669 space is permitted before or after operators.
9670
9671 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9672 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9673 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9674 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9675 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9676
9677 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9678 or 1024*1024*1024,
9679 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9680 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9681
9682 .display
9683 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9684 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9685 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9686 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9687 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9688 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9689 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9690 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9691 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9692 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9693 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9694 .endd
9695
9696 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9697 .code
9698 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9699 condition = \
9700 ${if and { \
9701 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9702 { \
9703 < \
9704 {$recipients_count} \
9705 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9706 } \
9707 }{yes}{no}}
9708 .endd
9709 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9710 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9711
9712
9713 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9714 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9715 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9716 example,
9717 .code
9718 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9719 .endd
9720 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9721 and then re-expands what it has found.
9722
9723
9724 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9725 .cindex "Unicode"
9726 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9727 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9728 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9729 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9730 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9731 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9732 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9733 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9734 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9735
9736 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9737 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9738 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9739 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9740 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9741 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9742 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9743
9744
9745 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9746 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9747 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9748 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9749 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9750 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9751 .code
9752 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9753 .endd
9754 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9755 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9756
9757
9758
9759 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9760 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9761 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9762 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9763 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9764 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9765
9766
9767 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9768 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9769 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9770 .cindex "lower casing"
9771 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9772 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9773 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9774 .code
9775 ${lc:$local_part}
9776 .endd
9777
9778 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9779 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9780 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9781 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9782 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9783 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9784 .code
9785 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9786 .endd
9787 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9788 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9789 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9790
9791
9792 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9793 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9794 .cindex "list" "item count"
9795 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9796 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9797 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9798
9799
9800 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${list_*&<&'type'&>&*name*&>&*}*&
9801 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9802 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9803 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9804 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9805 If the optional type if given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9806 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9807 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9808 matching list is returned.
9809
9810
9811 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9812 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9813 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9814 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9815 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9816 empty.
9817
9818
9819 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9820 .cindex "masked IP address"
9821 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9822 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9823 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9824 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9825 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9826 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9827 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9828 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9829 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9830 .code
9831 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9832 .endd
9833 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9834 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9835 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9836 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9837 .code
9838 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9839 .endd
9840 returns the string
9841 .code
9842 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9843 .endd
9844 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9845
9846
9847 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9848 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9849 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9850 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9851 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9852 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9853
9854
9855 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9856 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9857 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9858 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9859 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9860 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9861 .code
9862 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9863 .endd
9864 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9865
9866
9867 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9868 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9869 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9870 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9871 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9872 is an empty string or
9873 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9874 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9875 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9876 respectively For example,
9877 .code
9878 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9879 .endd
9880 becomes
9881 .code
9882 "ab\"*\"cd"
9883 .endd
9884 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9885 variable or a message header.
9886
9887 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9888 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9889 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9890 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9891 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9892 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9893 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9894
9895
9896 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9897 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9898 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9899 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9900 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9901 .code
9902 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9903 .endd
9904 returns
9905 .code
9906 two%20%5C2A%20two
9907 .endd
9908 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9909 yields an unchanged string.
9910
9911
9912 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9913 .cindex "random number"
9914 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9915 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9916 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9917 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9918 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9919 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9920 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9921 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9922 random().
9923
9924
9925 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9926 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9927 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9928 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9929 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9930 for DNS. For example,
9931 .code
9932 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9933 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
9934 .endd
9935 returns
9936 .code
9937 4.2.0.192
9938 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9939 .endd
9940
9941
9942 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9943 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9944 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9945 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9946 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9947 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9948 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9949 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9950 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9951 characters
9952 .code
9953 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9954 .endd
9955 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9956 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9957 characters.
9958
9959
9960 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9961 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9962 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9963 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9964 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9965 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9966 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9967 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9968
9969 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9970 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9971 to use this operator as well.
9972
9973
9974
9975 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9976 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9977 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9978 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9979 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9980 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9981 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9982
9983
9984 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9985 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9986 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9987 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9988 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9989 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9990
9991
9992 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9993 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9994 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9995 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9996 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9997 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9998 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9999 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10000 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10001 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10002 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10003 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10004 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10005
10006 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10007 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10008 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10009
10010 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10011 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10012 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10013 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10014 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10015
10016
10017
10018 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10019 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10020 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10021 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10022 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10023 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10024
10025
10026 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10027 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10028 .cindex "substring extraction"
10029 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10030 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10031 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10032 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10033 .code
10034 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10035 .endd
10036 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10037 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10038
10039 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10040 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10041 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10042 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10043 seconds.
10044
10045 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10046 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10047 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10048 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10049 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10050 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10051 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10052
10053 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10054 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10055 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10056 .cindex "upper casing"
10057 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10058 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10059 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10060 .endlist
10061
10062
10063
10064
10065
10066
10067 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10068 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10069 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10070 while expanding strings:
10071
10072 .vlist
10073 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10074 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10075 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10076 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10077 condition.
10078
10079 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10080 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10081 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10082 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10083 are:
10084 .display
10085 &`= `& equal
10086 &`== `& equal
10087 &`> `& greater
10088 &`>= `& greater or equal
10089 &`< `& less
10090 &`<= `& less or equal
10091 .endd
10092 For example:
10093 .code
10094 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10095 .endd
10096 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10097 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10098 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10099 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10100 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10101 zero.
10102
10103 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10104 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10105 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10106
10107
10108 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10109 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10110 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10111 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10112 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10113 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10114 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10115 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10116 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10117 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10118 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10119 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10120 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10121 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10122
10123 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10124 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10125 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10126 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10127 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10128 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10129 false if zero.
10130 An empty string is treated as false.
10131 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10132 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10133 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10134
10135 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10136 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10137 For example:
10138 .code
10139 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10140 .endd
10141
10142
10143 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10144 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10145 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10146 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10147 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10148 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10149 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10150 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10151
10152 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10153
10154 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10155 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10156 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10157 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10158 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10159 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10160 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10161 included in the binary.
10162
10163 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10164 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10165 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10166 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10167 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10168 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10169 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10170 string in LDAP form is:
10171 .code
10172 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10173 .endd
10174 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10175 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10176 .code
10177 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10178 .endd
10179 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10180 supported:
10181
10182 .ilist
10183 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10184 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10185 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10186 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10187 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10188 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10189 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10190 comparison fails.
10191
10192 .next
10193 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10194 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10195 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10196 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10197 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10198 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10199
10200 .next
10201 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10202 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10203 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10204 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10205 whatever its length.
10206
10207 .next
10208 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10209 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10210 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10211 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10212 .endlist
10213 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10214 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10215 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10216 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10217 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10218 support &[crypt16()]&.
10219
10220 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10221 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10222 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10223 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10224 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10225
10226 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10227 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10228 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10229
10230 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10231 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10232 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10233 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10234 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10235
10236 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10237 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10238 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10239 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10240 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10241 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10242 .code
10243 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10244 .endd
10245 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10246 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10247
10248 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10249 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10250 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10251 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10252 exists in the message. For example,
10253 .code
10254 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10255 .endd
10256 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10257 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10258
10259 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10260 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10261 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10262 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10263 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10264 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10265 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10266 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10267 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10268
10269 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10270 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10271 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10272 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10273 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10274 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10275 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10276 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10277
10278 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10279 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10280 .cindex "first delivery"
10281 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10282 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10283 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10284 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10285
10286
10287 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10288 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10289 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10290 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10291 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10292 .vindex "&$item$&"
10293 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10294 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10295 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10296 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10297 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10298 .ilist
10299 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10300 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10301 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10302 .next
10303 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10304 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10305 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10306 .endlist
10307 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10308 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10309 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10310 list separator is changed to a comma:
10311 .code
10312 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10313 .endd
10314 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10315 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10316
10317
10318 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10319 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10320 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10321 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10322 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10323 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10324 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10325 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10326 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10327 case-independent.
10328
10329 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10330 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10331 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10332 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10333 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10334 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10335 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10336 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10337 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10338 case-independent.
10339
10340 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10341 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10342 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10343 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10344 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10345 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10346 is true.
10347
10348 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10349 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10350 .code
10351 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10352 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10353 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10354 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10355 .endd
10356
10357 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10358 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10359 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10360 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10361 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10362 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10363 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10364 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10365 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10366 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10367 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10368
10369 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10370 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10371 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10372 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10373 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10374
10375 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10376 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10377 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10378 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10379 .code
10380 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10381 .endd
10382 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10383
10384 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10385 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10386 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10387 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10388 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10389 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10390 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10391 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10392 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10393 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10394 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10395 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10396 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10397 this can be used.
10398
10399
10400 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10401 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10402 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10403 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10404 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10405 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10406 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10407 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10408 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10409 case-independent.
10410
10411 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10412 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10413 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10414 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10415 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10416 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10417 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10418 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10419 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10420 case-independent.
10421
10422
10423 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10424 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10425 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10426 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10427 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10428 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10429 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10430 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10431 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10432 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10433 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10434 For example,
10435 .code
10436 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10437 .endd
10438 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10439 backslashes is also required.
10440
10441 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10442 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10443 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10444 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10445 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10446 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10447
10448 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10449 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10450 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10451 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10452 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10453 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10454 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10455 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10456
10457 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10458 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10459 See &*match_local_part*&.
10460
10461 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10462 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10463 See &*match_local_part*&.
10464
10465 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10466 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10467 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10468 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10469 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10470 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10471 .code
10472 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10473 .endd
10474 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10475
10476 .ilist
10477 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10478 .next
10479 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10480 .next
10481 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10482 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10483 in a single test such as
10484 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10485 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10486 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10487 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10488 .code
10489 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10490 .endd
10491 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10492 .next
10493 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10494 .next
10495 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10496 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10497 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10498 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10499 masks. For example:
10500 .code
10501 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10502 .endd
10503 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10504 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10505 address mask, for example:
10506 .code
10507 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10508 .endd
10509 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10510 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10511 .code
10512 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10513 .endd
10514 .endlist ilist
10515
10516 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10517 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10518
10519 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10520
10521 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10522 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10523 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10524 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10525 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10526 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10527 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10528 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10529 example is:
10530 .code
10531 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10532 .endd
10533 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10534 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10535 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10536 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10537 .code
10538 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10539 .endd
10540 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10541 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10542 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10543 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10544 caselessly.
10545
10546 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10547 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10548
10549 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10550 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10551 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10552 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10553
10554 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10555 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10556 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10557 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10558 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10559 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10560 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10561 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10562 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10563 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10564 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10565 .code
10566 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10567 .endd
10568 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10569 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10570
10571 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10572 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10573 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10574 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10575 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10576 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10577 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10578
10579 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10580 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10581 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10582 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10583 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10584 .code
10585 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10586 .endd
10587 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10588 .code
10589 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10590 .endd
10591 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10592 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10593 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10594 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10595 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10596 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10597 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10598 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10599
10600
10601 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10602 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10603 .cindex "Cyrus"
10604 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10605 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10606 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10607 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10608 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10609 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10610
10611 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10612 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10613 building Exim. For example:
10614 .code
10615 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10616 .endd
10617 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10618 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10619 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10620 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10621
10622 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10623 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10624 configuration, you might have this:
10625 .code
10626 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10627 .endd
10628 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10629 .code
10630 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10631 .endd
10632 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10633 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10634 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10635 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10636 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10637 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10638
10639
10640 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10641 .cindex "Radius"
10642 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10643 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10644 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10645 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10646 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10647 support.
10648
10649 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10650 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10651 this library, you need to set
10652 .code
10653 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10654 .endd
10655 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10656 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10657 .code
10658 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10659 .endd
10660 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10661 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10662 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10663
10664 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10665 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10666 the authentication is successful. For example:
10667 .code
10668 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10669 .endd
10670
10671
10672 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10673 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10674 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10675 .cindex "Cyrus"
10676 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10677 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10678 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10679 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10680 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10681 by a process that is not running as root.
10682
10683 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10684 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10685 building Exim. For example:
10686 .code
10687 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10688 .endd
10689 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10690 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10691 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10692
10693 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10694 two are mandatory. For example:
10695 .code
10696 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10697 .endd
10698 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10699 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10700 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10701 .endlist vlist
10702
10703
10704
10705 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10706 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10707 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10708 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10709 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10710 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10711 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10712
10713
10714 .vlist
10715 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10716 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10717 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10718 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10719 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10720 For example,
10721 .code
10722 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10723 .endd
10724 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10725 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10726 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10727
10728 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10729 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10730 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10731 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10732 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10733 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10734 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10735 parsed but not evaluated.
10736 .endlist
10737 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10738
10739
10740
10741
10742 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10743 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10744 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10745 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10746 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10747
10748 .vlist
10749 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10750 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10751 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10752 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10753 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10754 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10755 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10756 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10757 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10758 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10759 matching condition.
10760
10761 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10762 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10763 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10764 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10765 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10766 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10767 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10768 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10769 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10770 during subsequent delivery.
10771
10772 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10773 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10774 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10775 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10776 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10777 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10778 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10779 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10780 delivery.
10781
10782 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10783 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10784 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10785 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10786 be preserved by coding like this:
10787 .code
10788 warn !verify = sender
10789 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10790 .endd
10791 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10792 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10793 failure.
10794
10795 .vitem &$address_data$&
10796 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10797 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10798 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10799 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10800 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10801 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10802 user filter files.
10803
10804 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10805 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10806 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10807 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10808 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10809 from the child's routing.
10810
10811 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10812 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10813 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10814 address.
10815
10816 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10817 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10818 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10819
10820 .vitem &$address_file$&
10821 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10822 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10823 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10824 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10825 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10826 .code
10827 /home/r2d2/savemail
10828 .endd
10829 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10830 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10832 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10833 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10834 to the relevant file.
10835
10836 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10837 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10838 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10839 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10840
10841 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10842 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10843 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10844 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10845
10846 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10847 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10848 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10849 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10850 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10851 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10852 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10853 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10854 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10855 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10856 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10857 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10858 command line option.
10859
10860
10861
10862
10863 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10864 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10865 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10866 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10867 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10868 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10869 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10870 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10871 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10872 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10873 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10874
10875 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10876 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10877 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10878 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10879 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10880
10881
10882 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10883 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10884 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10885 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10886 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10887 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10888 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10889 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10890 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10891 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10892 an undefined mechanism.
10893
10894 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10895 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10896 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10897 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10898 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10899 the ACL malware condition.
10900
10901 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10902 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10903 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10904 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10905 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10906 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10907
10908 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10909 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10910 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10911 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10912 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10913 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10914 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10915
10916 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10917 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10918 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10919 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10920 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10921
10922 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10923 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10924 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10925 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10926 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10927
10928 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10929 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10930 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10931 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10932 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10933 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10934 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10935
10936 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10937 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10938 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10939 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10940 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10941 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10942 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10943
10944 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10945 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10946 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10947
10948 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10949 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10950 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10951 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10952 compilations of the same version of the program.
10953
10954 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10955 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10956 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10957 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10958 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10959
10960 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10961 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10962 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10963 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10964 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10965
10966 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10967 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10968 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10969 &$dnslist_value$&
10970 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10971 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10972 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10973 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10974 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10975 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10976 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10977 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10978 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10979
10980 .vitem &$domain$&
10981 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10982 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10983 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10984 case for &$domain$&.
10985
10986 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10987 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10988 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10989 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10990
10991 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10992 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10993 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10994 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10995 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10996 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10997
10998 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10999 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11000 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11001
11002 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11003
11004 .ilist
11005 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11006 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11007 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11008 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11009 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11010 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11011 the &(smtp)& transport.
11012
11013 .next
11014 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11015 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11016 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11017 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11018
11019 .next
11020 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11021 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11022 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11023 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11024 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11025 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11026
11027 .next
11028 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11029 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11030 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11031 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11032 .endlist
11033
11034
11035 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11036 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11037 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11038 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11039 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11040 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11041 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11042 used.
11043
11044 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11045 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11046 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11047 to nothing.
11048
11049 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11050 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11051 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11052
11053 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11054 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11055 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11056
11057 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11058 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11059 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11060
11061 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11062 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11063 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11064 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11065 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11066
11067 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11068 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11069 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11070 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11071 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11072
11073 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11074 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11075 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11076 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11077 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11078
11079 .vitem &$home$&
11080 .vindex "&$home$&"
11081 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11082 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11083 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11084 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11085 by a setting on the transport itself.
11086
11087 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11088 of the environment variable HOME.
11089
11090 .vitem &$host$&
11091 .vindex "&$host$&"
11092 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11093 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11094 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11095 to local and remote transports.
11096
11097 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11098 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11099 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11100 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11101 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11102 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11103 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11104 is connected.
11105
11106 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11107 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11108 client is connected.
11109
11110
11111 .vitem &$host_address$&
11112 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11113 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11114 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11115 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11116
11117 .vitem &$host_data$&
11118 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11119 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11120 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11121 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11122 .code
11123 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11124 message = $host_data
11125 .endd
11126 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11127 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11128 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11129 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11130 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11131 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11132 variables is set to &"1"&.
11133
11134 .ilist
11135 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11136 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11137
11138 .next
11139 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11140 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11141 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11142 .endlist ilist
11143
11144 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11145 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11146 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11147 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11148 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11149 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11150 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11151 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11152 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11153 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11154
11155 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11156 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11157 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11158
11159
11160 .vitem &$inode$&
11161 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11162 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11163 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11164 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11165 a unique name for the file.
11166
11167 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11168 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11169 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11170
11171 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11172 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11173 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11174
11175 .vitem &$item$&
11176 .vindex "&$item$&"
11177 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11178 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11179 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11180 empty.
11181
11182 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11183 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11184 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11185 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11186 lookup.
11187
11188 .vitem &$load_average$&
11189 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11190 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11191 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11192 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11193
11194 .vitem &$local_part$&
11195 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11196 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11197 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11198 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11199 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11200
11201 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11202 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11203 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11204 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11205 once.
11206
11207 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11208 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11209 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11210 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11211 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11212 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11213
11214 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11215 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11216 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11217 &$address_pipe$&).
11218
11219 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11220 local part of the recipient address.
11221
11222 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11223 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11224 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11225
11226 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11227 the addresses
11228 .code
11229 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11230 abc\:xyz@test.example
11231 .endd
11232 the value of &$local_part$& is
11233 .code
11234 abc:xyz
11235 .endd
11236 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11237 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11238 have:
11239 .code
11240 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11241 .endd
11242 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11243 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11244 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11245
11246 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11247 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11248 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11249 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11250 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11251 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11252 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11253
11254 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11255 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11256 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11257 variable expands to nothing.
11258
11259 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11260 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11261 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11262 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11263 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11264
11265 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11266 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11267 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11268 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11269 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11270
11271 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11272 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11273 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11274 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11275
11276 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11277 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11278 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11279
11280 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11281 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11282 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11283 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11284 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11285 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11286 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11287 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11288
11289 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11290 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11291 This contains the expanded value of the
11292 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11293 been read.
11294
11295 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11296 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11297 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11298 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11299 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11300 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11301
11302 .vitem &$log_space$&
11303 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11304 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11305 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11306 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11307 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11308 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11309
11310
11311 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11312 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11313 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11314 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11315 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11316 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11317 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11318 variable is empty.
11319
11320 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11321 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11322 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11323 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11324 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11325
11326 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11327 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11328 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11329 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11330 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11331 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11332 character(s).
11333
11334 .vitem &$message_age$&
11335 .cindex "message" "age of"
11336 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11337 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11338 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11339 delivery attempt.
11340
11341 .vitem &$message_body$&
11342 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11343 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11344 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11345 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11346 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11347 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11348 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11349 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11350 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11351
11352 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11353 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11354 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11355 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11356 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11357
11358 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11359 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11360 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11361 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11362 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11363 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11364 &$message_body$&.
11365
11366 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11367 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11368 .cindex "message body" "size"
11369 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11370 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11371 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11372 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11373 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11374
11375 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11376 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11377 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11378 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11379 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11380 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11381 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11382 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11383
11384 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11385 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11386 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11387 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11388 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11389 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11390
11391 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11392 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11393 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11394 contents of header lines is done.
11395
11396 .vitem &$message_id$&
11397 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11398
11399 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11400 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11401 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11402 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11403 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11404 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11405 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11406 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11407 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11408 from the body is not counted.
11409
11410 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11411 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11412 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11413 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11414 header and the body).
11415
11416 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11417 .code
11418 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11419 condition = \
11420 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11421 .endd
11422 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11423 message has not yet been received.
11424
11425 .vitem &$message_size$&
11426 .cindex "size" "of message"
11427 .cindex "message" "size"
11428 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11429 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11430 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11431 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11432 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11433 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11434 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11435 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11436 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11437
11438 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11439 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11440 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11441 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11442
11443 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11444 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11445 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11446 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11447
11448 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11449 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11450 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11451
11452 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11453 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11454 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11455 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11456 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11457 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11458 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11459 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11460 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11461 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11462
11463 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11464 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11465 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11466
11467 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11468 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11469 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11470 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11471 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11472 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11473 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11474 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11475 the original address.
11476
11477 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11478 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11479 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11480 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11481 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11482
11483 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11484 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11485 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11486
11487 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11488 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11489 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11490 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11491 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11492 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11493 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11494 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11495 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11496
11497 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11498 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11499 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11500 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11501 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11502 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11503 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11504 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11505 user.
11506
11507 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11508 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11509 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11510 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11511
11512 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11513 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11514 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11515 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11516
11517 .vitem &$pid$&
11518 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11519 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11520 This variable contains the current process id.
11521
11522 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11523 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11524 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11525 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11526 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11527 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11528 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11529 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11530 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11531 variable"& error if encountered.
11532
11533 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11534 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11535 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11536 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11537 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11538 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11539 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11540
11541
11542 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11543 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11544 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11545 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11546
11547 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11548 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11549 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11550 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11551
11552 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11553 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11554 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11555 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11556
11557 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11558 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11559 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11560
11561 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11562 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11563 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11564 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11565
11566 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11567 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11568 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11569 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11570 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11571
11572 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11573 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11574 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11575 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11576 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11577 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11578
11579 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11580 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11581 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11582 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11583 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11584
11585 .vitem &$received_count$&
11586 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11587 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11588 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11589 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11590 delivering.
11591
11592 .vitem &$received_for$&
11593 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11594 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11595 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11596 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11597 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11598
11599 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11600 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11601 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11602 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11603 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11604 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11605 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11606 option.
11607
11608 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11609 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11610 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11611 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11612 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11613 time.
11614
11615 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11616 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11617 &(smtp)& transport).
11618
11619 .vitem &$received_port$&
11620 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11621 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11622
11623 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11624 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11625 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11626 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11627 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11628 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11629 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11630 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11631 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11632
11633 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11634 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11635 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11636 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11637 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11638 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11639
11640 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11641 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11642 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11643
11644 .vitem &$received_time$&
11645 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11646 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11647 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11648
11649 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11650 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11651 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11652 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11653 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11654 .display
11655 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11656 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11657 .endd
11658 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11659 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11660 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11661 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11662
11663 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11664 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11665 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11666 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11667
11668 .ilist
11669 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11670 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11671
11672 .next
11673 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11674
11675 .next
11676 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11677 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11678 MAIL).
11679
11680 .next
11681 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11682 .next
11683
11684 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11685 .endlist
11686
11687 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11688 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11689
11690 .vitem &$recipients$&
11691 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11692 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11693 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11694 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11695 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11696 cases:
11697
11698 .olist
11699 In a system filter file.
11700 .next
11701 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11702 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11703 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11704 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11705 .next
11706 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11707 .endlist
11708
11709
11710 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11711 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11712 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11713 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11714 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11715 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11716
11717
11718 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11719 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11720 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11721 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11722
11723
11724 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11725 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11726 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11727 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11728 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11729 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11730 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11731
11732 .vitem &$return_path$&
11733 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11734 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11735 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11736 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11737 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11738 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11739 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11740 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11741 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11742 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11743 envelope sender.
11744
11745 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11746 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11747 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11748
11749 .vitem &$runrc$&
11750 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11751 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11752 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11753 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11754 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11755 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11756 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11757 another.
11758
11759 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11760 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11761 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11762 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11763 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11764 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11765 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11766 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11767
11768 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11769 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11770 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11771 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11772 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11773 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11774
11775 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11776 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11777 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11778 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11779 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11780 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11781 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11782 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11783
11784 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11785 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11786 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11787
11788 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11789 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11790 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11791
11792 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11793 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11794 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11795 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11796 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11797 this:
11798 .display
11799 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11800 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11801 .endd
11802 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11803 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11804 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11805 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11806
11807 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11808 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11809 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11810 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11811 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11812 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11813 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11814 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11815 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11816 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11817 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11818 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11819 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11820
11821 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11822 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11823 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11824 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11825 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11826 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11827
11828 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11829 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11830 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11831 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11832
11833 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11834 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11835 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11836 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11837 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11838 &$authenticated_id$&.
11839
11840 .new
11841 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11842 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11843 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11844 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11845 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11846 other times, this variable is false.
11847
11848 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11849 library, by setting:
11850 .code
11851 dns_use_dnssec = 1
11852 .endd
11853
11854 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11855 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11856
11857 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11858 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11859
11860 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11861 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11862 .wen
11863
11864
11865 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11866 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11867 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11868 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11869 other means, this variable is empty.
11870
11871 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11872 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11873 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11874 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11875 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11876 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11877 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11878
11879 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11880 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11881 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11882 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11883
11884 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11885 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11886 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11887 is set to &"1"&.
11888
11889 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11890 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11891 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11892 following are true:
11893
11894 .ilist
11895 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11896 .next
11897 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11898 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11899 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11900 .next
11901 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11902 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11903 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11904 .next
11905 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11906 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11907 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11908 .next
11909 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11910 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11911 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11912 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11913 .code
11914 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11915 .endd
11916 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11917 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11918 .endlist
11919
11920
11921 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11922 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11923 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11924 number that was used on the remote host.
11925
11926 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11927 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11928 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11929 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11930 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11931 called Exim.
11932
11933 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11934 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11935 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11936 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11937
11938 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11939 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11940 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11941 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11942 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11943 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11944 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11945 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11946 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11947 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11948 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11949 the parentheses.
11950
11951 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11952 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11953 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11954 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11955 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11956
11957 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11958 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11959 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11960 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11961 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11962
11963 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11964 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11965 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11966 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11967 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11968 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11969 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11970
11971 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11972 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11973 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11974 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11975 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11976
11977 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11978 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11979 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11980 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11981 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11982 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11983
11984 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11985 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11986 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11987 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11988 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11989 .code
11990 MAIL FROM:<>
11991 MAIL FROM: <>
11992 .endd
11993 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11994 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11995 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11996 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11997
11998 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11999 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12000 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12001 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12002 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12003 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12004 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12005
12006 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12007 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12008 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12009 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12010 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12011 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12012 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12013 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12014 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12015 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12016 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12017
12018 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12019 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12020 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12021 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12022 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12023 message is junk mail.
12024
12025 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12026 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12027 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12028 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12029
12030
12031 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12032 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12033 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12034
12035 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12036 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12037 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12038 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12039 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12040 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12041
12042 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12043 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12044 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12045 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12046 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12047 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12048 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12049 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12050 .code
12051 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12052 .endd
12053 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12054
12055
12056 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12057 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12058 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12059 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12060 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12061 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12062
12063 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12064 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12065 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12066 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12067 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12068 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12069 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12070 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12071
12072 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12073 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12074 the outbound.
12075
12076 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12077 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12078 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12079 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12080 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12081 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12082
12083 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12084 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12085 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12086 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12087
12088 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12089 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12090 the outbound.
12091
12092 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12093 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12094 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12095 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12096 and &"0"& otherwise.
12097
12098 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12099 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12100 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12101 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12102 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12103 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12104 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12105 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12106 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12107
12108 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12109 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12110 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12111
12112 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12113 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12114 This variable is
12115 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12116 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12117 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12118 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12119
12120 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12121 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12122 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12123 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12124 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12125 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12126 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12127
12128 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12129 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12130 the outbound.
12131
12132 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12133 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12134 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12135 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12136 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12137 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12138
12139 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12140 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12141 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12142 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12143 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12144 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12145 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12146 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12147 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12148 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12149 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12150
12151 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12152 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12153 the outbound.
12154
12155 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12156 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12157 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12158 During outbound
12159 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12160 the transport.
12161
12162 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12163 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12164 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12165 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12166
12167 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12168 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12169 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12170
12171 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12172 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12173 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12174
12175 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12176 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12177 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12178 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12179 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12180 values for those that are behind (west).
12181
12182 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12183 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12184 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12185 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12186
12187 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12188 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12189 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12190 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12191 flag.
12192
12193 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12194 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12195 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12196 -0500.
12197
12198 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12199 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12200 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12201 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12202
12203 .vitem &$value$&
12204 .vindex "&$value$&"
12205 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12206 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12207 &*reduce*& expansion.
12208
12209 .vitem &$version_number$&
12210 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12211 The version number of Exim.
12212
12213 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12214 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12215 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12216 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12217
12218 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12219 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12220 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12221 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12222 .endlist
12223 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12224
12225
12226
12227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12229
12230 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12231 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12232 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12233 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12234 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12235 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12236 the line
12237 .code
12238 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12239 .endd
12240 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12241
12242
12243 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12244 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12245 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12246 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12247 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12248 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12249 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12250 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12251 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12252
12253 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12254 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12255 should usually be something like
12256 .code
12257 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12258 .endd
12259 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12260 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12261 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12262 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12263 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12264 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12265 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12266 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12267 two ways:
12268
12269 .ilist
12270 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12271 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12272 a startup when Exim is entered.
12273 .next
12274 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12275 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12276 .endlist
12277
12278 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12279 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12280
12281
12282 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12283 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12284 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12285 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12286 forms:
12287 .code
12288 ${perl{foo}}
12289 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12290 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12291 .endd
12292 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12293 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12294 with an error message of the form
12295 .code
12296 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12297 .endd
12298 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12299 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12300 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12301 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12302 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12303 that was passed to &%die%&.
12304
12305
12306 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12307 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12308 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12309 the Perl code
12310 .code
12311 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12312 .endd
12313 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12314 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12315 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12316
12317 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12318 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12319 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12320 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12321
12322 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12323 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12324 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12325 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12326 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12327 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12328 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12329
12330
12331 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12332 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12333 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12334 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12335 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12336 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12337 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12338 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12339 avoided, but the output is lost.
12340
12341 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12342 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12343 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12344 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12345 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12346 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12347 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12348 .code
12349 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12350 .endd
12351 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12352 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12353 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12354 as the first subroutine argument.
12355 .ecindex IIDperl
12356
12357
12358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12360
12361 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12362 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12363 "Starting the daemon"
12364 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12365 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12366 .cindex "network interface"
12367 .cindex "interface" "network"
12368 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12369 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12370 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12371 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12372 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12373 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12374 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12375 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12376 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12377 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12378 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12379
12380 .olist
12381 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12382 and ports to listen on.
12383 .next
12384 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12385 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12386 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12387 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12388 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12389 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12390 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12391 as an error situation.
12392 .next
12393 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12394 for the outgoing connection.
12395 .endlist
12396
12397
12398 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12399 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12400 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12401 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12402 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12403
12404 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12405 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12406 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12407 chapter describes how they operate.
12408
12409 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12410 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12411
12412
12413
12414 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12415 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12416 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12417 following options:
12418
12419 .ilist
12420 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12421 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12422 .next
12423 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12424 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12425 .endlist
12426
12427 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12428 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12429 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12430 colons. For example:
12431 .code
12432 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12433 192.168.23.65 ; \
12434 ::1 ; \
12435 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12436 .endd
12437 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12438 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12439
12440 .olist
12441 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12442 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12443 .code
12444 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12445 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12446 .endd
12447 .next
12448 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12449 with a colon separator, for example:
12450 .code
12451 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12452 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12453 .endd
12454 .endlist
12455
12456 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12457 default setting contains just one port:
12458 .code
12459 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12460 .endd
12461 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12462 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12463 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12464 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12465 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12466
12467
12468
12469 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12470 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12471 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12472 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12473 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12474 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12475 .code
12476 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12477 .endd
12478 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12479 .code
12480 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12481 .endd
12482 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12483
12484
12485
12486 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12487 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12488 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12489 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12490 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12491 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12492 exim.
12493
12494 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12495 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12496 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12497 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12498 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12499 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12500 .code
12501 -oX 1225
12502 .endd
12503 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12504 whereas
12505 .code
12506 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12507 .endd
12508 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12509 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12510 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12511
12512
12513
12514 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12515 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12516 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12517 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12518 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12519 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12520 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12521 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12522 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12523 common use of this option is expected to be
12524 .code
12525 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12526 .endd
12527 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12528 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12529 this way when a daemon is started.
12530
12531 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12532 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12533 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12534 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12535 connections via the daemon.)
12536
12537
12538
12539
12540 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12541 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12542 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12543 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12544 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12545 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12546 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12547 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12548 .code
12549 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12550 .endd
12551 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12552 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12553 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12554 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12555 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12556 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12557 .code
12558 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12559 .endd
12560 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12561 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12562 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12563 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12564 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12565
12566 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12567 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12568 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12569 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12570 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12571 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12572 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12573 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12574 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12575 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12576 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12577 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12578
12579 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12580 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12581 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12582 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12583 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12584
12585
12586
12587 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12588 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12589 .code
12590 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12591 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12592 .endd
12593 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12594 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12595 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12596 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12597
12598 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12599 .code
12600 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12601 .endd
12602 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12603 .code
12604 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12605 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12606 .endd
12607 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12608 IPv4 loopback address only:
12609 .code
12610 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12611 .endd
12612 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12613 .code
12614 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12615 .endd
12616 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12617
12618
12619
12620 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12621 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12622 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12623 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12624 treated as local.
12625
12626 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12627 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12628 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12629 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12630
12631 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12632 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12633 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12634 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12635 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12636 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12637 used for listening. Consider this example:
12638 .code
12639 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12640 192.168.53.235 ; \
12641 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12642
12643 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12644 .endd
12645 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12646 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12647 Exim is routing.
12648
12649 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12650 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12651 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12652 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12653 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12654 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12655 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12656 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12657
12658
12659
12660 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12661 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12662 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12663 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12664 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12665 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12666 details.
12667
12668
12669
12670
12671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12673
12674 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12675 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12676 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12677 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12678
12679 .ilist
12680 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12681 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12682 .next
12683 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12684 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12685 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12686 .next
12687 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12688 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12689 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12690 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12691 settings.
12692 .endlist
12693
12694 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12695 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12696 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12697 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12698 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12699 listed in more than one group.
12700
12701 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12702 .table2
12703 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12704 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12705 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12706 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12707 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12708 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12709 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12710 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12711 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12712 .endtable
12713
12714
12715 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12716 .table2
12717 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12718 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12719 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12720 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12721 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12722 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12723 .endtable
12724
12725
12726
12727 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12728 .table2
12729 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12730 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12731 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12732 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12733 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12734 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12735 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12736 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12737 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12738 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12739 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12740 .endtable
12741
12742
12743
12744 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12745 .table2
12746 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12747 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12748 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12749 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12750 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12751 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12752 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12753 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12754 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12755 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12756 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12757 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12758 .endtable
12759
12760
12761
12762 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12763 .table2
12764 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12765 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12766 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12767 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12768 .endtable
12769
12770
12771
12772 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12773 .table2
12774 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12775 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12776 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12777 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12778 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12779 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12780 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12781 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12782 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12783 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12784 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12785 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12786 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12787 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12788 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12789 .endtable
12790
12791
12792
12793 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12794 .table2
12795 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12796 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12797 .endtable
12798
12799
12800
12801 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12802 .table2
12803 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12804 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12805 .endtable
12806
12807
12808
12809 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12810 .table2
12811 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12812 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12813 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12814 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12815 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12816 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12817 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12818 .endtable
12819
12820
12821
12822 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12823 .table2
12824 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12825 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12826 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12827 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12828 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12829 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12830 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12831 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12832 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12833 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12834 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12835 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12836 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12837 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12838 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12839 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12840 connection"
12841 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12842 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12843 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12844 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12845 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12846 .endtable
12847
12848
12849
12850 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12851 .table2
12852 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12853 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12854 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12855 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12856 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12857 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12858 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12859 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12860 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12861 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12862 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12863 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12864 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12865 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12866 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12867 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12868 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12869 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12870 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12871 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12872 words""&"
12873 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12874 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12875 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12876 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12877 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12878 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12879 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12880 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12881 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12882 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12883 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12884 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12885 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12886 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12887 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12888 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12889 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12890 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12891 .endtable
12892
12893
12894
12895 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12896 .table2
12897 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12898 item"
12899 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12900 item"
12901 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12902 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12903 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12904 .endtable
12905
12906
12907
12908 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12909 .table2
12910 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12911 .row &%gnutls_enable_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
12912 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12913 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12914 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12915 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12916 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
12917 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12918 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12919 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12920 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12921 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12922 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12923 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12924 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12925 .endtable
12926
12927
12928
12929 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12930 .table2
12931 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12932 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12933 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12934 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12935 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12936 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12937 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12938 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12939 .endtable
12940
12941
12942
12943 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12944 .table2
12945 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12946 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12947 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12948 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12949 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12950 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12951 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12952 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12953 .endtable
12954
12955
12956
12957
12958 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12959 .table2
12960 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12961 .endtable
12962
12963
12964
12965
12966
12967 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12968 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12969
12970 .table2
12971 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12972 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12973 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12974 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12975 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12976 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12977 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12978 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12979 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12980 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12981 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12982 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12983 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12984 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12985 connection"
12986 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12987 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12988 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12989 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12990 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12991 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12992 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12993 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12994 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12995 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12996 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12997 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12998 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12999 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13000 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13001 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13002 .endtable
13003
13004
13005
13006 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13007 .table2
13008 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13009 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13010 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13011 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13012 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13013 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13014 .endtable
13015
13016
13017
13018 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13019 .table2
13020 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13021 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13022 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13023 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13024 words""&"
13025 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13026 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13027 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13028 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13029 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13030 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13031 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13032 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13033 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13034 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13035 .endtable
13036
13037
13038
13039 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13040 .table2
13041 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13042 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13043 directory"
13044 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13045 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13046 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13047 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13048 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13049 .endtable
13050
13051
13052
13053 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13054 .table2
13055 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13056 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13057 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13058 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13059 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13060 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13061 .row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
13062 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13063 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13064 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13065 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13066 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13067 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13068 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13069 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13070 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13071 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13072 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13073 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13074 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13075 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13076 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13077 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13078 .endtable
13079
13080
13081
13082 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13083 .table2
13084 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13085 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13086 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13087 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13088 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13089 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13090 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13091 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13092 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13093 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13094 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13095 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13096 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13097 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13098 .endtable
13099
13100
13101
13102 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13103 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13104 &dagger;.
13105
13106 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13107 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13108 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13109 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13110 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13111 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13112 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13113 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13114 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13115
13116 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13117 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13118 It now defaults to true.
13119 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13120 .display
13121 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13122 .endd
13123
13124 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13125 .code
13126 log_selector = +8bitmime
13127 .endd
13128
13129 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13130 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13131 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13132 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13133 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13134 further details.
13135
13136 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13137 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13138 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13139 SMTP messages.
13140
13141 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13142 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13143 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13144 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13145 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13146
13147 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13148 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13149 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13150 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13151 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13152
13153 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13154 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13155 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13156 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13157
13158 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13159 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13160 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13161 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13162 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13163
13164 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13165 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13166 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13167 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13168
13169 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13170 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13171 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13172 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13173
13174 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13175 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13176 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13177 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13178 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13179
13180
13181 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13182 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13183 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13184 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13185
13186 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13187 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13188 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13189 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13190 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13191
13192 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13193 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13194 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13195 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13196 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13197
13198 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13199 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13200 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13201 further details.
13202
13203 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13204 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13205 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13206 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13207
13208 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13209 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13210 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13211 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13212
13213 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13214 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13215 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13216 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13217
13218 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13219 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13220 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13221 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13222
13223 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13224 .cindex "admin user"
13225 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13226 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13227 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13228 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13229 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13230 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13231 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13232
13233 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13234 .cindex "domain literal"
13235 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13236 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13237 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13238 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13239
13240 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13241 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13242 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13243 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13244 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13245 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13246 the local host's IP addresses.
13247
13248
13249 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13250 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13251 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13252 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13253 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13254 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13255 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13256 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13257 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13258
13259 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13260 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13261 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13262 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13263 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13264 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13265 experiment if they wish.
13266
13267 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13268 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13269 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13270 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13271 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13272 suitable setting is:
13273 .code
13274 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13275 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13276 .endd
13277 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13278 .code
13279 dns_check_names_pattern =
13280 .endd
13281 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13282
13283
13284 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13285 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13286 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13287 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13288 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13289 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13290 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13291 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13292 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13293 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13294 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13295
13296 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13297 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13298 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13299 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13300 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13301 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13302
13303 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13304 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13305 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13306 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13307 .code
13308 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13309 .endd
13310 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13311 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13312 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13313 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13314
13315
13316 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13317 .cindex "thawing messages"
13318 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13319 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13320 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13321 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13322 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13323 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13324
13325 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13326 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13327 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13328
13329
13330 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13331 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13332 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13333 .code
13334 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13335 .endd
13336 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13337 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13338
13339
13340 .option bi_command main string unset
13341 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13342 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13343 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13344 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13345 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13346
13347
13348 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13349 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13350 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13351 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13352 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13353 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13354
13355
13356 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13357 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13358 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13359 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13360
13361 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13362 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13363 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13364 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13365 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13366 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13367 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13368 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13369 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13370 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13371
13372 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13373 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13374 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13375 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13376
13377
13378 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13379 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13380 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13381 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13382 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13383 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13384 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13385 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13386 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13387
13388 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13389 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13390 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13391 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13392 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13393 messages.
13394
13395 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13396 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13397 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13398 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13399 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13400 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13401 connection. A typical setting might be:
13402 .code
13403 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13404 .endd
13405 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13406 .code
13407 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13408 .endd
13409 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13410 address.
13411
13412 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13413 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13414 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13415 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13416 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13417 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13418
13419
13420 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13421 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13422 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13423 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13424
13425
13426 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13427 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13428 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13429 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13430
13431
13432 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13433 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13434 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13435 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13436
13437
13438 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13439 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13440 callout verification. The default value is
13441 .code
13442 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13443 .endd
13444 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13445
13446
13447 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13448 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13449
13450
13451 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13452 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13453
13454 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13455 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13456 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13457 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13458 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13459 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13460 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13461 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13462 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13463 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13464
13465
13466 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13467 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13468
13469
13470 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13471 .cindex "checking disk space"
13472 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13473 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13474 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13475 message is accepted.
13476
13477 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13478 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13479 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13480 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13481 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13482 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13483 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13484 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13485
13486
13487 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13488 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13489 .code
13490 check_spool_space = 10M
13491 check_spool_inodes = 100
13492 .endd
13493 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13494 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13495 transit.
13496
13497 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13498 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13499 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13500
13501 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13502 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13503 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13504 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13505 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13506 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13507
13508 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13509 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13510
13511 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13512 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13513 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13514
13515 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13516 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13517 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13518 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13519 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13520 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13521
13522 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13523 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13524 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13525 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13526 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13527 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13528 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13529
13530 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13531 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13532
13533 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13534 .cindex "warning of delay"
13535 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13536 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13537 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13538 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13539 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13540 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13541 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13542 with
13543 .code
13544 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13545 .endd
13546 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13547 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13548 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13549 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13550 .code
13551 delay_warning = 6h
13552 .endd
13553 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13554 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13555 .code
13556 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13557 .endd
13558
13559 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13560 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13561 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13562 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13563 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13564 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13565 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13566 not sent. The default is:
13567 .code
13568 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13569 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13570 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13571 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13572 } {no}{yes}}
13573 .endd
13574 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13575 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13576 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13577 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13578
13579 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13580 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13581 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13582 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13583 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13584 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13585 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13586 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13587
13588 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13589 .cindex "load average"
13590 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13591 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13592 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13593 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13594 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13595
13596
13597 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13598 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13599 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13600 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13601 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13602 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13603 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13604 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13605
13606 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13607 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13608 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13609 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13610 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13611 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13612 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13613 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13614
13615 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13616 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13617 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13618 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13619
13620
13621 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13622 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13623 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13624 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13625 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13626 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13627 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13628
13629
13630 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13631 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13632 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13633 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13634 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13635 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13636 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13637 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13638 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13639 by a setting such as this:
13640 .code
13641 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13642 .endd
13643 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13644 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13645 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13646 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13647 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13648 options are applied after this global option.
13649
13650 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13651 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13652 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13653 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13654 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13655 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13656 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13657 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13658 value of this option. The default pattern is
13659 .code
13660 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13661 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13662 .endd
13663 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13664 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13665 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13666 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13667 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13668 empty string.
13669
13670 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13671 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13672 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13673
13674 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13675 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13676 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13677 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13678
13679 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13680 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13681 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13682 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13683 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13684 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13685 domain matches this list.
13686
13687 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13688 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13689 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13690
13691
13692 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13693 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13694 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13695 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13696 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13697 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13698 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13699 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13700 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13701 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13702 to set in them.
13703
13704
13705 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13706 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13707
13708
13709 .new
13710 .option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13711 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13712 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13713 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13714 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13715 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13716
13717 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13718 .wen
13719
13720
13721 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13722 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13723 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13724 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13725 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13726 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13727 on.
13728
13729 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13730
13731
13732 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13733 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13734 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13735 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13736
13737 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13738 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13739 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13740 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13741 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13742 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13743 .code
13744 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13745 .endd
13746 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13747 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13748
13749 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13750 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13751 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13752 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13753 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13754 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13755 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13756 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13757 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13758
13759
13760 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13761 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13762 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13763 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13764 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13765 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13766 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13767 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13768 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13769
13770 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13771 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13772 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13773 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13774 are examined. For example:
13775 .code
13776 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13777 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13778 postmaster@mydomain.example
13779 .endd
13780 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13781 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13782 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13783 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13784 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13785 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13786 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13787
13788
13789 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13790 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13791 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13792 .display
13793 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13794 .endd
13795 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13796 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13797 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13798 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13799 overrides the default.
13800
13801 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13802 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13803 and warning messages. For example:
13804 .code
13805 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13806 .endd
13807 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13808 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13809 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13810 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13811 not used.
13812
13813
13814 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13815 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13816 .cindex "Exim group"
13817 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13818 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13819 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13820 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13821 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13822 security issues.
13823
13824
13825 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13826 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13827 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13828 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13829 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13830 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13831 other place.
13832 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13833 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13834 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13835 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13836
13837
13838 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13839 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13840 .cindex "Exim user"
13841 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13842 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13843 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13844 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13845
13846 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13847 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13848 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13849 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13850
13851
13852 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13853 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13854 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13855 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13856
13857
13858 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13859 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13860
13861 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13862 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13863 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13864 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13865 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13866 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13867 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13868 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13869 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13870 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13871 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13872 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13873 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13874 addresses.
13875
13876
13877 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13878 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13879 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13880 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13881 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13882 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13883 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13884 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13885 retries.
13886
13887 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13888 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13889 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13890 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13891
13892
13893
13894 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13895 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13896 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13897 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13898 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13899 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13900 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13901 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13902 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13903 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13904 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13905 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13906 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13907 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13908 logging that you require.
13909
13910
13911 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13912 .cindex "HP-UX"
13913 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13914 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13915 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13916 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13917 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13918 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13919 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13920 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13921
13922 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13923 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13924 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13925 user's name.
13926
13927 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13928 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13929 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13930 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13931 .code
13932 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13933 gecos_name = $1
13934 .endd
13935
13936 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13937 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13938
13939
13940 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13941 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13942 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13943 implementations of TLS.
13944
13945
13946 .new
13947 option gnutls_enable_pkcs11 main boolean unset
13948 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
13949 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
13950
13951 See
13952 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
13953 for documentation.
13954 .wen
13955
13956
13957
13958 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13959 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13960 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13961 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13962 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13963 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13964
13965
13966
13967 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13968 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13969 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13970 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13971 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13972 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13973 sections are rejected.
13974
13975
13976 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13977 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13978 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13979 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13980 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13981 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13982 zero means &"no limit"&.
13983
13984
13985
13986
13987 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13988 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13989 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13990 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13991 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13992 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13993 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13994 if you want to do semantic checking.
13995 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13996 set.
13997
13998
13999 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14000 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14001 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14002 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14003 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14004 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14005 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14006 .code
14007 helo_allow_chars = _
14008 .endd
14009 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14010
14011
14012 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14013 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14014 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14015 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14016 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14017 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14018 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14019 do.
14020
14021
14022 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14023 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14024 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14025 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14026 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14027 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14028 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14029 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14030 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14031 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14032 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14033 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14034
14035 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14036 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14037 EHLO command either:
14038
14039 .ilist
14040 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14041 .next
14042 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14043 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14044 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14045 calling host address, or
14046 .next
14047 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14048 available) yields the calling host address.
14049 .endlist
14050
14051 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14052 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14053 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14054
14055 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14056 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14057 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14058 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14059 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14060 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14061 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14062 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14063 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14064 error.
14065
14066 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14067 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14068 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14069 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14070 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14071 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14072 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14073 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14074 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14075
14076 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14077 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14078 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14079 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14080 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14081
14082 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14083 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14084 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14085 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14086
14087
14088 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14089 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14090 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14091 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14092 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14093 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14094 default configuration file contains
14095 .code
14096 host_lookup = *
14097 .endd
14098 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14099 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14100
14101 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14102 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14103 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14104
14105 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14106 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14107 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14108 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14109 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14110 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14111
14112
14113 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14114 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14115 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14116 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14117 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14118 if you want.
14119
14120 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14121 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14122 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14123 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14124
14125
14126
14127 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14128 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14129 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14130 as soon as the connection is made.
14131 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14132 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14133 connections immediately.
14134
14135 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14136 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14137 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14138 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14139 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14140
14141
14142 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14143 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14144 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14145 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14146 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14147 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14148 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14149 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14150 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14151 .code
14152 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14153 .endd
14154 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14155
14156
14157
14158 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14159 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14160 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14161 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14162 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14163 records
14164 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14165 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14166
14167 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14168 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14169 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14170 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14171 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14172 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14173 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14174
14175
14176 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14177 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14178 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14179 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14180 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14181
14182
14183
14184 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14185 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14186 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14187 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14188 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14189 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14190
14191 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14192 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14193 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14194 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14195 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14196 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14197 for frozen messages. For example,
14198 .code
14199 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14200 .endd
14201 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14202 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14203 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14204 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14205 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14206 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14207
14208
14209 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14210 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14211 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14212 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14213 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14214 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14215 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14216 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14217 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14218 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14219
14220
14221 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14222 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14223
14224
14225 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14226 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14227 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14228 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14229 logged.
14230
14231
14232 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14233 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14234 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14235 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14236 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14237 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14238 and constrained to be a directory.
14239
14240
14241 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14242 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14243 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14244 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14245 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14246 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14247 and constrained to be a file.
14248
14249
14250 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14251 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14252 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14253 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14254 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14255
14256
14257 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14258 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14259 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14260 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14261 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14262 identity to be proven.
14263
14264
14265 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14266 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14267 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14268 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14269 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14270
14271
14272 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14273 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14274 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14275 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14276 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14277 with LDAP support.
14278
14279
14280 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14281 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14282 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14283 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14284 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14285 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14286 to hard/demand.
14287
14288
14289 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14290 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14291 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14292 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14293 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14294 of SSL-on-connect.
14295 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14296 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14297
14298
14299 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14300 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14301 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14302 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14303 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14304 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14305 has been built with LDAP support.
14306
14307
14308
14309 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14310 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14311 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14312 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14313 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14314 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14315 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14316
14317 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14318 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14319 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14320
14321 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14322 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14323 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14324 and the default qualify domain.
14325
14326 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14327 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14328 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14329 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14330
14331 .cindex "envelope sender"
14332 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14333 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14334 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14335
14336 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14337 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14338 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14339
14340
14341
14342
14343 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14344 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14345 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14346 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14347 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14348 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14349 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14350 example, if
14351 .code
14352 local_from_prefix = *-
14353 .endd
14354 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14355 .code
14356 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14357 .endd
14358 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14359 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14360 qualify domain.
14361
14362
14363 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14364 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14365
14366
14367 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14368 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14369 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14370 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14371 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14372 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14373 &%local_interfaces%& is
14374 .code
14375 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14376 .endd
14377 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14378 .code
14379 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14380 .endd
14381
14382 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14383 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14384 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14385 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14386 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14387 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14388 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14389 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14390
14391
14392
14393 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14394 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14395 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14396 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14397 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14398 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14399 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14400 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14401
14402
14403
14404
14405 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14406 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14407 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14408 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14409 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14410 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14411 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14412 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14413 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14414 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14415 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14416 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14417 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14418 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14419 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14420
14421
14422
14423 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14424 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14425 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14426 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14427 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14428 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14429 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14430 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14431 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14432 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14433 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14434 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14435 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14436 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14437
14438
14439 .option log_selector main string unset
14440 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14441 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14442 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14443 minus characters. For example:
14444 .code
14445 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14446 .endd
14447 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14448 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14449
14450
14451 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14452 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14453 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14454 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14455 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14456 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14457 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14458 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14459 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14460 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14461 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14462 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14463 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14464
14465
14466 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14467 .cindex "too many open files"
14468 .cindex "open files, too many"
14469 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14470 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14471 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14472 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14473 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14474 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14475 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14476 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14477 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14478 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14479 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14480 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14481
14482
14483 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14484 .cindex "length of login name"
14485 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14486 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14487 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14488 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14489 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14490 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14491
14492
14493 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14494 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14495 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14496 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14497 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14498 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14499 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14500 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14501
14502
14503 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14504 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14505 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14506 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14507 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14508 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14509 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14510
14511
14512 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14513 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14514 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14515 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14516 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14517 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14518 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14519 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14520 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14521 empty string, the option is ignored.
14522
14523
14524 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14525 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14526 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14527 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14528 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14529 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14530 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14531 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14532 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14533 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14534 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14535 colons will become hyphens.
14536
14537
14538 .option message_logs main boolean true
14539 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14540 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14541 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14542 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14543 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14544 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14545 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14546 which is not affected by this option.
14547
14548
14549 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14550 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14551 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14552 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14553 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14554 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14555 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14556 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14557 optionally followed by K or M.
14558
14559 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14560 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14561 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14562 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14563 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14564
14565 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14566 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14567 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14568 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14569 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14570 message that an individual transport can process.
14571
14572 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14573 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14574 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14575 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14576 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14577 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14578 some problems may result.
14579
14580 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14581 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14582 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14583
14584
14585 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14586 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14587 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14588 .code
14589 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14590 .endd
14591 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14592 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14593 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14594 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14595 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14596
14597
14598 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14599 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14600 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14601 contains a full description of this facility.
14602
14603
14604
14605 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14606 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14607 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14608 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14609 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14610
14611
14612 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14613 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14614 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14615 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14616 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14617 safety precaution.
14618
14619 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14620 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14621 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14622 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14623 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14624
14625 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14626 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14627 example is
14628 .code
14629 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14630 .endd
14631 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14632 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14633 transport driver.
14634
14635
14636 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14637 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14638 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14639 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14640 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14641
14642 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14643 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14644 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14645 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14646 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14647 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14648 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14649
14650 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14651 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14652 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14653 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14654 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14655
14656 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14657 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14658 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14659 some now infamous attacks.
14660
14661 An example:
14662 .code
14663 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14664 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14665 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14666 .endd
14667
14668 Possible options may include:
14669 .ilist
14670 &`all`&
14671 .next
14672 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14673 .next
14674 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14675 .next
14676 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14677 .next
14678 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
14679 .next
14680 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14681 .next
14682 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14683 .next
14684 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14685 .next
14686 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14687 .next
14688 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14689 .next
14690 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14691 .next
14692 &`no_compression`&
14693 .next
14694 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14695 .next
14696 &`no_sslv2`&
14697 .next
14698 &`no_sslv3`&
14699 .next
14700 &`no_ticket`&
14701 .next
14702 &`no_tlsv1`&
14703 .next
14704 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
14705 .next
14706 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
14707 .next
14708 &`single_dh_use`&
14709 .next
14710 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14711 .next
14712 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14713 .next
14714 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14715 .next
14716 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14717 .next
14718 &`tls_d5_bug`&
14719 .next
14720 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14721 .endlist
14722
14723
14724 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14725 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14726 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14727 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14728 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14729
14730
14731 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14732 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14733 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14734 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14735 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14736 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14737 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14738 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14739 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14740 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14741 an ACL.
14742
14743 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14744 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14745 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14746 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14747 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14748 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14749 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14750
14751
14752 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14753 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14754 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14755
14756
14757 .option perl_startup main string unset
14758 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14759 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14760
14761
14762 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14763 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14764 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14765 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14766 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14767 PostgreSQL support.
14768
14769
14770 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14771 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14772 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14773 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14774 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14775 to the host name:
14776 .code
14777 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14778 .endd
14779 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14780 spool directory.
14781 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14782 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14783 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14784
14785
14786 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14787 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14788 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14789 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14790 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14791 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14792 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14793 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14794 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14795
14796
14797 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14798 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14799 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14800 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14801 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14802 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14803 volume of mail. Use with care!
14804
14805
14806 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14807 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14808 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14809 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14810 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14811 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14812 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14813 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14814 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14815 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14816
14817 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14818 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14819 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14820 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14821 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14822 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14823
14824
14825 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14826 .cindex "printing characters"
14827 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14828 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14829 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14830 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14831 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14832 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14833 characters.
14834
14835 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14836 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14837 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14838 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14839 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14840 standards.
14841
14842
14843 .option process_log_path main string unset
14844 .cindex "process log path"
14845 .cindex "log" "process log"
14846 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14847 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14848 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14849 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14850 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14851 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14852 different spool directories.
14853
14854
14855 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14856 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14857 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14858 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14859 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14860 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14861 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14862
14863
14864 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14865 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14866 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14867 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14868 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14869 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14870 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14871 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14872 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14873
14874 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14875 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14876 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14877 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14878 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14879 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14880 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14881
14882
14883 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14884 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14885 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14886
14887
14888
14889 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14890 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14891 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14892 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14893 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14894 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14895 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14896 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14897
14898
14899 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14900 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14901 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14902 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14903 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14904
14905
14906 .option queue_only main boolean false
14907 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14908 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14909 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14910 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14911 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14912 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14913
14914 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14915 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14916 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14917 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14918
14919
14920 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14921 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14922 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14923 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14924 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14925 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14926 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14927 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14928 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14929 .code
14930 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14931 .endd
14932 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14933 &_/some/file_& exists.
14934
14935
14936 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14937 .cindex "load average"
14938 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14939 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14940 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14941 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14942 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14943 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14944 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14945 false.
14946
14947 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14948 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14949 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14950 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14951
14952
14953 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14954 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14955 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14956 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14957 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14958 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14959 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14960 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14961 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14962 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14963 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14964 re-evaluated for each message.
14965
14966
14967 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14968 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14969 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14970 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14971 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14972 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14973
14974
14975 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14976 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14977 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14978 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14979 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14980 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14981 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14982 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14983 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14984 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14985 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14986 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14987 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14988
14989
14990
14991 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14992 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14993 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14994 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14995 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14996 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14997 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14998 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14999 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15000
15001 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15002 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15003 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15004 the daemon's command line.
15005
15006 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15007 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15008 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15009 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15010 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15011 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15012 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15013 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15014 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15015 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15016 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15017 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15018 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15019 &%queue_domains%&.
15020
15021
15022 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15023 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15024 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15025 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15026 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15027 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15028 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15029
15030 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15031 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15032 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15033 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15034 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15035 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15036 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15037 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15038 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15039 header lines. The default setting is:
15040
15041 .code
15042 received_header_text = Received: \
15043 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15044 {${if def:sender_ident \
15045 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15046 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15047 by $primary_hostname \
15048 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15049 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15050 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15051 ${if def:sender_address \
15052 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15053 id $message_exim_id\
15054 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15055 .endd
15056
15057 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15058 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15059 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15060 header lines such as the following:
15061 .code
15062 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15063 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15064 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15065 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15066 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15067 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15068 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15069 .endd
15070 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15071 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15072 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15073 message was accepted.
15074
15075
15076 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15077 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15078 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15079 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15080 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15081 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15082 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15083 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15084
15085
15086 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15087 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15088 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15089 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15090 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15091 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15092 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15093 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15094 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15095 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15096 option was not set.
15097
15098
15099 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15100 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15101 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15102 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15103 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15104 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15105 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15106 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15107 done.
15108
15109 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15110 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15111 RCPT commands in a single message.
15112
15113
15114 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15115 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15116 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15117 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15118 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15119 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15120 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15121
15122
15123 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15124 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15125 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15126 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15127 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15128 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15129 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15130 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15131 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15132 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15133 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15134 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15135 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15136 tagged with its process id.
15137
15138 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15139 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15140 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15141 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15142 is received.
15143
15144 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15145 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15146 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15147 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15148 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15149 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15150 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15151 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15152 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15153 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15154 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15155
15156 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15157 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15158 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15159 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15160
15161
15162 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15163 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15164 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15165 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15166 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15167 .code
15168 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15169 .endd
15170 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15171 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15172
15173
15174 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15175 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15176 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15177 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15178 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15179 past failures.
15180
15181
15182 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15183 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15184 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15185 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15186 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15187 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15188 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15189 the default value.
15190
15191
15192 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15193 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15194 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15195 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15196 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15197 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15198 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15199 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15200 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15201 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15202
15203
15204 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15205 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15206
15207
15208 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15209 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15210 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15211 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15212 in the list.
15213
15214 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15215 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15216 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15217 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15218 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15219
15220
15221 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15222 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15223 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15224 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15225 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15226 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15227 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15228 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15229 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15230 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15231
15232
15233 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15234 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15235 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15236 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15237 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15238 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15239 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15240 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15241 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15242 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15243 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15244
15245
15246
15247 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15248 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15249 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15250 .cindex "inetd"
15251 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15252 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15253 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15254 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15255 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15256 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15257
15258 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15259 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15260 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15261 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15262
15263
15264 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15265 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15266 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15267 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15268 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15269 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15270 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15271 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15272
15273 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15274 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15275 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15276 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15277 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15278 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15279 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15280 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15281
15282
15283 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15284 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15285 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15286 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15287 live with.
15288
15289
15290 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15291 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15292
15293 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15294 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15295 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15296 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15297 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15298 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15299 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15300 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15301 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15302 seen).
15303
15304
15305 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15306 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15307 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15308 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15309 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15310 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15311 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15312 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15313 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15314 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15315 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15316
15317 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15318 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15319 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15320 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15321 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15322 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15323
15324
15325
15326 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15327 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15328 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15329 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15330 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15331 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15332 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15333 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15334 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15335 to all messages received in the same connection.
15336
15337 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15338 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15339 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15340 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15341
15342
15343 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15344 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15345
15346 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15347 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15348 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15349 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15350 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15351 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15352 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15353 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15354 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15355 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15356 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15357 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15358 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15359
15360
15361 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15362 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15363 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15364 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15365 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15366 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15367 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15368 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15369 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15370 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15371 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15372 individual host.
15373
15374 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15375 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15376 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15377 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15378
15379
15380 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15381 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15382 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15383 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15384 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15385 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15386 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15387 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15388 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15389
15390 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15391 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15392 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15393 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15394
15395 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15396 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15397 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15398 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15399 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15400 For example:
15401 .code
15402 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15403 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15404 .endd
15405
15406 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15407 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15408 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15409 &%helo_data%& value.
15410
15411 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15412 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15413 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15414 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15415 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15416 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15417 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15418 .code
15419 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15420 $version_number $tod_full
15421 .endd
15422 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15423 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15424 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15425 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15426 multiline response).
15427
15428
15429 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15430 .cindex "checking disk space"
15431 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15432 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15433 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15434 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15435 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15436 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15437 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15438
15439
15440 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15441 .cindex "connection backlog"
15442 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15443 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15444 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15445 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15446 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15447 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15448 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15449 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15450 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15451 attacks by SYN flooding.
15452
15453
15454 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15455 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15456 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15457 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15458 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15459 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15460 fewer, but they still exist.
15461
15462 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15463 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15464 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15465 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15466 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15467 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15468 does detect many instances.
15469
15470 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15471 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15472 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15473 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15474
15475
15476
15477 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15478 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15479 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15480 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15481 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15482 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15483 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15484 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15485 example:
15486 .code
15487 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15488 $sender_host_address
15489 .endd
15490 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15491 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15492 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15493 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15494 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15495 the command.
15496
15497
15498 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15499 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15500 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15501 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15502 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15503
15504
15505 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15506 .cindex "load average"
15507 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15508 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15509 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15510 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15511 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15512 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15513
15514
15515
15516 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15517 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15518 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15519 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15520 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15521 .code
15522 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15523 .endd
15524 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15525 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15526 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15527 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15528 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15529
15530 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15531 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15532 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15533 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15534 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15535 not count towards the limit.
15536
15537
15538
15539 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15540 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15541 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15542 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15543 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15544 that subvert web
15545 clients
15546 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15547 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15548
15549
15550
15551 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15552 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15553 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15554 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15555 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15556 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15557 recipients.
15558
15559 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15560 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15561 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15562 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15563
15564 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15565 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15566 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15567 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15568 values:
15569
15570 .ilist
15571 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15572 .next
15573 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15574 fractional parts are allowed here.
15575 .next
15576 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15577 .next
15578 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15579 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15580 .endlist
15581
15582 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15583 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15584 .code
15585 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15586 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15587 .endd
15588 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15589 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15590 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15591 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15592
15593
15594 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15595 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15596
15597
15598 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15599 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15600
15601
15602 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15603 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15604 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15605 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15606 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15607 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15608 the message is abandoned.
15609 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15610 .code
15611 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15612 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15613 .endd
15614 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15615 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15616
15617
15618 .oindex "&%-os%&"
15619 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15620 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15621 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15622 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15623 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15624
15625
15626 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15627 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15628 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15629
15630
15631 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15632 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15633 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15634 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15635 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15636 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15637 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15638 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15639 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15640 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15641 .code
15642 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15643 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15644 .endd
15645
15646 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15647 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15648 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15649 The default value is
15650 .code
15651 127.0.0.1 783
15652 .endd
15653 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15654
15655
15656
15657 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15658 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15659 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15660 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15661 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15662 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15663 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15664 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15665 arrival of the message.
15666
15667 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15668 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15669 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15670 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15671 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15672
15673 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15674 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15675 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15676 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15677 automatically deleted.
15678
15679 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15680 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15681 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15682 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15683 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15684 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15685 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15686 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15687 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15688
15689
15690 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15691 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15692 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15693 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15694 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15695 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15696 &$primary_hostname$&.
15697
15698 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15699 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15700 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15701 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15702 as failures in the configuration file.
15703
15704 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15705 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15706
15707 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15708 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15709 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15710 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15711
15712 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15713 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15714 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15715 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15716 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15717 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15718
15719 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15720 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15721 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15722 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15723 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15724 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15725 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15726
15727
15728 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15729 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15730 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15731 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15732 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15733 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15734 domain causes a syntax error.
15735 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15736 syntax checking.
15737
15738
15739 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15740 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15741 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15742 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15743 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15744 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15745 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15746 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15747 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15748 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15749 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15750 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15751
15752
15753 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15754 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15755 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15756 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15757 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15758 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15759 details of Exim's logging.
15760
15761
15762
15763 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15764 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15765 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15766 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15767 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15768
15769
15770
15771 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15772 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15773 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15774 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15775 details of Exim's logging.
15776
15777
15778 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15779 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15780 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15781 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15782 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15783 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15784 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15785 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15786 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15787 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15788 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15789
15790
15791 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15792 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15793 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15794 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15795 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15796 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15797
15798
15799 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15800 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15801 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15802 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15803 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15804
15805 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15806 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15807 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15808 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15809 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15810
15811 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15812 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15813 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15814 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15815 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15816 contains the pipe command.
15817
15818
15819 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15820 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15821 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15822 is used in a system filter.
15823
15824
15825 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15826 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15827 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15828 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15829 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15830 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15831 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15832 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15833 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15834 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15835
15836 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15837 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15838 transport option overrides.
15839
15840
15841 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15842 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15843 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15844 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15845 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15846 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15847 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15848 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15849 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15850 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15851 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15852 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15853 TCP_NODELAY.
15854
15855
15856 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15857 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15858 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15859 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15860 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15861 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15862 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15863 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15864 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15865 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15866
15867 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15868 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15869 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15870
15871
15872 .option timezone main string unset
15873 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15874 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15875 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15876 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15877 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15878 .code
15879 timezone = UTC
15880 .endd
15881 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15882 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15883 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15884 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15885 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15886 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15887
15888
15889 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15890 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15891 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15892 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15893 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15894 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15895 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15896 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15897
15898
15899 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15900 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15901 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15902 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15903 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15904 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15905 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15906
15907 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15908 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15909 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15910 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15911
15912 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15913 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15914 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15915 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15916
15917 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15918 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15919 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15920 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15921 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15922
15923 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15924
15925
15926 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
15927 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
15928 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
15929 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
15930 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
15931 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
15932
15933 The value must be at least 1024.
15934
15935 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
15936 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
15937 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
15938
15939 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
15940 number.
15941
15942 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
15943 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
15944 larger prime than requested.
15945
15946
15947 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15948 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15949 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
15950 to be used by Exim.
15951
15952 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
15953 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
15954 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
15955 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
15956 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
15957 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
15958 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
15959
15960 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
15961 loaded by Exim.
15962
15963 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
15964 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
15965 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
15966 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
15967
15968 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
15969 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
15970 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
15971 in IKE is assigned number 23.
15972
15973 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
15974 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
15975 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
15976 "ike23".
15977
15978 The available primes are:
15979 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
15980 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
15981 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
15982
15983 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
15984 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
15985
15986
15987 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15988 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15989 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15990 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15991 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15992
15993
15994
15995 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15996 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15997 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15998 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15999 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16000 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16001 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16002
16003 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16004
16005
16006 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16007 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16008 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16009 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16010 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16011 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16012 TLS session.
16013
16014
16015 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16016 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16017 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16018 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16019 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16020 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16021 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16022 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16023 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16024 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16025 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16026
16027
16028 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16029 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16030 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16031 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16032
16033
16034 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16035 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16036 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16037 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16038 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16039 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16040 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16041 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16042 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16043
16044 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16045 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16046 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16047 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16048 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16049 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16050
16051 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16052
16053
16054 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16055 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16056 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16057 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16058 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16059 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16060 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16061 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16062
16063 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16064 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16065 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16066 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16067 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16068 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16069 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16070
16071 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16072 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16073 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16074 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16075 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16076 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16077 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16078 certificate"&.
16079
16080 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16081 certificates.
16082
16083
16084 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16085 .cindex "trusted groups"
16086 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16087 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16088 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16089 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16090 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16091 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16092 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16093 are trusted.
16094
16095 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16096 .cindex "trusted users"
16097 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16098 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16099 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16100 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16101 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16102 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16103 Exim user are trusted.
16104
16105 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16106 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16107 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16108 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16109 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16110 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16111 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16112 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16113 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16114 &%-F%& option.
16115
16116 .option unknown_username main string unset
16117 See &%unknown_login%&.
16118
16119 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16120 .cindex "trusted users"
16121 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16122 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16123 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16124 .cindex "envelope sender"
16125 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16126 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16127 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16128 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16129 is used) is ignored.
16130
16131 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16132 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16133 .code
16134 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16135 .endd
16136 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16137 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16138 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16139 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16140 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16141 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16142 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16143 followed by a hyphen
16144 by a setting like this:
16145 .code
16146 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16147 .endd
16148 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16149 restriction, you can use
16150 .code
16151 untrusted_set_sender = *
16152 .endd
16153 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16154 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16155 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16156 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16157 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16158 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16159 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16160 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16161
16162 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16163 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16164 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16165 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16166 sender address.
16167
16168
16169 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16170 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16171 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16172 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16173 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16174 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16175 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16176 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16177 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16178 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16179 .code
16180 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16181 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16182 .endd
16183 The pattern can be seen by running
16184 .code
16185 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16186 .endd
16187 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16188 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16189 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16190 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16191 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16192 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16193
16194
16195 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16196 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16197
16198
16199 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16200 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16201 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16202 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16203 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16204 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16205 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16206 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16207
16208
16209 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16210 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16211 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16212 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16213 .ecindex IIDconfima
16214 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16215
16216
16217
16218
16219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16221
16222 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16223 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16224 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16225 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16226 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16227
16228 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16229 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16230 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16231 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16232 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16233
16234
16235
16236 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16237 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16238 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16239 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16240 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16241 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16242 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16243
16244 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16245 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16246 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16247 routers, and the eventual transport.
16248
16249 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16250 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16251 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16252 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16253 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16254
16255 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16256 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16257 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16258 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16259 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16260
16261 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16262 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16263 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16264 .code
16265 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16266 .endd
16267 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16268 .code
16269 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16270 .endd
16271 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16272 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16273
16274 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16275 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16276 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16277 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16278 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16279 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16280 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16281
16282
16283
16284 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16285 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16286 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16287 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16288 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16289 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16290 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16291 routing.
16292
16293
16294
16295 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16296 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16297 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16298 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16299 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16300 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16301 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16302 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16303 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16304 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16305 you could put:
16306 .code
16307 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16308 .endd
16309 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16310 and
16311 .code
16312 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16313 .endd
16314 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16315 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16316 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16317 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16318
16319
16320 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16321 .cindex "case of local parts"
16322 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16323 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16324 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16325 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16326 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16327 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16328 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16329 more details.
16330
16331 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16332 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16333 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16334 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16335 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16336 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16337 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16338 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16339 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16340
16341 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16342 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16343 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16344 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16345
16346
16347
16348 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16349 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16350 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16351 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16352 .vindex "&$home$&"
16353 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16354 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16355 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16356 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16357 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16358 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16359 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16360 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16361 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16362 the router is skipped.
16363
16364 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16365 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16366 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16367 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16368 setting to achieve this. For example:
16369 .code
16370 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16371 .endd
16372 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16373 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16374 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16375
16376
16377
16378 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16379 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16380 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16381 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16382 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16383 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16384 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16385 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16386
16387 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16388 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16389
16390 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16391 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16392
16393 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16394 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16395 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16396 .code
16397 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16398 .endd
16399 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16400 .code
16401 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16402 .endd
16403
16404 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16405 .code
16406 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16407 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16408 condition = foobar
16409 .endd
16410
16411 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16412 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16413 be specified using &%condition%&.
16414
16415
16416 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16417 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16418 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16419 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16420 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16421 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16422 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16423 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16424 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16425 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16426 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16427 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16428
16429
16430
16431 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16432 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16433 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16434 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16435 transport option of the same name.
16436
16437
16438 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16439 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16440 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16441 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16442 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16443 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16444 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16445 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16446
16447
16448
16449 .option driver routers string unset
16450 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16451 to be used.
16452
16453
16454
16455 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16456 .cindex "envelope sender"
16457 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16458 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16459 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16460 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16461 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16462 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16463 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16464
16465 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16466 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16467 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16468 setting.
16469
16470 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16471 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16472 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16473 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16474
16475 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16476 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16477 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16478 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16479 settings:
16480 .code
16481 errors_to =
16482 errors_to = ""
16483 .endd
16484 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16485 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16486 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16487 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16488 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16489
16490 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16491 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16492 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16493 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16494 setting &%return_path%&.
16495
16496 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16497 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16498 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16499
16500
16501
16502 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16503 .cindex "address" "testing"
16504 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16505 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16506 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16507 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16508 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16509 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16510 on for the system alias file.
16511 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16512 are evaluated.
16513
16514 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16515 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16516 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16517
16518
16519
16520 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16521 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16522 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16523 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16524
16525
16526
16527 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16528 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16529 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16530
16531
16532
16533 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16534 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16535 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16536
16537
16538
16539 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16540 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16541 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16542 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16543 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16544 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16545 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16546 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16547 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16548
16549 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16550 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16551 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16552 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16553 transport for further details.
16554
16555
16556 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16557 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16558 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16559 .cindex "transport" "local"
16560 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16561 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16562 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16563 process.
16564 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16565 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16566 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16567 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16568 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16569
16570
16571
16572 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16573 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16574 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16575 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16576 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16577 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16578 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16579 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16580 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16581 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16582 &"see"& the added header lines.
16583
16584 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16585 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16586 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16587 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16588
16589 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16590 for a router; all listed headers are added.
16591
16592 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16593 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16594
16595 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16596 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16597 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16598 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16599 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16600 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16601 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16602 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16603 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16604 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16605
16606
16607
16608 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16609 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16610 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16611 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16612 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16613 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16614 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16615 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16616 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16617 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16618 &"see"& the original header lines.
16619
16620 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16621 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16622 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16623 errors.
16624
16625 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16626 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16627
16628 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16629 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16630
16631 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16632 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16633 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16634 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16635
16636
16637 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16638 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16639 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16640 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16641 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16642 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16643 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16644 like
16645 .code
16646 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16647 .endd
16648 by setting
16649 .code
16650 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16651 .endd
16652 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16653 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16654 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16655 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16656 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16657 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16658
16659 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16660 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16661 .code
16662 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16663 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16664 .endd
16665 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16666 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16667
16668 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16669 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16670 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16671 domain that is being routed.
16672
16673 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16674 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16675 checked.
16676
16677 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16678 .cindex "additional groups"
16679 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16680 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16681 .cindex "transport" "local"
16682 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16683 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16684 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16685 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16686 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16687
16688
16689
16690 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16691 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16692 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16693 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16694 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16695 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16696 evaluated.
16697
16698 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16699 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16700 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16701 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16702 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16703 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16704 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16705 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16706 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16707
16708 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16709 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16710 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16711 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16712 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16713 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16714 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16715 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16716 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16717 the relevant transport.
16718
16719 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16720 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16721 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16722 callout.
16723
16724 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16725 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16726 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16727 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16728 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16729 .code
16730 real_localuser:
16731 driver = accept
16732 local_part_prefix = real-
16733 check_local_user
16734 transport = local_delivery
16735 .endd
16736 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16737 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16738 .code
16739 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16740 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16741 .endd
16742
16743 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16744 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16745 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16746 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16747
16748
16749 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16750 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16751
16752
16753
16754 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16755 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16756 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16757 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16758 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16759 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16760 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16761 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16762 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16763 &%username-foo%&.
16764
16765
16766 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16767 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16768
16769
16770
16771 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16772 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16773 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16774 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16775 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16776 are evaluated, and
16777 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16778 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16779 example:
16780 .code
16781 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16782 .endd
16783 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16784 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16785 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16786 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16787 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16788 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16789 each virtual domain:
16790 .code
16791 postmaster:
16792 driver = redirect
16793 local_parts = postmaster
16794 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16795 .endd
16796
16797
16798 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16799 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16800 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16801 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16802 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16803 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16804 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16805 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16806 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16807 redirect addresses.
16808
16809
16810
16811 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16812 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16813 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16814 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16815 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16816 delivery to be deferred.
16817
16818 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16819 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16820 .oindex "&%self%&"
16821 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16822 means of the setting
16823 .code
16824 self = pass
16825 .endd
16826 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16827 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16828 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16829
16830 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16831 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16832 controls what happens next.
16833
16834
16835 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16836 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16837 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16838 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16839 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16840 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16841 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16842 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16843
16844 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16845 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16846 applies to all of them.
16847
16848
16849
16850 .option pass_router routers string unset
16851 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16852 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16853 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16854 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16855 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16856 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16857 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16858 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16859 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16860 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16861
16862
16863
16864 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16865 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16866 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16867 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16868 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16869 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16870
16871 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16872 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16873 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16874 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16875
16876
16877
16878 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16879 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16880 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16881 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16882 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16883 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16884 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16885
16886 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16887 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16888 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16889 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16890
16891 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16892 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16893 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16894 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16895 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16896
16897 .cindex "NFS"
16898 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16899 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16900 unavailable.
16901
16902 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16903 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16904 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16905 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16906 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16907 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16908 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16909 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16910
16911 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16912 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16913 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16914 operates as follows:
16915
16916 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16917 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16918 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16919 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16920 used. For example:
16921 .code
16922 require_files = mail:/some/file
16923 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16924 .endd
16925 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16926 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16927
16928 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16929 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16930 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16931 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16932
16933 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16934 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16935 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16936 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16937 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16938
16939 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16940 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16941 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16942 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16943 check again in that process.
16944
16945 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16946 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16947 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16948 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16949 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16950 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16951 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16952 .code
16953 require_files = +/some/file
16954 .endd
16955 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16956 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16957 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16958
16959
16960
16961 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16962 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16963 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16964 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16965 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16966 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16967 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16968 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16969 latter kind.
16970
16971 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16972 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16973 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16974 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16975 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16976 same name.
16977
16978 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16979 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16980 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16981
16982
16983
16984 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16985 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16986 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16987 .vindex "&$home$&"
16988 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16989 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16990 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16991 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16992 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16993 cause the router to defer.
16994
16995 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16996 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16997 place.
16998 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16999 are evaluated.)
17000 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17001 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17002
17003 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17004 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17005 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17006 of these values that is set:
17007
17008 .ilist
17009 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17010 .next
17011 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17012 .next
17013 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17014 .next
17015 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17016 .endlist
17017
17018 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17019 router, but not for the transport.
17020
17021
17022
17023 .option self routers string freeze
17024 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17025 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17026 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17027 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17028 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17029 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17030 of remote hosts.
17031 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17032 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17033 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17034 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17035 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17036
17037 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17038 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17039 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17040 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17041 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17042 cases:
17043
17044 .vlist
17045 .vitem &%defer%&
17046 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17047
17048 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17049 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17050 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17051 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17052
17053 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17054 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17055 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17056 rewritten.
17057
17058 .vitem &%pass%&
17059 .oindex "&%more%&"
17060 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17061 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17062 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17063 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17064 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17065 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17066 combination
17067 .code
17068 self = pass
17069 no_more
17070 .endd
17071 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17072 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17073 be passed to the next router.
17074
17075 .vitem &%fail%&
17076 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17077
17078 .vitem &%send%&
17079 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17080 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17081 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17082 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17083 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17084 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17085 .endlist
17086
17087
17088
17089 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17090 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17091 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17092 address matches something on the list.
17093 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17094 are evaluated.
17095
17096 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17097 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17098 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17099 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17100 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17101 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17102 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17103 matters.
17104
17105
17106 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17107 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17108 .cindex "packet radio"
17109 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17110 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17111 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17112 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17113 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17114 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17115 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17116 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17117
17118 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17119 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17120 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17121 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17122 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17123 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17124 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17125 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17126 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17127 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17128 .code
17129 translate_ip_address = \
17130 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17131 {$value}fail}}
17132 .endd
17133 The file would contain lines like
17134 .code
17135 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17136 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17137 .endd
17138 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17139 are doing.
17140
17141
17142
17143 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17144 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17145 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17146 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17147 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17148 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17149 delivery is deferred.
17150
17151 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17152 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17153 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17154
17155
17156
17157 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17158 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17159 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17160 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17161 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17162 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17163 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17164 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17165 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17166 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17167 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17168 environment.
17169
17170
17171
17172
17173 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17174 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17175 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17176 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17177 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17178 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17179 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17180 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17181 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17182 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17183
17184 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17185 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17186 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17187 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17188 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17189
17190 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17191 environment.
17192
17193
17194
17195
17196 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17197 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17198 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17199 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17200 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17201 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17202 delivery to be deferred.
17203
17204 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17205 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17206 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17207 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17208 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17209 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17210
17211 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17212 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17213 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17214 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17215 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17216 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17217 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17218 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17219
17220 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17221 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17222 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17223 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17224 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17225 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17226 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17227 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17228 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17229 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17230
17231 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17232 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17233 subsequent routers.
17234
17235
17236 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17237 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17238 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17239 .cindex "transport" "local"
17240 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17241 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17242 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17243 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17244 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17245 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17246 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17247 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17248 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17249 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17250 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17251 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17252
17253
17254
17255 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17256 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17257 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17258
17259
17260 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17261 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17262 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
17263 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17264 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17265 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17266 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17267 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17268 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17269 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17270
17271 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17272 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17273 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17274 user or group.
17275
17276
17277 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17278 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17279 addresses,
17280 delivering in cutthrough mode
17281 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17282 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17283 are evaluated.
17284
17285
17286 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17287 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17288 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17289 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17290 are evaluated.
17291 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17292 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17293
17294
17295
17296
17297
17298
17299 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17301
17302 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17303 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17304 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17305 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17306 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17307 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17308 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17309 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17310 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17311 .code
17312 localusers:
17313 driver = accept
17314 domains = mydomain.example
17315 check_local_user
17316 transport = local_delivery
17317 .endd
17318 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17319 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17320 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17321 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17322
17323
17324
17325
17326
17327
17328 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17330
17331 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17332 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17333 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17334 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17335 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17336 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17337
17338 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17339 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17340 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17341 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17342 records.
17343
17344 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17345 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17346 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17347 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17348 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17349 generic option, the router declines.
17350
17351 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17352 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17353 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17354
17355 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17356 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17357 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17358 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17359 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17360 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17361
17362
17363 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17364 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17365 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17366 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17367 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17368 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17369
17370 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17371 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17372 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17373 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17374 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17375 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17376 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17377 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17378 case routing fails.
17379
17380
17381 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17382 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17383 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17384 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17385 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17386
17387 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17388 .ilist
17389 The domain does not exist in DNS
17390 .next
17391 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17392 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17393 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17394 .next
17395 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17396 .next
17397 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17398 .next
17399 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17400 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17401 .next
17402 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17403 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17404 .next
17405 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17406 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17407 .next
17408 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17409 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17410 .endlist
17411
17412
17413
17414
17415 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17416 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17417 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17418
17419 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17420 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17421 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17422 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17423 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17424 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17425 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17426
17427
17428 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17429 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17430 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17431 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17432 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17433 required. For example,
17434 .code
17435 check_srv = smtp
17436 .endd
17437 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17438 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17439 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17440 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17441 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17442 normal way.
17443
17444 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17445 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17446 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17447 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17448 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17449 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17450
17451 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17452 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17453 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17454 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17455 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17456 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17457 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17458 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17459
17460 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17461 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17462
17463
17464
17465 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17466 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17467 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17468 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17469 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17470 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17471 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17472 setting:
17473 .code
17474 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17475 .endd
17476 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17477 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17478 the address record.
17479
17480
17481 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17482 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17483 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17484 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17485
17486
17487
17488
17489 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17490 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17491 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17492 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17493 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17494 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17495 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17496 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17497 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17498 &'resolv.conf'&.
17499
17500
17501
17502 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17503 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17504 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17505 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17506 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17507 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17508 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17509 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17510 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17511 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17512 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17513
17514 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17515 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17516 sense.
17517
17518 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17519 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17520 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17521 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17522 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17523 header rewriting.
17524
17525
17526 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17527 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17528 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17529 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17530 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17531 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17532 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17533 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17534
17535 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17536 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17537 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17538 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17539 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17540 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17541 without processing them independently,
17542 provided the following conditions are met:
17543
17544 .ilist
17545 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17546 &%headers_remove%&.
17547 .next
17548 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17549 the domain.
17550 .endlist
17551
17552
17553
17554
17555 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17556 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17557 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17558 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17559 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17560 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17561 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17562 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17563 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17564 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17565
17566 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17567 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17568 local wildcard.
17569
17570
17571
17572 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17573 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17574 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17575 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17576
17577
17578
17579
17580 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17581 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17582 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17583 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17584 if
17585 .code
17586 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17587 .endd
17588 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17589 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17590 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17591 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17592 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17593 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17594
17595
17596 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17597 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17598 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17599 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17600 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17601
17602 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17603 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17604 such as that implied by
17605 .code
17606 domains = @mx_any
17607 .endd
17608 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17609 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17610 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17611 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17612
17613
17614
17615
17616
17617
17618
17619
17620
17621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17623
17624 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17625 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17626 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17627 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17628 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17629 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17630 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17631 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17632 router handles the address
17633 .code
17634 root@[192.168.1.1]
17635 .endd
17636 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17637 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17638 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17639 .code
17640 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17641 .endd
17642 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17643 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17644
17645 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17646 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17647 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17648 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17649
17650 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17651 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17652 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17653 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17654
17655
17656
17657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17659
17660 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17661 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17662 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17663 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17664 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17665 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17666 must set
17667 .code
17668 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17669 .endd
17670 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17671
17672 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17673 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17674 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17675 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17676 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17677 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17678 must not be specified for it.
17679
17680 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17681 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17682 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17683 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17684 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17685 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17686 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17687
17688
17689 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17690 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17691 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17692 delivery to the address is deferred.
17693
17694
17695 .option port iplookup integer 0
17696 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17697 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17698 call.
17699
17700
17701 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17702 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17703 protocols is to be used.
17704
17705
17706 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17707 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17708 default value is:
17709 .code
17710 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17711 .endd
17712 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17713 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17714
17715
17716 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17717 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17718 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17719 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17720 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17721 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17722 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17723 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17724
17725
17726 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17727 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17728 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17729 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17730 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17731 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17732 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17733 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17734 following could be used:
17735 .code
17736 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17737 reroute = $local_part@$1
17738 .endd
17739
17740 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17741 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17742 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17743 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17744
17745
17746
17747
17748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17750
17751 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17752 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17753 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17754 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17755 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17756 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17757 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17758 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17759 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17760 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17761
17762 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17763 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17764 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17765 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17766 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17767 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17768 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17769
17770 .vindex "&$host$&"
17771 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17772 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17773 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17774 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17775 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17776 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17777 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17778 text string.
17779
17780 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17781 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17782 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17783 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17784 below, following the list of private options.
17785
17786
17787 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17788
17789 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17790 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17791
17792 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17793 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17794
17795 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17796 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17797 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17798 of the following values:
17799 .code
17800 decline
17801 defer
17802 fail
17803 freeze
17804 ignore
17805 pass
17806 .endd
17807 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17808 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17809 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17810 &%pass_router%&),
17811 .oindex "&%more%&"
17812 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17813 router only if &%more%& is true.
17814
17815 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17816 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17817 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17818 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17819
17820 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17821 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17822 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17823
17824
17825 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17826 .cindex "randomized host list"
17827 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17828 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17829 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17830 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17831 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17832 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17833 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17834 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17835
17836 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17837 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17838 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17839 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17840 .code
17841 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17842 .endd
17843 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17844 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17845 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17846 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17847 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17848
17849
17850 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17851 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17852 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17853 example:
17854 .code
17855 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17856 .endd
17857 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17858 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17859 deferred.
17860
17861
17862 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17863 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17864 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17865 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17866
17867
17868 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17869 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17870 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17871 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17872 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17873 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17874 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17875 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17876
17877 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17878 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17879 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17880 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17881 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17882 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17883 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17884 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17885
17886
17887
17888
17889 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17890 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17891 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17892 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17893 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17894 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17895 .display
17896 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17897 .endd
17898 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17899 no options:
17900 .code
17901 route_list = \
17902 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17903 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17904 .endd
17905 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17906 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17907 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17908 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17909 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17910 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17911 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17912 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17913 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17914 in a &%route_list%&).
17915
17916 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17917 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17918 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17919 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17920
17921
17922
17923 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17924 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17925 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17926 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17927 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17928 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17929 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17930 like this:
17931 .code
17932 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17933 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17934 .endd
17935 This data can be accessed by setting
17936 .code
17937 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17938 .endd
17939 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17940 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17941 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17942 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17943 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17944
17945
17946
17947
17948 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17949 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17950 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17951 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17952 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17953 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17954 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17955
17956 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17957 variables are set during its expansion:
17958
17959 .ilist
17960 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17961 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17962 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17963 .code
17964 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17965 .endd
17966 .next
17967 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17968 .next
17969 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17970
17971 .next
17972 .vindex "&$value$&"
17973 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17974 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17975 .code
17976 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17977 .endd
17978 .endlist
17979
17980 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17981 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17982
17983
17984
17985 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17986 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17987 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17988 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17989 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17990 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17991
17992 .ilist
17993 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17994 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17995 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17996 .code
17997 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17998 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17999 .endd
18000 .next
18001 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18002 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18003 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18004 number follows. For example:
18005 .code
18006 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18007 .endd
18008 .endlist
18009
18010 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18011 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18012 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18013 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18014 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18015 transport.
18016
18017 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18018 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18019 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18020 records in the DNS. For example:
18021 .code
18022 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18023 .endd
18024 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18025 example:
18026 .code
18027 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18028 .endd
18029 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18030 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18031 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18032 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18033 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18034 happens is controlled by the
18035 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18036 &%self%& option of the router.
18037
18038 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18039 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18040 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18041 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18042 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18043 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18044 defined by MX preferences.
18045
18046 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18047 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18048 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18049
18050 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18051 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18052 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18053 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18054
18055 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18056 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18057 router.
18058
18059 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18060 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18061 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18062
18063 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18064 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18065
18066
18067
18068 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18069 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18070 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18071 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18072 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18073 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18074 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18075
18076 .ilist
18077 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18078 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18079 .next
18080 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18081 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18082 .next
18083 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18084 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18085 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18086 .next
18087 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18088 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18089 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18090 .endlist
18091
18092 For example:
18093 .code
18094 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18095 domain2 host4:host5
18096 .endd
18097 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18098 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18099 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18100 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18101 call.
18102
18103 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18104 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18105 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18106 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18107 function called.
18108
18109
18110
18111 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18112 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18113
18114 .vindex "&$host$&"
18115 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18116 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18117
18118
18119
18120 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18121 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18122 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18123
18124 .ilist
18125 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18126 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18127 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18128 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18129 .code
18130 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18131 .endd
18132 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18133 your first router something like this:
18134 .code
18135 smart_route:
18136 driver = manualroute
18137 domains = !+local_domains
18138 transport = remote_smtp
18139 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18140 .endd
18141 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18142 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18143 they are tried in order
18144 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18145 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18146 .code
18147 smart_route:
18148 driver = manualroute
18149 transport = remote_smtp
18150 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18151 .endd
18152 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18153 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18154 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18155 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18156 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18157 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18158 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18159 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18160
18161 .next
18162 .cindex "mail hub example"
18163 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18164 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18165 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18166 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18167 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18168 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18169 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18170 lookup is easier to manage.
18171
18172 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18173 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18174 example:
18175 .code
18176 hub_route:
18177 driver = manualroute
18178 transport = remote_smtp
18179 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18180 .endd
18181 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18182 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18183 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18184 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18185 domain can be used to find the host:
18186 .code
18187 through_firewall:
18188 driver = manualroute
18189 transport = remote_smtp
18190 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18191 .endd
18192 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18193 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18194 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18195 next router.
18196
18197 .next
18198 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18199 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18200 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18201 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18202 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18203 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18204 .code
18205 save_in_file:
18206 driver = manualroute
18207 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18208 route_list = saved.domain.example
18209 .endd
18210 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18211 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18212 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18213 .code
18214 save_in_file:
18215 driver = manualroute
18216 route_list = \
18217 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18218 *.saved.domain2.example \
18219 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18220 batch_pipe
18221 .endd
18222 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18223 .vindex "&$host$&"
18224 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18225 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18226 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18227 the address if the lookup fails.
18228
18229 .next
18230 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18231 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18232 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18233 one way it can be done:
18234 .code
18235 # Transport
18236 uucp:
18237 driver = pipe
18238 user = nobody
18239 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18240 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18241 return_fail_output = true
18242
18243 # Router
18244 uucphost:
18245 transport = uucp
18246 driver = manualroute
18247 route_data = \
18248 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18249 .endd
18250 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18251 .code
18252 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18253 .endd
18254 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18255 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18256 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18257 .endlist
18258 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18259 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18260
18261
18262
18263
18264
18265
18266
18267
18268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18269 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18270
18271 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18272 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18273 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18274 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18275 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18276 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18277 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18278 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18279 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18280 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18281 options:
18282 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18283
18284 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18285 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18286 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18287 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18288 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18289
18290
18291 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18292 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18293 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18294 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18295 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18296 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18297
18298
18299 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18300 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18301 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18302 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18303 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18304 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18305 not set, a value for the gid also.
18306
18307 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18308 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18309 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18310 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18311 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18312 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18313 gid.
18314
18315
18316 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18317 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18318 before running the command.
18319
18320
18321 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18322 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18323 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18324 timeout.
18325
18326
18327 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18328 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18329 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18330 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18331 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18332
18333 .ilist
18334 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18335 below).
18336 .next
18337 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18338 &%no_more%& is set.
18339 .next
18340 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18341 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18342 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18343 included in the SMTP response.
18344 .next
18345 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18346 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18347 included in any SMTP response.
18348 .next
18349 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18350 .next
18351 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18352 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18353 .next
18354 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18355 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18356 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18357 .endlist
18358
18359 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18360 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18361 the page):
18362 .code
18363 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18364 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18365 .endd
18366 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18367 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18368 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18369 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18370
18371 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18372 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18373 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18374 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18375 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18376
18377 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18378 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18379 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18380 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18381 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18382
18383 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18384 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18385 variable. For example, this return line
18386 .code
18387 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18388 .endd
18389 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18390 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18391 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18392 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18393
18394
18395
18396
18397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18399
18400 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18401 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18402 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18403 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18404 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18405 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18406 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18407 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18408 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18409 redirected in several different ways:
18410
18411 .ilist
18412 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18413 independently.
18414 .next
18415 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18416 .next
18417 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18418 .next
18419 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18420 .next
18421 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18422 .next
18423 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18424 .next
18425 It can be discarded.
18426 .endlist
18427
18428 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18429 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18430 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18431 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18432
18433
18434
18435 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18436 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18437 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18438 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18439 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18440 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18441 .code
18442 system_aliases:
18443 driver = redirect
18444 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18445 .endd
18446 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18447 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18448 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18449 cause delivery to be deferred.
18450
18451 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18452 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18453 .code
18454 userforward:
18455 driver = redirect
18456 check_local_user
18457 file = $home/.forward
18458 no_verify
18459 .endd
18460 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18461 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18462 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18463 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18464 comments.
18465
18466
18467
18468 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18469 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18470 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18471 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18472
18473 .ilist
18474 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18475 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18476 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18477 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18478 .next
18479 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18480 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18481 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18482 saves some resources.
18483 .endlist
18484
18485
18486
18487
18488
18489
18490 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18491 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18492 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18493 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18494 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18495
18496 .ilist
18497 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18498 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18499 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18500 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18501 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18502 document is intended for use by end users.
18503 .next
18504 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18505 described in the next section.
18506 .endlist
18507
18508 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18509 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18510 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18511 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18512 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18513
18514
18515
18516 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18517 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18518 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18519 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18520 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18521 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18522 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18523 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18524 commas or newlines.
18525 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18526 quotes.
18527
18528 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18529 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18530 next newline character is ignored.
18531
18532 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18533 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18534 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18535 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18536 removed.
18537
18538 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18539 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18540 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18541 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18542 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18543 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18544 setting:
18545 .code
18546 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18547 .endd
18548
18549
18550 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18551 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18552 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18553 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18554 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18555 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18556 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18557 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18558 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18559 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18560 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18561
18562 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18563 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18564 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18565 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18566 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18567 .code
18568 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18569 .endd
18570 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18571 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18572 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18573 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18574 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18575 synonymously.
18576
18577 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18578 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18579 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18580 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18581 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18582
18583 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18584 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18585 contains:
18586 .code
18587 Sam.Reman: spqr
18588 .endd
18589 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18590 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18591 this forward file:
18592 .code
18593 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18594 .endd
18595 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18596 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18597 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18598 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18599 should really contain
18600 .code
18601 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18602 .endd
18603 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18604 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18605 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18606
18607
18608
18609 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18610 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18611 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18612
18613 .ilist
18614 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18615 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18616 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18617 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18618 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18619 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18620 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18621
18622 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18623 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18624 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18625 in double quotes, for example:
18626 .code
18627 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18628 .endd
18629 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18630 quote just the command. An item such as
18631 .code
18632 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18633 .endd
18634 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18635
18636 .new
18637 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18638 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18639 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18640 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18641 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18642 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18643 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18644 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18645 an &%accept%& router.
18646 .wen
18647
18648 .next
18649 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18650 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18651 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18652 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18653 .code
18654 /home/world/minbari
18655 .endd
18656 is treated as a file name, but
18657 .code
18658 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18659 .endd
18660 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18661 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18662 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18663 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18664
18665 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18666 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18667
18668 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18669 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18670 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18671 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18672
18673 .next
18674 .cindex "included address list"
18675 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18676 If an item is of the form
18677 .code
18678 :include:<path name>
18679 .endd
18680 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18681 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18682 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18683 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18684 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18685 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18686 .code
18687 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18688 .endd
18689 It must be given as
18690 .code
18691 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18692 .endd
18693 .next
18694 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18695 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18696 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18697 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18698 .cindex "black hole"
18699 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18700 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18701 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18702 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18703
18704 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18705 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18706 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18707 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18708 &_/dev/null_&.
18709
18710 .next
18711 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18712 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18713 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18714 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18715 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18716 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18717 redirection items of the form
18718 .code
18719 :defer:
18720 :fail:
18721 .endd
18722 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18723 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18724 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18725 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18726 .code
18727 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18728 .endd
18729 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18730 of a
18731 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18732 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18733 default.
18734 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18735 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18736 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18737
18738 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18739 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18740 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18741 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18742 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18743 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18744 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18745 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18746 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18747 ignored.
18748
18749 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18750 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18751 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18752 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18753
18754 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18755 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18756 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18757 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18758 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18759
18760 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18761 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18762 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18763 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18764 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18765 rules still apply.
18766
18767 .next
18768 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18769 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18770 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18771 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18772 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18773 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18774 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18775 .endlist
18776
18777
18778 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18779 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18780 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18781 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18782 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18783 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18784 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18785 aliasing scheme of the type
18786 .code
18787 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18788 localpart1: pipe
18789 localpart2: pipe
18790 .endd
18791 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18792 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18793 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18794 such as
18795 .code
18796 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18797 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18798 .endd
18799 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18800 the pipes are distinct.
18801
18802
18803
18804 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18805 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18806 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18807 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18808 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18809 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18810 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18811 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18812 can be used to avoid this.
18813
18814
18815 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18816 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18817 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18818 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18819 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18820 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18821 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18822
18823
18824
18825 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18826
18827 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18828 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18829
18830
18831 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18832 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18833 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18834
18835
18836 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18837 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18838 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18839 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18840
18841
18842 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18843 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18844 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18845 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18846 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18847 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18848 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18849
18850 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18851 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18852
18853
18854 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18855 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18856 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18857 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18858 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18859
18860
18861
18862 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18863 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18864 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18865 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18866 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18867 let ordinary users do.
18868
18869
18870
18871 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18872 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18873 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18874 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18875 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18876 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18877
18878 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18879 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18880 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18881 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18882 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18883 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18884 .code
18885 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18886 .endd
18887 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18888 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18889 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18890 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18891 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18892 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18893 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18894 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18895
18896
18897 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18898 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18899 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18900 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18901 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18902 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18903 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18904 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18905
18906
18907
18908 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18909 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18910 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18911 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18912 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18913 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18914
18915
18916 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18917 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18918 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18919 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18920 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18921 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18922
18923 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18924 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18925 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18926 .code
18927 data = #Exim filter\n\
18928 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18929 .endd
18930 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18931 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18932 choice into a newline.
18933
18934
18935 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18936 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18937 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18938 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18939 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18940
18941
18942 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18943 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18944 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18945 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18946 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18947 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18948 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18949 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18950
18951 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18952 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18953 runs a check on the containing directory,
18954 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18955 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18956 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18957 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18958 not, the router declines.
18959
18960
18961 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18962 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18963 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18964 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18965 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18966 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18967 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18968
18969
18970 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18971 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18972 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18973 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18974 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18975
18976
18977 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18978 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18979 redirection list.
18980
18981
18982 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18983 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18984 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18985
18986
18987
18988
18989 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18990 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18991 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18992 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18993 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18994 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18995 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18996 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18997 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18998
18999
19000 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19001 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19002 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19003 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19004 functions.
19005
19006 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19007 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19008 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19009 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19010
19011 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19012 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19013 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19014 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19015 &_.forward_& files).
19016
19017
19018 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19019 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19020 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19021
19022
19023 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19024 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19025 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19026 of the embedded Perl support.
19027
19028
19029 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19030 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19031 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19032
19033
19034 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19035 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19036 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19037
19038
19039 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19040 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19041 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19042 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19043 &%one_time%& is set.
19044
19045
19046 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19047 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19048 to make use of &%run%& items.
19049
19050
19051 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19052 If this option is true, items of the form
19053 .code
19054 :include:<path name>
19055 .endd
19056 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19057
19058
19059 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19060 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19061 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19062 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19063 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19064
19065
19066 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19067 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19068 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19069
19070
19071 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19072 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19073 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19074 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19075 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19076
19077
19078
19079
19080 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19081 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19082 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19083 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19084 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19085 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19086 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19087
19088
19089 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19090 .cindex "EACCES"
19091 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19092 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19093 file did not exist.
19094
19095
19096 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19097 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19098 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19099 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19100 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19101
19102 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19103 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19104 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19105 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19106 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19107 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19108 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19109 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19110
19111
19112
19113 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19114 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19115 redirection list must start with this directory.
19116
19117
19118 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19119 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19120 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19121
19122
19123 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19124 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19125 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19126 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19127 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19128 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19129 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19130 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19131 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19132 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19133 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19134 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19135 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19136 before they subscribed.
19137
19138 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19139 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19140 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19141 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19142 attempt.
19143
19144 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19145 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19146 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19147 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19148
19149 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19150 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19151 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19152
19153 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19154 &%one_time%&.
19155
19156 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19157 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19158 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19159 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19160 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19161 expansion.
19162
19163
19164 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19165 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19166 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19167 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19168 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19169 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19170 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19171 See &%check_owner%& above.
19172
19173
19174 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19175 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19176 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19177 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19178
19179
19180 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19181 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19182 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19183 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19184 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19185 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19186 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19187
19188
19189 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19190 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19191 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19192 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19193 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19194 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19195 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19196 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19197
19198 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19199 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19200 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19201 addresses.
19202
19203 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19204 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19205 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19206 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19207 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19208 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19209 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19210 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19211 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19212 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19213
19214
19215 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19216 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19217 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19218 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19219 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19220 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19221
19222
19223 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19224 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19225 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19226 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19227 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19228 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19229
19230
19231 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19232 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19233 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19234 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19235 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19236
19237
19238 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19239 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19240 :subaddress part of an address.
19241
19242 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19243 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19244 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19245 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19246
19247
19248 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19249 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19250 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19251 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19252 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19253 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19254 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19255
19256
19257
19258 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19259 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19260 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19261 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19262 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19263 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19264 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19265 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19266 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19267 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19268 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19269 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19270 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19271 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19272 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19273 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19274
19275 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19276 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19277 the following routers.
19278
19279 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19280 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19281 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19282 so it is passed to the following routers.
19283
19284 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19285 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19286 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19287 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19288
19289 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19290 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19291 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19292 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19293 .code
19294 userforward:
19295 driver = redirect
19296 allow_filter
19297 check_local_user
19298 file = $home/.forward
19299 file_transport = address_file
19300 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19301 reply_transport = address_reply
19302 no_verify
19303 skip_syntax_errors
19304 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19305 syntax_errors_text = \
19306 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19307 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19308 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19309 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19310 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19311 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19312 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19313 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19314 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19315 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19316 .endd
19317 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19318 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19319 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19320 .code
19321 real_localuser:
19322 driver = accept
19323 check_local_user
19324 local_part_prefix = real-
19325 transport = local_delivery
19326 .endd
19327 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19328 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19329 .code
19330 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19331 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19332 .endd
19333
19334
19335 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19336 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19337
19338
19339 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19340 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19341 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19342 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19343
19344
19345
19346
19347
19348
19349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19351
19352 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19353 "Environment for local transports"
19354 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19355 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19356 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19357 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19358 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19359 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19360 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19361
19362 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19363 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19364 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19365 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19366
19367 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19368 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19369 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19370 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19371 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19372
19373
19374
19375 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19376 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19377 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19378 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19379 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19380 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19381 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19382 time.
19383
19384 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19385 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19386 .code
19387 my_transport:
19388 driver = pipe
19389 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19390 .endd
19391 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19392 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19393 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19394 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19395
19396
19397
19398
19399 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19400 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19401 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19402 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19403 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19404 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19405 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19406 group (set by the transport). For example:
19407 .code
19408 # Routers ...
19409 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19410 local_users:
19411 driver = accept
19412 check_local_user
19413 transport = group_delivery
19414
19415 # Transports ...
19416 # This transport overrides the group
19417 group_delivery:
19418 driver = appendfile
19419 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19420 group = mail
19421 .endd
19422 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19423 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19424 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19425 set.
19426
19427 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19428 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19429 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19430 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19431 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19432 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19433
19434 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19435 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19436 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19437 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19438 original gid is also used.
19439
19440 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19441 following that is set is used:
19442
19443 .ilist
19444 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19445 .next
19446 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19447 .next
19448 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19449 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19450 .next
19451 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19452 .next
19453 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19454 the uid is the creator's uid;
19455 .next
19456 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19457 .endlist
19458
19459 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19460 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19461 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19462 The first of the following that is set is used:
19463
19464 .ilist
19465 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19466 .next
19467 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19468 .next
19469 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19470 .next
19471 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19472 .next
19473 The Exim uid.
19474 .endlist
19475
19476 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19477 &%never_users%& list.
19478
19479
19480
19481
19482
19483 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19484 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19485 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19486 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19487 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19488 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19489 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19490 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19491 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19492 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19493
19494 .ilist
19495 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19496 .next
19497 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19498 .next
19499 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19500 .next
19501 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19502 .endlist
19503
19504 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19505
19506 .ilist
19507 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19508 .next
19509 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19510 .endlist
19511
19512
19513 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19514 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19515 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19516
19517
19518
19519 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19520 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19521 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19522 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19523 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19524 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19525 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19526 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19527 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19528 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19529 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19530 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19531 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19532 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19533
19534
19535
19536
19537
19538
19539
19540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19542
19543 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19544 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19545 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19546 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19547 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19548
19549
19550 .option body_only transports boolean false
19551 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19552 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19553 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19554 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19555 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19556 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19557 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19558 automatically suppress them.
19559
19560
19561 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19562 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19563 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19564 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19565 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19566 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19567
19568
19569 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19570 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19571 deliveries by the transport or for any
19572 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19573 what you are doing.
19574
19575
19576 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19577 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19578 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19579 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19580 transport is run.
19581 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19582 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19583 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19584 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19585 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19586 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19587 one.
19588
19589
19590 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19591 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19592 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19593 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19594 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19595 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19596 safely be resent to other recipients.
19597
19598
19599 .option driver transports string unset
19600 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19601 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19602
19603
19604 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19605 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19606 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19607 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19608 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19609 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19610 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19611 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19612 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19613 resent to other recipients.
19614
19615
19616 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19617 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19618 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19619 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19620 &%user%& (see below).
19621
19622
19623 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19624 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19625 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19626 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19627 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19628 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19629 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19630 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19631 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19632
19633 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19634 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19635
19636
19637
19638 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19639 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19640 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19641 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19642 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19643 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19644 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19645 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19646
19647
19648 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19649 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19650 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19651 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19652 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19653 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19654 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19655 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19656 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19657
19658 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19659 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19660
19661
19662
19663 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19664 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19665 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19666 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19667 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19668 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19669 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19670 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19671 example,
19672 .code
19673 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19674 x@y w@z
19675 .endd
19676 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19677 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19678 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19679 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19680 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19681 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19682 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19683 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19684 change envelope recipients at this time.
19685
19686
19687 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19688 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19689 .vindex "&$home$&"
19690 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19691 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19692 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19693 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19694 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19695 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19696 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19697 deferred.
19698
19699
19700 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19701 .cindex "additional groups"
19702 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19703 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19704 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19705 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19706 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19707
19708
19709 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19710 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19711 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19712 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19713 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19714 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19715 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19716 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19717 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19718 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19719 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19720 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19721 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19722 delivered.
19723
19724
19725
19726 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19727 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19728 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19729 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19730 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19731 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19732 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19733 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19734 that contains
19735 .code
19736 local_part_prefix = *-
19737 .endd
19738 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19739 is delivered with
19740 .code
19741 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19742 .endd
19743 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19744 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19745 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19746 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19747 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19748
19749
19750 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19751 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19752 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19753 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19754 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19755 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19756 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19757 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19758 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19759
19760 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19761 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19762 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19763 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19764
19765 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19766 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19767 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19768
19769
19770 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19771 .cindex "envelope sender"
19772 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19773 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19774 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19775 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19776 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19777 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19778 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19779 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19780 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19781
19782 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19783 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19784
19785 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19786 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19787 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19788 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19789 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19790 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19791 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19792
19793 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19794 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19795 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19796 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19797 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19798
19799
19800
19801 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19802 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19803 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19804 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19805 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19806 have easy access to it.
19807
19808 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19809 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19810 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19811 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19812 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19813 recipients.
19814
19815
19816 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19817 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19818
19819
19820 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19821 .cindex "shadow transport"
19822 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19823 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19824 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19825
19826 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19827 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19828 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19829 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19830 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19831 cause a log line to be written.
19832
19833 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19834 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19835 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19836 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19837 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19838 of the form
19839 .code
19840 ST=<shadow transport name>
19841 .endd
19842 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19843 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19844 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19845 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19846 headers that some sites insist on.
19847
19848
19849 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19850 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19851 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19852 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19853 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19854 individual users or via a system filter.
19855
19856 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19857 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19858 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19859 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19860 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19861
19862 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19863 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19864 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19865 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19866 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19867 &(pipe)& transports.
19868
19869 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19870 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19871 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19872 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19873 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19874
19875 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19876 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19877 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19878 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19879
19880 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19881 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19882 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19883 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19884 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19885 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19886
19887 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19888 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19889 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19890 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19891 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19892 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19893 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19894 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19895
19896 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19897 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19898 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19899 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19900 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19901 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19902 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19903 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19904 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19905 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19906
19907 .vindex "&$host$&"
19908 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19909 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19910 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19911 which the message is being sent. For example:
19912 .code
19913 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19914 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19915 .endd
19916
19917 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19918 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19919 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19920 .ilist
19921 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19922 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19923 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19924 example:
19925 .code
19926 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19927 .endd
19928 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19929 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19930 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19931 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19932 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19933 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19934 .next
19935 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19936 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19937 arguments. Consider this example:
19938 .code
19939 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19940 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19941 .endd
19942 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19943 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19944 .code
19945 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19946 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19947 .endd
19948 .endlist
19949
19950 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19951 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19952 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19953 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19954 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19955 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19956 bounced from a transport filter.
19957
19958 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19959 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19960 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19961
19962
19963 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19964 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19965 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
19966 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19967 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19968 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19969 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19970 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19971 becomes a temporary error.
19972
19973
19974 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19975 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19976 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19977 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19978 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19979 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19980 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19981 option is not set.
19982
19983 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19984 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19985 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19986
19987 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19988 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19989 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19990 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19991 retry data.
19992 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19993 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19994 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19995
19996
19997
19998
19999
20000
20001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20003
20004 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20005 "Address batching"
20006 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20007 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20008 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20009 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20010 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20011 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20012 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20013
20014 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20015 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20016 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20017 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20018 local transport, for example:
20019
20020 .ilist
20021 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20022 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20023 recipients saves space.
20024 .next
20025 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20026 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20027 .next
20028 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20029 to a scanner program or
20030 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20031 acceptable.
20032 .endlist
20033
20034 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20035 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20036 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20037
20038 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20039 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20040 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20041 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20042 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20043 to certain conditions:
20044
20045 .ilist
20046 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20047 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20048 batching is possible.
20049 .next
20050 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20051 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20052 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20053 .next
20054 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20055 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20056 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20057 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20058 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20059 from taking place.
20060 .next
20061 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20062 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20063 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20064 be the same.
20065 .endlist
20066
20067 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20068 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20069 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20070 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20071 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20072 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20073 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20074 .code
20075 check_string = "."
20076 escape_string = ".."
20077 .endd
20078 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20079 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20080 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20081
20082 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20083 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20084 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20085 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20086 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20087 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20088
20089 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20090 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20091 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20092 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20093 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20094 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20095 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20096 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20097 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20098
20099
20100
20101
20102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20103 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20104
20105 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20106 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20107 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20108 .cindex "directory creation"
20109 .cindex "creating directories"
20110 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20111 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20112 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20113 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20114 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20115 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20116 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20117 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20118 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20119 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20120
20121 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20122 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20123 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20124 included.
20125
20126 .cindex "quota" "system"
20127 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20128 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20129 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20130
20131 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20132 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20133 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20134 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20135
20136 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20137 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20138 private options.
20139
20140 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20141 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20142 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20143 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20144 option).
20145
20146
20147
20148 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20149 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20150 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20151 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20152 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20153
20154 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20155 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20156 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20157 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20158 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20159 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20160 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20161 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20162 operation. There are two cases:
20163
20164 .ilist
20165 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20166 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20167 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20168 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20169 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20170 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20171 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20172 .next
20173 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20174 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20175 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20176 .endlist
20177
20178
20179 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20180 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20181 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20182 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20183 form:
20184 .code
20185 save folder23
20186 .endd
20187 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20188 .code
20189 require "fileinto";
20190 fileinto "folder23";
20191 .endd
20192 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20193 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20194 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20195 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20196 way of handling this requirement:
20197 .code
20198 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20199 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20200 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20201 {$address_file} \
20202 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20203 }} \
20204 }
20205 .endd
20206 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20207 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20208 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20209
20210 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20211 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20212 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20213 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20214 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20215 path to the transport.
20216
20217 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20218 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20219
20220
20221
20222
20223 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20224 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20225
20226
20227
20228 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20229 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20230 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20231 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20232 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20233 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20234 delivery is deferred.
20235
20236
20237 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20238 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20239 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20240 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20241 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20242 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20243 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20244 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20245
20246
20247 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20248 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20249 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20250 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20251 file.
20252
20253
20254 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20255 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20256
20257
20258 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20259 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20260 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20261 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20262 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20263
20264
20265 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20266 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20267 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20268 process is running.
20269
20270
20271 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20272 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20273 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20274 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20275 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20276 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20277 contains is significant.
20278
20279 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20280 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20281 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20282 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20283 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20284
20285 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20286 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20287 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20288 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20289 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20290 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20291 .code
20292 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20293 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20294 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20295 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20296 .endd
20297 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20298 .cindex "directory creation"
20299 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20300 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20301 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20302
20303 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20304 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20305 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20306 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20307 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20308
20309
20310
20311 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20312 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20313 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20314 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20315 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20316 beneath.
20317
20318 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20319 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20320 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20321 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20322 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20323 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20324 &%file_must_exist%&.
20325
20326
20327 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20328 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20329 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20330 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20331
20332 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20333 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20334 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20335 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20336 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20337
20338
20339 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20340 .cindex "base62"
20341 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20342 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20343 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20344 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20345 .code
20346 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20347 .endd
20348 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20349 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20350 option.
20351
20352
20353 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20354 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20355 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20356
20357
20358 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20359 See &%check_string%& above.
20360
20361
20362 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20363 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20364 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20365 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20366 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20367 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20368 &%file%&.
20369
20370 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20371 .cindex "locking files"
20372 .cindex "lock files"
20373 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20374 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20375
20376 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20377 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20378 examples:
20379 .code
20380 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20381 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20382 file = $home/inbox
20383 .endd
20384 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20385 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20386 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20387 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20388 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20389 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20390
20391
20392
20393 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20394 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20395 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20396 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20397 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20398 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20399 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20400 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20401 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20402 this added to it:
20403 .code
20404 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20405 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20406 .endd
20407 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20408 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20409 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20410 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20411 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20412 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20413 delivery is deferred.
20414
20415
20416 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20417 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20418 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20419 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20420
20421
20422 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20423 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20424 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20425 .cindex "locking files"
20426 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20427 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20428 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20429 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20430 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20431 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20432 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20433 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20434
20435 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20436 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20437 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20438 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20439
20440 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20441 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20442 retries is
20443 .code
20444 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20445 .endd
20446 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20447 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20448 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20449
20450 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20451 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20452 .code
20453 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20454 .endd
20455
20456 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20457 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20458 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20459 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20460
20461
20462 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20463 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20464 for details of locking.
20465
20466
20467 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20468 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20469 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20470
20471
20472 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20473 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20474 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20475
20476
20477 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20478 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20479 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20480 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20481 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20482
20483
20484 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20485 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20486 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20487 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20488 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20489 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20490 external source that maintains the data.
20491
20492
20493 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20494 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20495 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20496 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20497 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20498 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20499 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20500 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20501
20502
20503
20504 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20505 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20506 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20507 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20508 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20509 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20510 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20511 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20512 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20513 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20514
20515
20516 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20517 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20518 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20519 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20520 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20521 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20522 calculation. The default value is:
20523 .code
20524 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20525 .endd
20526 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20527 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20528 &_Trash_&
20529 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20530 .code
20531 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20532 .endd
20533 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20534 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20535 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20536 directly into that directory.
20537
20538
20539 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20540 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20541 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20542
20543
20544 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20545 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20546 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20547
20548
20549 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20550 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20551 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20552 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20553 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20554 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20555 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20556 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20557
20558 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20559 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20560 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20561 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20562 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20563 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20564 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20565 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20566 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20567 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20568
20569
20570 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20571 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20572 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20573 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20574 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20575 below for further details.
20576
20577
20578 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20579 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20580 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20581
20582
20583 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20584 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20585 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20586
20587
20588 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20589 .cindex "locking files"
20590 .cindex "file" "locking"
20591 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20592 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20593 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20594 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20595 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20596 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20597 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20598
20599 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20600 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20601 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20602 combination:
20603 .code
20604 mbx_format = true
20605 message_prefix =
20606 message_suffix =
20607 .endd
20608 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20609 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20610 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20611 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20612 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20613 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20614 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20615 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20616
20617 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20618 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20619 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20620 append messages to it.
20621
20622
20623 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20624 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20625 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20626 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20627 in which case it is:
20628 .code
20629 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20630 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20631 .endd
20632 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20633 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20634
20635 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20636 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20637 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20638 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20639 setting
20640 .code
20641 message_suffix =
20642 .endd
20643 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20644 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20645
20646 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20647 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20648 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20649 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20650 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20651 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20652 value, and this option is ignored.
20653
20654
20655 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20656 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20657 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20658 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20659 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20660
20661
20662 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20663 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20664 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20665 on users about incoming mail.
20666
20667
20668 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20669 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20670 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20671 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20672 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20673 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20674 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20675 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20676 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20677
20678 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20679 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20680 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20681
20682 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20683 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20684 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20685 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20686 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20687 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20688
20689 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20690 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20691 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20692 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20693 be handled.
20694
20695 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20696
20697 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20698 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20699 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20700 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20701 system quota failures.
20702
20703 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20704 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20705 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20706 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20707 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20708 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20709 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20710 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20711 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20712 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20713
20714
20715 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20716 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20717 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20718 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20719 delivery directory.
20720
20721
20722 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20723 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20724 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20725 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20726 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20727 &"no quota"&.
20728
20729
20730 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20731 See &%quota%& above.
20732
20733
20734 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20735 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20736 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20737 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20738 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20739 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20740 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20741
20742 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20743 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20744 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20745 the file length to the file name. For example:
20746 .code
20747 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20748 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20749 .endd
20750 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20751 number of lines in the message.
20752
20753 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20754 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20755 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20756
20757 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20758
20759
20760 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20761 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20762 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20763 .code
20764 quota_warn_message = "\
20765 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20766 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20767 This message is automatically created \
20768 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20769 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20770 a warning threshold that is\n\
20771 set by the system administrator.\n"
20772 .endd
20773
20774
20775 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20776 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20777 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20778 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20779 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20780 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20781 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20782 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20783 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20784 sign. For example:
20785 .code
20786 quota = 10M
20787 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20788 .endd
20789 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20790 percent sign is ignored.
20791
20792 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20793 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20794 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20795 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20796 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20797 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20798 .code
20799 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20800 .endd
20801 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20802 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20803 option.
20804
20805 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20806 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20807 percentage.
20808
20809
20810 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20811 .cindex "envelope sender"
20812 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20813 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20814 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20815 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20816 for details of batch SMTP.
20817
20818
20819 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20820 .cindex "carriage return"
20821 .cindex "linefeed"
20822 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20823 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20824 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20825 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20826
20827 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20828 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20829 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20830 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20831 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20832 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20833
20834
20835 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20836 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20837 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20838 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20839 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20840 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20841
20842
20843 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20844 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20845 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20846 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20847 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20848
20849 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20850 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20851 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20852 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20853
20854 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20855 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20856 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20857 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20858 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20859 error.
20860
20861 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20862 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20863
20864
20865 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20866 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20867 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20868 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20869 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20870 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20871 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20872
20873 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20874 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20875 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20876 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20877 file corruption.
20878
20879 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20880 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20881 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20882
20883
20884 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20885 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20886 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20887 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20888 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20889 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20890 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20891 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20892 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20893
20894 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20895 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20896 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20897 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20898
20899
20900
20901
20902 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20903 .cindex "appending to a file"
20904 .cindex "file" "appending"
20905 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20906
20907 .ilist
20908 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20909 return is given.
20910
20911 .next
20912 .cindex "directory creation"
20913 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20914 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20915 &%directory_mode%& option.
20916
20917 .next
20918 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20919 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20920 transport.
20921
20922 .next
20923 .cindex "file" "locking"
20924 .cindex "locking files"
20925 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20926 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20927 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20928
20929 .olist
20930 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20931 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20932 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20933 .next
20934 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20935 .next
20936 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20937 Unlink the hitching post name.
20938 .next
20939 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20940 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20941 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20942 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20943 .next
20944 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20945 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20946 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20947 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20948 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20949 it before trying again.
20950 .endlist olist
20951
20952 .next
20953 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20954 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20955 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20956
20957 .next
20958 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20959 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20960 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20961 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20962 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20963 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20964 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20965 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20966 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20967 checked.
20968
20969 .next
20970 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20971 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20972 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20973 delivery is deferred.
20974
20975 .next
20976 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20977 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20978 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20979 permissions.
20980
20981 .next
20982 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20983 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20984 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20985
20986 .next
20987 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20988 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20989 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20990
20991 .next
20992 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20993 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20994 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20995 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20996 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20997 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20998 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20999 that prevents link following.
21000
21001 .next
21002 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21003 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21004 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21005 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21006 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21007
21008 .next
21009 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21010
21011 .next
21012 .cindex "file" "locking"
21013 .cindex "locking files"
21014 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21015 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21016 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21017 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21018 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21019 .code
21020 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21021 .endd
21022 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21023 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21024 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21025
21026 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21027 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21028 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21029
21030 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21031 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21032 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21033 delivery is deferred.
21034
21035 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21036 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21037 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21038 immediately. It retries up to
21039 .code
21040 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21041 .endd
21042 times (rounded up).
21043 .endlist
21044
21045 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21046 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21047
21048
21049 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21050 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21051 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21052 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21053 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21054 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21055 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21056 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21057 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21058 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21059
21060 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21061 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21062 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21063 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21064 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21065 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21066 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21067
21068 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21069 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21070 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21071 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21072
21073
21074 .cindex "maildir format"
21075 .cindex "mailstore format"
21076 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21077 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21078 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21079 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21080 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21081
21082 .cindex "directory creation"
21083 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21084 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21085 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21086 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21087 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21088 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21089 deferred.
21090
21091
21092
21093 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21094 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21095 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21096 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21097 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21098 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21099 &_new_& subdirectory.
21100
21101 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21102 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21103 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21104 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21105 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21106 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21107 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21108
21109 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21110 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21111 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21112 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21113 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21114 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21115 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21116 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21117
21118 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21119 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21120 folders. Consider this example:
21121 .code
21122 maildir_format = true
21123 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21124 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21125 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21126 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21127 .endd
21128 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21129 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21130 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21131 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21132 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21133 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21134
21135 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21136 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21137 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21138 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21139 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21140
21141 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21142 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21143 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21144
21145 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21146 .cindex "maildir++"
21147 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21148 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21149 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21150 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21151 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21152 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21153 amount of space used.
21154
21155 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21156 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21157 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21158 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21159 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21160 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21161
21162
21163
21164
21165 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21166 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21167 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21168 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21169 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21170 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21171
21172
21173 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21174 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21175 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21176 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21177 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21178 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21179 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21180 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21181 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21182 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21183 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21184 backwards compatibility).
21185
21186 For one common implementation, you might set:
21187 .code
21188 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21189 .endd
21190 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21191
21192 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21193 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21194 &[stat()]& each message file.
21195
21196
21197 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21198 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21199 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21200 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21201 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21202 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21203 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21204 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21205 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21206
21207 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21208 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21209 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21210 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21211 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21212 need to know the quota.
21213
21214 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21215 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21216
21217 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21218 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21219 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21220 details.
21221
21222
21223 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21224 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21225 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21226 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21227 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21228 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21229 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21230 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21231
21232 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21233 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21234 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21235 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21236 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21237 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21238
21239 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21240 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21241 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21242 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21243 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21244 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21245
21246 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21247 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21248 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21249 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21250
21251
21252 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21253 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21254 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21255 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21256 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21257 .code
21258 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21259 .endd
21260 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21261 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21262 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21263 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21264 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21265
21266
21267
21268
21269
21270
21271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21273
21274 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21275 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21276 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21277 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21278 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21279 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21280 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21281 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21282
21283 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21284 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21285 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21286 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21287 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21288
21289
21290 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21291 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21292 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21293 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21294 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21295
21296 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21297 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21298 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21299 transport is run as a consequence of a
21300 &%mail%&
21301 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21302 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21303 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21304 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21305 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21306 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21307
21308 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21309 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21310 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21311 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21312
21313 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21314 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21315 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21316 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21317 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21318 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21319 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21320
21321 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21322 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21323 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21324 the transport defers.
21325 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21326 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21327
21328 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21329 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21330 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21331 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21332
21333 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21334 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21335 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21336 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21337 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21338 problems. They are just discarded.
21339
21340
21341
21342 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21343 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21344
21345 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21346 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21347 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21348
21349
21350 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21351 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21352 when the message is specified by the transport.
21353
21354
21355 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21356 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21357 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21358 string comes first.
21359
21360
21361 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21362 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21363 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21364
21365
21366 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21367 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21368 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21369
21370
21371 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21372 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21373 specified by the transport.
21374
21375
21376 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21377 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21378 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21379 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21380
21381
21382 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21383 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21384 the message is specified by the transport.
21385
21386
21387 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21388 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21389 used.
21390
21391
21392 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21393 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21394 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21395 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21396 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21397
21398
21399
21400 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21401 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21402 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21403 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21404
21405 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21406 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21407 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21408 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21409 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21410 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21411 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21412 infinity.
21413
21414 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21415 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21416 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21417 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21418 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21419
21420 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21421 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21422 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21423 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21424 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21425 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21426
21427
21428 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21429 See &%once%& above.
21430
21431
21432 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21433 See &%once%& above.
21434 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21435
21436
21437 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21438 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21439 specified by the transport.
21440
21441
21442 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21443 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21444 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21445 configuration option.
21446
21447
21448 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21449 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21450 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21451 automatic responses. For example:
21452 .code
21453 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21454 .endd
21455 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21456 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21457 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21458 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21459 small.
21460
21461
21462
21463 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21464 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21465 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21466 the text comes first.
21467
21468
21469 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21470 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21471 when the message is specified by the transport.
21472 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21473 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21474
21475
21476
21477
21478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21480
21481 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21482 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21483 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21484 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21485 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21486 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21487 specified command
21488 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21489 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21490 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21491 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21492 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21493 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21494 .code
21495 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21496 .endd
21497 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21498 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21499 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21500 as follows:
21501
21502 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21503 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21504
21505
21506 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21507 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21508 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21509 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21510 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21511
21512
21513 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21514 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21515 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21516 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21517 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21518 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21519 LMTP protocol.
21520
21521 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21522 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21523 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21524 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21525 in its response to the LHLO command.
21526
21527 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21528 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21529 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21530 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21531
21532
21533 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21534 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21535 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21536 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21537 LMTP transport:
21538 .code
21539 lmtp:
21540 driver = lmtp
21541 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21542 batch_max = 20
21543 user = exim
21544 .endd
21545 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21546 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21547
21548
21549
21550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21552
21553 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21554 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21555 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21556 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21557 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21558 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21559 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21560 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21561 following ways:
21562
21563 .ilist
21564 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21565 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21566 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21567 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21568 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21569 .next
21570 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21571 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21572 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21573 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21574 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21575 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21576 that are routed to the transport.
21577 .next
21578 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21579 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21580 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21581 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21582 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21583 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21584 the local part that was redirected.
21585 .endlist
21586
21587
21588 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21589 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21590 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21591
21592 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21593 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21594 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21595 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21596 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21597 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21598 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21599
21600
21601 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21602 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21603 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21604 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21605 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21606
21607
21608
21609
21610 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21611 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21612 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21613 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21614 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21615 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21616 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21617 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21618 &"local delivery failed"&.
21619
21620 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21621 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21622 will be sent as normal.
21623
21624 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21625 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21626 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21627 apply in this case.
21628
21629 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21630 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21631 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21632 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21633
21634 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21635 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21636 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21637 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21638 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21639 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21640 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21641 &%temp_errors%&.
21642
21643
21644
21645 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21646 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21647 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21648 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21649 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21650 run.
21651
21652 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21653 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21654 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21655 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21656
21657 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21658 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21659 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21660 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21661 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21662 .code
21663 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21664 .endd
21665 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21666 arguments. You have to write
21667 .code
21668 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21669 .endd
21670 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21671 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21672 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21673 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21674 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21675 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21676 example:
21677 .code
21678 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21679 .endd
21680
21681 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21682 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21683 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21684 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21685 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21686 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21687 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21688 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21689 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21690 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21691
21692 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21693 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21694 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21695 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21696 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21697 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21698 control what is done with it.
21699
21700 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21701 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21702 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21703 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21704 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21705 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21706 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21707 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21708 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21709 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21710 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21711
21712
21713
21714 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21715 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21716 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21717 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21718 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21719 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21720 environment.
21721 .display
21722 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21723 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21724 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21725 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21726 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21727 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21728 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21729 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21730 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21731 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21732 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21733 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21734 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21735 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21736 &`USER `& see below
21737 .endd
21738 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21739 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21740 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21741 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21742 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21743 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21744 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21745
21746 .cindex "HOST"
21747 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21748 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21749 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21750 the router.
21751
21752 .cindex "HOME"
21753 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21754 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21755 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21756 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21757
21758
21759 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21760 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21761
21762
21763
21764 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21765 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21766 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21767 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21768 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21769 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21770 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21771 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21772 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21773 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21774 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21775 example, if
21776 .code
21777 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21778 .endd
21779 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21780 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21781 &%use_shell%& is set.
21782
21783
21784 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21785 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21786
21787
21788 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21789 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21790 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21791
21792
21793 .option check_string pipe string unset
21794 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21795 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21796 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21797 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21798 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21799 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21800 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21801 ignored.
21802
21803
21804 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21805 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21806 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21807 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21808 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21809 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21810 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21811
21812
21813 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21814 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21815 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21816 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21817 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21818 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21819 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21820
21821
21822 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21823 See &%check_string%& above.
21824
21825
21826 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21827 .cindex "exec failure"
21828 .cindex "failure of exec"
21829 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21830 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21831 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21832 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21833 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21834
21835
21836 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21837 .cindex "signal exit"
21838 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21839 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21840 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21841 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21842
21843
21844 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21845 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21846 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21847 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21848 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21849 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21850
21851 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21852 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21853
21854 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21855 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21856 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21857 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21858 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21859
21860
21861 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21862 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21863 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21864 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21865 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21866 Only one of them may be set.
21867
21868
21869
21870 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21871 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21872 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21873 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21874
21875
21876
21877 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21878 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21879 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21880 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21881 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21882 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21883 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21884 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21885
21886
21887 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21888 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21889 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21890 .code
21891 message_prefix = \
21892 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21893 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21894 .endd
21895 .cindex "Cyrus"
21896 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21897 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21898 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21899 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21900 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21901 setting
21902 .code
21903 message_prefix =
21904 .endd
21905 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21906 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21907
21908
21909 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21910 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21911 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21912 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21913 .code
21914 message_suffix =
21915 .endd
21916 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21917 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21918
21919
21920 .option path pipe string "see below"
21921 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21922 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21923 .code
21924 /bin:/usr/bin
21925 .endd
21926 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21927 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21928 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21929
21930
21931 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21932 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21933 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21934 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21935 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21936 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21937 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21938 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21939 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21940
21941
21942 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21943 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21944 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21945 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21946 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21947 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21948 accept the message is used.
21949
21950
21951 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21952 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21953 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21954 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21955 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21956 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21957
21958
21959 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21960 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21961 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21962 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21963 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21964 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21965 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21966
21967
21968
21969 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21970 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21971 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21972 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21973 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21974 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21975 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21976 of them may be set.
21977
21978
21979
21980 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21981 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21982 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21983 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21984 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21985 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21986 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21987 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21988 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21989 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21990 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21991 and 73, respectively.
21992
21993
21994 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21995 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21996 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21997 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21998 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21999 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22000 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22001
22002 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22003 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22004 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22005 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22006 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22007 delivery to be deferred.
22008
22009 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22010 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22011
22012
22013 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22014 .cindex "envelope sender"
22015 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22016 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22017 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22018 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22019 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22020
22021 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22022 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22023 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22024 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22025 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22026 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22027 class database.
22028
22029
22030 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22031 .cindex "carriage return"
22032 .cindex "linefeed"
22033 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22034 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22035 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22036 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22037
22038 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22039 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22040 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22041 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22042 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22043
22044
22045 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22046 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22047 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22048 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22049 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22050 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22051 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22052 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22053 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22054 its &%-c%& option.
22055
22056
22057
22058 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22059 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22060 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22061 .cindex "external local delivery"
22062 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22063 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22064 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22065 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22066 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22067 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22068 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22069 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22070 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22071 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22072 .code
22073 # transport
22074 procmail_pipe:
22075 driver = pipe
22076 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22077 return_path_add
22078 delivery_date_add
22079 envelope_to_add
22080 check_string = "From "
22081 escape_string = ">From "
22082 umask = 077
22083 user = $local_part
22084 group = mail
22085
22086 # router
22087 procmail:
22088 driver = accept
22089 check_local_user
22090 transport = procmail_pipe
22091 .endd
22092 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22093 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22094 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22095 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22096 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22097 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22098
22099 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22100 .code
22101 IFS=" "
22102 .endd
22103 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22104 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22105
22106 .cindex "Cyrus"
22107 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22108 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22109 .code
22110 # transport
22111 local_delivery_cyrus:
22112 driver = pipe
22113 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22114 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22115 user = cyrus
22116 group = mail
22117 return_output
22118 log_output
22119 message_prefix =
22120 message_suffix =
22121
22122 # router
22123 local_user_cyrus:
22124 driver = accept
22125 check_local_user
22126 local_part_suffix = .*
22127 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22128 .endd
22129 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22130 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22131 sender.
22132 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22133 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22134
22135
22136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22138
22139 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22140 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22141 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22142 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22143 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22144 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22145 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22146 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22147
22148
22149 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22150 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22151 two ways:
22152
22153 .ilist
22154 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22155 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22156 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22157 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22158 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22159 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22160 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22161 .next
22162 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22163 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22164 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22165 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22166 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22167 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22168 process.
22169 .endlist
22170
22171
22172 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22173 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22174 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22175
22176
22177
22178 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22179 .vindex "&$host$&"
22180 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22181 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22182 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22183 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22184 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22185 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22186 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22187 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22188
22189
22190 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22191 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22192 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22193 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22194 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22195 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22196 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22197 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22198 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22199 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22200 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22201 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22202 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22203 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22204
22205 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22206 and will be removed in a future release.
22207
22208
22209 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22210 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22211 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22212
22213
22214 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22215 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22216 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22217 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22218 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22219 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22220 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22221 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22222
22223 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22224 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22225 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22226 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22227 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22228 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22229 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22230 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22231 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22232
22233
22234 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22235 .cindex "Cyrus"
22236 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22237 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22238 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22239 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22240 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22241 ignored.
22242
22243 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22244 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22245 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22246 particular connection.
22247
22248 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22249 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22250 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22251 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22252
22253 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22254 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22255 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22256 .code
22257 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22258 .endd
22259 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22260 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22261
22262 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22263 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22264 value.
22265
22266
22267 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22268 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22269 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22270 authenticated as a client.
22271
22272
22273 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22274 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22275 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22276 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22277
22278
22279 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22280 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22281 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22282 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22283 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22284 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22285 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22286
22287
22288 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22289 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22290 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22291 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22292 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22293 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22294 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22295 option.
22296
22297
22298 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22299 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22300 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22301 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22302
22303
22304 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22305 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22306 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22307 cutoff times.
22308
22309 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22310 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22311 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22312 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22313 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22314 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22315
22316 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22317 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22318 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22319 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22320 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22321 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22322 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22323 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22324 to them.
22325
22326
22327 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22328 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22329 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22330 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22331 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22332
22333
22334 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22335 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22336 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22337 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22338 details.
22339
22340
22341 .new
22342 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22343 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22344 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22345 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22346 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22347 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22348 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22349
22350 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22351 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22352 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22353 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22354 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22355 .wen
22356
22357
22358 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22359 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22360 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22361 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22362 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22363 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22364 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22365 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22366
22367 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22368 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22369 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22370 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22371 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22372 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22373
22374 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22375 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22376 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22377 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22378 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22379
22380 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22381 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22382 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22383 copy of the message is sent.
22384
22385 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22386 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22387 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22388 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22389 fails"& facility.
22390
22391
22392 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22393 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22394 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22395 zero.
22396
22397 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22398 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22399 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22400 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22401 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22402 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22403
22404 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22405 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22406 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22407 implementations of TLS.
22408
22409 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22410 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22411 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22412 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22413 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22414 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22415 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22416 option is:
22417 .code
22418 $primary_hostname
22419 .endd
22420 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22421 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22422 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22423 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22424 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22425 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22426 interface address, you could use this:
22427 .code
22428 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22429 {$primary_hostname}}
22430 .endd
22431 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22432 callouts.
22433
22434 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22435 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22436 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22437 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22438 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22439 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22440
22441 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22442 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22443 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22444 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22445
22446 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22447 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22448 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22449 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22450 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22451 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22452 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22453
22454 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22455 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22456 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22457 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22458 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22459 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22460 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22461 address are used.
22462
22463 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22464 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22465
22466
22467 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22468 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22469 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22470 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22471 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22472 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22473 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22474 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22475 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22476 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22477
22478
22479 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22480 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22481 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22482 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22483
22484
22485 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22486 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22487 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22488 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22489
22490 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22491 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22492 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22493 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22494 to any host that matches this list.
22495 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22496
22497
22498 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22499 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22500 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22501 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22502 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22503 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22504 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22505 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22506
22507
22508 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22509 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22510 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22511 why it exists.
22512
22513
22514
22515 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22516 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22517 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22518 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22519 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22520 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22521 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22522 explanation of when this might be needed.
22523
22524
22525 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22526 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22527 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22528 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22529 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22530
22531
22532 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22533 .cindex "randomized host list"
22534 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22535 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22536 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22537 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22538 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22539 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22540 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22541 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22542
22543 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22544 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22545 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22546 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22547 .code
22548 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22549 .endd
22550 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22551 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22552 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22553
22554 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22555 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22556 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22557 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22558 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22559 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22560 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22561 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22562 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22563
22564
22565 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22566 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22567 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22568 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22569 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22570 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22571
22572 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22573 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22574 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22575 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22576 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22577 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22578 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22579
22580 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22581 .cindex "bind IP address"
22582 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22583 .vindex "&$host$&"
22584 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22585 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22586 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22587 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22588 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22589 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22590 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22591 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22592 unknown.
22593
22594 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22595 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22596 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22597 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22598 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22599 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22600 .code
22601 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22602 .endd
22603 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22604 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22605 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22606 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22607
22608
22609 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22610 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22611 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22612 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22613 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22614 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22615 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22616 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22617 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22618 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22619 unreachable hosts.
22620
22621
22622 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22623 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22624 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22625 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22626 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22627
22628 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22629 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22630 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22631 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22632 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22633 permits this.
22634
22635
22636 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22637 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22638 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22639 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22640 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22641 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22642 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22643 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22644
22645
22646 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22647 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22648 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22649 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22650 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22651 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22652 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22653 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22654
22655 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22656 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22657 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22658 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22659 is deferred.
22660
22661
22662
22663 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22664 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22665 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22666 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22667 .vindex "&$port$&"
22668 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22669 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22670 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22671 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22672 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22673
22674 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22675 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22676 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22677 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22678
22679
22680 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22681 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22682 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22683 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22684 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22685 addresses is not affected.
22686
22687 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22688 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22689 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22690 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22691 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22692 hosts.
22693
22694
22695 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22696 .cindex "serializing connections"
22697 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22698 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22699 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22700 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22701 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22702 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22703 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22704
22705 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22706 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22707 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22708 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22709 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22710 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22711
22712 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22713 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22714 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22715 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22716 are used for ETRN serialization.
22717
22718
22719 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22720 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22721 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22722 .cindex "size" "of message"
22723 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22724 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22725 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22726 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22727 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22728 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22729 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22730 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22731
22732 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22733 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22734
22735
22736 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22737 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22738 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22739 .vindex "&$host$&"
22740 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22741 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22742 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22743 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22744 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22745 details of TLS.
22746
22747 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22748 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22749 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22750 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22751 client.
22752
22753
22754 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22755 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22756 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22757 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22758 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22759
22760
22761 .new
22762 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22763 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22764 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22765 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22766 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22767 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22768 will fail.
22769
22770 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22771 .wen
22772
22773
22774 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22775 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22776 .vindex "&$host$&"
22777 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22778 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22779 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22780 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22781 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22782 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22783 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22784 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22785
22786
22787 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22788 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22789 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22790 .vindex "&$host$&"
22791 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22792 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22793 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22794 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22795 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22796 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22797 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22798 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22799 ciphers is a preference order.
22800
22801
22802
22803 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22804 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22805 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22806 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
22807 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22808 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22809 certificate and private key for the session.
22810
22811 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22812
22813 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
22814 TLS extensions.
22815
22816
22817
22818
22819 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22820 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22821 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22822 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22823 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22824 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22825 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22826 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22827 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22828 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22829 in clear.
22830
22831
22832 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22833 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22834 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22835 .vindex "&$host$&"
22836 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22837 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22838 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22839 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22840 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22841 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22842 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22843 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22844 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22845
22846
22847
22848
22849 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22850 "SECTvalhosmax"
22851 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22852 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22853 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22854 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22855 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22856
22857
22858 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22859 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22860 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22861 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22862 retrying.
22863
22864 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22865 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22866 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22867
22868 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22869 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22870 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22871 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22872 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22873
22874 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22875 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22876 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22877 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22878 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22879 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22880 see below for an exception).
22881
22882 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22883 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22884 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22885 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22886 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22887
22888 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22889 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22890 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22891 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22892 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22893 reached their retry times.
22894
22895 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22896 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22897 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22898 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22899 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22900 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22901 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22902 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22903 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22904 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22905 reached.
22906
22907 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22908 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22909 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22910 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22911 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22912 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22913
22914 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22915 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22916 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22917 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22918 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22919 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22920
22921
22922
22923
22924
22925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22927
22928 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22929 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22930 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22931 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22932 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22933 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22934
22935 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22936 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22937 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22938 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22939 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22940 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22941 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22942
22943 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22944 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22945 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22946 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22947
22948
22949 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22950 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22951 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22952 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22953
22954 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22955 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22956 facility; you do not have to use it.
22957
22958 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22959 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22960 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22961 address to which it applies.
22962
22963 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22964 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22965 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22966 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22967 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22968 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22969 rules.
22970
22971 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22972 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22973 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22974 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22975
22976
22977 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22978 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22979 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22980 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22981 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22982 discouraged.
22983
22984 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22985 illustrated by these examples:
22986
22987 .ilist
22988 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22989 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22990 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22991 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22992 .next
22993 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22994 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22995 .endlist
22996
22997
22998
22999 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23000 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23001 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23002 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23003 message's processing.
23004
23005 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23006 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23007 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23008 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23009 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23010 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23011 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23012 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23013 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23014
23015 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23016 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23017 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23018 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23019 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23020 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23021 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23022 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23023 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23024 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23025
23026 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23027 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23028 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23029 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23030 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23031 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23032
23033 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23034 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23035 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23036
23037 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23038 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23039 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23040 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23041 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23042 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23043 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23044 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23045 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23046
23047 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23048 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23049 transport time.
23050
23051
23052
23053
23054 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23055 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23056 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23057 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23058 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23059 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23060 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23061 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23062 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23063 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23064 .code
23065 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23066 .endd
23067 might produce the output
23068 .code
23069 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23070 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23071 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23072 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23073 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23074 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23075 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23076 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23077 .endd
23078 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23079 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23080 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23081 set for a particular transport.
23082
23083
23084 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23085 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23086 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23087 rules in the form
23088 .display
23089 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23090 .endd
23091 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23092 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23093 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23094 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23095
23096 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23097 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23098 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23099 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23100 ignored.
23101
23102 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23103 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23104 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23105
23106 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23107 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23108 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23109 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23110 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23111 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23112 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23113
23114 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23115 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23116 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23117 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23118 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23119 .code
23120 *@* ${lookup ...
23121 .endd
23122 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23123 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23124
23125
23126 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23127 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23128 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23129 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23130 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23131 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23132 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23133 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23134 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23135
23136 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23137 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23138 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23139
23140 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23141 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23142 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23143 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23144 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23145 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23146 of pattern they are set as follows:
23147
23148 .ilist
23149 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23150 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23151 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23152 pattern
23153 .code
23154 *queen@*.fict.example
23155 .endd
23156 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23157 .code
23158 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23159 $1 = hearts-
23160 $2 = wonderland
23161 .endd
23162 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23163 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23164
23165 .next
23166 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23167 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23168 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23169 rewriting rule of the form
23170 .display
23171 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23172 .endd
23173 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23174 .code
23175 $1 = foo
23176 $2 = bar
23177 $3 = baz.example
23178 .endd
23179 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23180 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23181 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23182 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23183 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23184 .endlist
23185
23186
23187 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23188 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23189 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23190 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23191 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23192 .code
23193 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23194 .endd
23195 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23196 &'From:'& headers.
23197
23198 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23199 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23200 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23201 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23202 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23203 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23204 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23205 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23206 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23207 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23208 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23209 entry written to the panic log.
23210
23211
23212
23213 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23214 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23215
23216 .ilist
23217 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23218 c, f, h, r, s, t.
23219 .next
23220 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23221 .next
23222 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23223 .endlist
23224
23225 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23226 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23227
23228
23229
23230 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23231 "SECID154"
23232 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23233 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23234 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23235 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23236 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23237 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23238 .display
23239 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23240 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23241 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23242 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23243 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23244 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23245 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23246 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23247 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23248 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23249 .endd
23250 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23251 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23252 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23253
23254 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23255 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23256
23257
23258 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23259 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23260 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23261 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23262 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23263 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23264 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23265 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23266 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23267
23268 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23269 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23270 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23271 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23272 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23273 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23274 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23275 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23276
23277
23278 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23279 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23280 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23281 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23282
23283 .ilist
23284 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23285 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23286 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23287 .next
23288 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23289 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23290 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23291 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23292 .next
23293 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23294 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23295 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23296 .next
23297 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23298 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23299 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23300 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23301 .code
23302 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23303 .endd
23304 into
23305 .code
23306 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23307 .endd
23308 .cindex "RFC 2047"
23309 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23310 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23311 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23312 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23313 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23314 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23315 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23316 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23317
23318 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23319 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23320 .endlist
23321
23322
23323 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23324 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23325 .code
23326 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23327 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23328 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23329 .endd
23330 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23331 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23332 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23333 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23334 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23335 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23336 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23337 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23338
23339 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23340 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23341 .code
23342 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23343 .endd
23344 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23345 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23346
23347 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23348 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23349 messages that originate outside the local host:
23350 .code
23351 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23352 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23353 .endd
23354 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23355 space.
23356
23357 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23358 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23359 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23360 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23361 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23362 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23363 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23364 components. For example, the rule
23365 .code
23366 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23367 .endd
23368 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23369 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23370 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23371 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23372 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23373 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23374 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23375 .ecindex IIDaddrew
23376
23377
23378
23379
23380
23381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23382 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23383
23384 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23385 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23386 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23387 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23388 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23389 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23390 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23391 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23392 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23393 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23394 address, domain and error.
23395
23396 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23397 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23398 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23399 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23400 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23401 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23402 log selector is set, the message
23403 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23404 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23405 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23406 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23407
23408 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23409 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23410 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23411 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23412 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23413 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23414 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23415 domain are maintained independently.
23416
23417 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23418 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23419 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23420 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23421 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23422 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23423 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23424 the local address is reached.
23425
23426 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23427 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23428 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23429 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23430 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23431
23432 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23433 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23434 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23435 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23436 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23437 messages that it should now be retaining.
23438
23439
23440
23441 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23442 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23443 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23444 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23445 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23446 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23447 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23448 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23449 message's sender, respectively.
23450
23451
23452 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23453 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23454 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23455 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23456 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23457 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23458 example,
23459 .code
23460 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23461 .endd
23462 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23463 whereas
23464 .code
23465 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23466 .endd
23467 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23468 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23469 part.
23470
23471 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23472 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23473 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23474 expressions work in address lists.
23475 .display
23476 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23477 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23478 .endd
23479
23480
23481 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23482 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23483 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23484 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23485 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23486 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23487 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23488 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23489 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23490
23491 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23492 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23493 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23494 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23495 local transports).
23496
23497 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23498 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23499 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23500 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23501 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23502 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23503 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23504 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23505 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23506 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23507 commands.
23508
23509
23510
23511 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23512 "SECID160"
23513 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23514 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23515 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23516 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23517 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23518 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23519 .code
23520 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23521 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23522 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23523 .endd
23524 and the retry rules are
23525 .code
23526 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23527 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23528 .endd
23529 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23530 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23531 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23532 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23533 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23534 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23535
23536 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23537 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23538 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23539 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23540
23541 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23542 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23543 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23544 .code
23545 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23546 .endd
23547 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23548 textual form of the IP address.
23549
23550 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23551 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23552 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23553 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23554
23555 .vlist
23556 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23557 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23558 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23559
23560 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23561 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23562 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23563
23564 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23565 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23566
23567 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23568 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23569 .endlist
23570
23571 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23572 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23573 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23574 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23575 retry rule of this form:
23576 .code
23577 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23578 .endd
23579 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23580 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23581
23582 .vlist
23583 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23584 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23585 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23586 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23587
23588 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23589 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23590
23591 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23592 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23593
23594 .vitem &%refused%&
23595 A connection was refused.
23596
23597 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23598 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23599
23600 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23601 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23602
23603 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23604 A connection attempt timed out.
23605
23606 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23607 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23608 obtained from an MX record.
23609
23610 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23611 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23612 obtained from an MX record.
23613
23614 .vitem &%timeout%&
23615 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23616
23617 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23618 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23619 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23620 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23621
23622 .vitem &%quota%&
23623 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23624 transport.
23625
23626 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23627 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23628 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23629 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23630 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23631 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23632 for four days.
23633 .endlist
23634
23635 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23636 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23637 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23638 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23639 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23640 heuristic rules:
23641
23642 .ilist
23643 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23644 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23645 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23646 .next
23647 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23648 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23649 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23650 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23651 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23652 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23653 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23654 .next
23655 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23656 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23657 .endlist
23658
23659 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23660 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23661 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23662 error).
23663
23664
23665
23666 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23667 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23668 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23669 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23670 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23671 form:
23672 .display
23673 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23674 .endd
23675 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23676 .code
23677 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23678 .endd
23679 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23680 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23681 For example:
23682 .code
23683 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23684 .endd
23685 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23686 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23687 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23688 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23689 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23690
23691 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23692 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23693 .code
23694 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23695 .endd
23696 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23697 list is never matched.
23698
23699
23700
23701
23702
23703 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23704 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23705 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23706 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23707 .display
23708 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23709 .endd
23710 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23711 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23712 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23713 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23714 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23715
23716 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23717 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23718 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23719 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23720 The available algorithms are:
23721
23722 .ilist
23723 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23724 the interval.
23725 .next
23726 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23727 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23728 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23729 .next
23730 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23731 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23732 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23733 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23734 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23735 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23736 queue processing times.
23737 .endlist
23738
23739 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23740 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23741 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23742 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23743 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23744 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23745 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23746 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23747 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23748 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23749 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23750 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23751
23752 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23753 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23754 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23755 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23756 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23757 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23758 time.
23759
23760 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23761 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23762 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23763 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23764 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23765 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23766 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23767 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23768 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23769 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23770 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23771 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23772
23773 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23774 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23775 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23776 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23777 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23778 deliveries that have been deferred.
23779
23780
23781 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23782 Here are some example retry rules:
23783 .code
23784 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23785 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23786 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23787 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23788 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23789 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23790 .endd
23791 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23792 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23793 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23794 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23795 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23796 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23797 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23798 days.
23799
23800 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23801 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23802 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23803 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23804 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23805
23806 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23807 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23808 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23809 were not obtained from an MX record.
23810
23811 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23812 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23813 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23814 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23815 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23816
23817
23818
23819 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23820 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23821 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23822 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23823 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23824 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23825 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23826 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23827 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23828 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23829 failing for the first time.
23830
23831 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23832 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23833 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23834 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23835
23836 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23837 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23838 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23839
23840
23841
23842
23843 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23844 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23845 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23846 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23847 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23848 default retry rule:
23849 .code
23850 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23851 .endd
23852 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23853 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23854 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23855
23856 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23857 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23858 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23859 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23860 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23861
23862 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23863 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23864 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23865
23866 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23867 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23868 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23869 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23870 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23871 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23872 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23873 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23874
23875 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23876 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23877 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23878 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23879 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23880 notice.
23881
23882 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23883 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23884 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23885 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23886 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23887 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23888 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23889 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23890 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23891 true.
23892
23893 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23894 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23895 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23896 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23897 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23898 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23899 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23900 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23901 reached.
23902
23903 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23904 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23905 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23906 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23907 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23908 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23909 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23910 time out the address.
23911
23912 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23913 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23914 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23915 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23916 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23917 considered immediately.
23918 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23919 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23920
23921
23922
23923
23924
23925
23926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23927 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23928
23929 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23930 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23931 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23932 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23933 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23934 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23935 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23936 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23937 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23938 other.
23939
23940 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23941 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23942
23943 .ilist
23944 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23945 the client's EHLO command.
23946 .next
23947 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23948 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23949 .next
23950 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23951 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23952 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23953 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23954 with the AUTH command.
23955 .next
23956 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23957 .next
23958 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23959 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23960 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23961 connection.
23962 .next
23963 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23964 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23965 unauthenticated connection.
23966 .endlist
23967
23968 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23969 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23970 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23971 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23972 .display
23973 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23974 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23975 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23976 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23977 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23978 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23979 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23980 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23981 &`250-PIPELINING`&
23982 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23983 &`250 HELP`&
23984 .endd
23985 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23986 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23987 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23988 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23989 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23990 included by setting
23991 .code
23992 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23993 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23994 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
23995 AUTH_GSASL=yes
23996 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23997 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23998 AUTH_SPA=yes
23999 .endd
24000 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24001 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24002 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24003 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24004 work via a socket interface.
24005 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24006 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24007 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24008 supporting setting a server keytab.
24009 The sixth can be configured to support
24010 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24011 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24012 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24013
24014 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24015 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24016 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24017 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24018 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24019 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24020 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24021
24022 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24023 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24024 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24025 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24026 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24027 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24028 .code
24029 cram:
24030 driver = cram_md5
24031 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24032 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24033 client_name = ph10
24034 client_secret = secret2
24035 .endd
24036 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24037 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24038
24039 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24040 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24041 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24042 in Exim.
24043
24044 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24045 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24046 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24047 authenticating data.
24048
24049 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24050 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24051 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24052 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24053 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24054 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24055 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24056 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24057 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24058 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24059 choose to honour.
24060
24061 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24062 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24063 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24064 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24065
24066
24067
24068 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24069 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24070 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24071
24072 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24073 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24074 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24075 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24076 encrypted by a setting such as:
24077 .code
24078 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24079 .endd
24080
24081
24082 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24083 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24084 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24085 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24086
24087
24088 .option driver authenticators string unset
24089 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24090 authenticators is to be used.
24091
24092
24093 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24094 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24095 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24096 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24097 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24098 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24099
24100
24101 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24102 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24103 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24104 mechanism is not advertised.
24105 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24106 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24107 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24108
24109
24110 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24111 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24112 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24113 for details.
24114
24115 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24116 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24117
24118 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24119 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24120 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24121 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24122 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24123 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24124 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24125 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24126 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24127 the error text.
24128
24129
24130 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24131 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24132 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24133 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24134 out the values of variables.
24135 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24136 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24137
24138
24139 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24140 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24141 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24142 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24143 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24144 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24145 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24146 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24147 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24148
24149
24150 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24151 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24152 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24153 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24154 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24155 remembered for later use.
24156 How it is used is described in the following section.
24157
24158
24159
24160
24161
24162 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24163 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24164 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24165 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24166 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24167 message:
24168
24169 .ilist
24170 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24171 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24172 .next
24173 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24174 .next
24175 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24176 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24177 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24178 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24179 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24180 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24181 given for the MAIL command.
24182 .next
24183 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24184 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24185 authenticated.
24186 .next
24187 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24188 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24189 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24190 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24191 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24192 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24193 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24194 message.
24195 .endlist
24196
24197
24198 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24199 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24200 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24201 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24202
24203 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24204 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24205 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24206 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24207 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24208 ACL is run.
24209
24210
24211
24212 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24213 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24214 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24215 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24216 conditions:
24217
24218 .ilist
24219 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24220 .next
24221 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24222 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24223 .endlist
24224
24225 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24226 the mechanisms are advertised.
24227
24228 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24229 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24230 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24231 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24232 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24233 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24234 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24235 .code
24236 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24237 .endd
24238 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24239
24240 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24241 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24242 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24243 such as:
24244 .code
24245 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24246 .endd
24247 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24248 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24249 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24250
24251 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24252 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24253 command. This is the case if
24254
24255 .ilist
24256 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24257 .next
24258 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24259 .next
24260 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24261 server authenticators.
24262 .endlist
24263
24264
24265 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24266 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24267 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24268
24269 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24270 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24271 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24272 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24273 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24274 rejected with a 504 error.
24275
24276 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24277 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24278 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24279 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24280 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24281 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24282 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24283 no successful authentication.
24284
24285
24286
24287
24288 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24289 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24290 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24291 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24292 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24293 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24294 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24295 script:
24296 .code
24297 use MIME::Base64;
24298 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24299 .endd
24300 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24301 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24302 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24303 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24304 command line to run this script on such data might be
24305 .code
24306 encode '\0user\0password'
24307 .endd
24308 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24309 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24310 whose code value is zero.
24311
24312 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24313 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24314 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24315 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24316
24317 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24318 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24319 example, a command such as
24320 .code
24321 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24322 .endd
24323 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24324
24325 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24326 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24327 .code
24328 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24329 .endd
24330 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24331 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24332 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24333 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24334
24335
24336
24337 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24338 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24339 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24340 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24341 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24342 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24343
24344 .ilist
24345 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24346 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24347 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24348 of the authenticator.
24349 .next
24350 .vindex "&$host$&"
24351 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24352 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24353 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24354 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24355 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24356 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24357 delivery to be deferred.
24358 .next
24359 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24360 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24361 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24362 usual way.
24363 .next
24364 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24365 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24366 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24367 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24368 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24369 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24370 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24371 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24372 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24373 .endlist
24374
24375 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24376 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24377 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24378 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24379 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24380 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24381 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24382 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24383 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24384 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24385 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24386 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24387 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24388
24389
24390
24391
24392
24393
24394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24396
24397 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24398 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24399 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24400 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24401 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24402 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24403 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24404 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24405 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24406 connections as you do for login accounts.
24407
24408 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24409 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24410 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24411
24412 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24413 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24414 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24415
24416 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24417 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24418 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24419 given.
24420
24421 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24422 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24423 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24424 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24425 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24426 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24427 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24428
24429 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24430 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24431 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24432 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24433 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24434 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24435 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24436
24437 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24438 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24439 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24440 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24441
24442 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24443 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24444 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24445
24446 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24447 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24448 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24449 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24450 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24451 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24452 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24453 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24454 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24455 string as the error text.
24456
24457 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24458 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24459 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24460
24461
24462
24463 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24464 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24465 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24466 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24467 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24468 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24469 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24470 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24471
24472 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24473 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24474 configured as follows:
24475 .code
24476 fixed_plain:
24477 driver = plaintext
24478 public_name = PLAIN
24479 server_prompts = :
24480 server_condition = \
24481 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24482 server_set_id = $auth2
24483 .endd
24484 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24485 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24486 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24487 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24488
24489 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24490 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24491 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24492 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24493 .code
24494 250-AUTH PLAIN
24495 .endd
24496 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24497 .code
24498 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24499 .endd
24500 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24501 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24502 .code
24503 AUTH PLAIN
24504 .endd
24505 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24506 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24507
24508 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24509 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24510 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24511 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24512 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24513
24514 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24515 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24516 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24517
24518 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24519 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24520 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24521 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24522 This is an incorrect example:
24523 .code
24524 server_condition = \
24525 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24526 .endd
24527 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24528 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24529 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24530 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24531 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24532 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24533 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24534 .code
24535 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24536 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24537 .endd
24538 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24539 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24540 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24541 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24542 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24543
24544
24545 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24546 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24547 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24548 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24549 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24550 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24551 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24552 .code
24553 fixed_login:
24554 driver = plaintext
24555 public_name = LOGIN
24556 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24557 server_condition = \
24558 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24559 server_set_id = $auth1
24560 .endd
24561 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24562 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24563 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24564 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24565
24566 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24567 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24568 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24569 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24570 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24571 .code
24572 login:
24573 driver = plaintext
24574 public_name = LOGIN
24575 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24576 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24577 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24578 ldapauth{\
24579 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24580 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24581 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24582 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24583 .endd
24584 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24585 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24586 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24587 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24588 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24589 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24590 uninterpreted string.
24591
24592
24593 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24594 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24595 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24596 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24597 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24598 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24599
24600
24601
24602
24603 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24604 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24605 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24606
24607 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24608 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24609 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24610 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24611 usual.
24612
24613 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24614 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24615 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24616 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24617 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24618 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24619 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24620 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24621 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24622 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24623 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24624 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24625
24626 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24627 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24628
24629 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24630 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24631 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24632 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24633 the string.
24634
24635 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24636 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24637 .code
24638 fixed_plain:
24639 driver = plaintext
24640 public_name = PLAIN
24641 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24642 .endd
24643 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24644 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24645 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24646 .code
24647 fixed_login:
24648 driver = plaintext
24649 public_name = LOGIN
24650 client_send = : username : mysecret
24651 .endd
24652 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24653 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24654 prompts.
24655 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24656 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24657
24658
24659
24660
24661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24663
24664 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24665 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24666 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24667 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24668 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24669 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24670 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24671 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24672 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24673 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24674 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24675 available in plain text at either end.
24676
24677
24678 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24679 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24680 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24681 authenticator as a server:
24682
24683 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24684 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24685 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24686 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24687 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24688 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24689 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24690 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24691 returned to the client.
24692
24693 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24694 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24695 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24696 numeric variables for other things.
24697
24698 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24699 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24700 user name, authentication fails.
24701 .code
24702 fixed_cram:
24703 driver = cram_md5
24704 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24705 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24706 server_set_id = $auth1
24707 .endd
24708 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24709 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24710 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24711 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24712 .code
24713 lookup_cram:
24714 driver = cram_md5
24715 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24716 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24717 {$value}fail}
24718 server_set_id = $auth1
24719 .endd
24720 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24721 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24722
24723 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24724 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24725 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24726 realm, with:
24727 .code
24728 cyrusless_crammd5:
24729 driver = cram_md5
24730 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24731 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24732 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24733 server_set_id = $auth1
24734 .endd
24735
24736 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24737 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24738 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24739
24740
24741
24742 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24743 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24744 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24745
24746
24747 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24748 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24749 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24750
24751
24752 .vindex "&$host$&"
24753 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24754 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24755 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24756 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24757 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24758 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24759 send the message to the current server.
24760
24761 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24762 strings, is:
24763 .code
24764 fixed_cram:
24765 driver = cram_md5
24766 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24767 client_name = ph10
24768 client_secret = secret
24769 .endd
24770 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24771 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24772
24773
24774
24775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24777
24778 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24779 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24780 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24781 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24782 .cindex "Kerberos"
24783 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24784 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24785
24786 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24787 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24788 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24789 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24790 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24791
24792 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24793 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24794 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24795 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24796
24797 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24798 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24799 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24800 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24801 depending on the driver you are using.
24802
24803 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24804 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24805 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24806 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24807 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24808 implementation.
24809
24810 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24811 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24812 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24813 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24814 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24815 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24816 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24817 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24818
24819
24820 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24821 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24822 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24823 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24824 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24825 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24826 things.
24827
24828
24829 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24830 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24831 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24832 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24833
24834
24835 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24836 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24837 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24838 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24839 example:
24840 .code
24841 sasl:
24842 driver = cyrus_sasl
24843 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24844 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24845 server_set_id = $auth1
24846 .endd
24847
24848 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24849 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24850
24851
24852 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24853 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24854
24855
24856 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24857 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24858 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24859 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24860 .code
24861 sasl_cram_md5:
24862 driver = cyrus_sasl
24863 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24864 server_set_id = $auth1
24865
24866 sasl_plain:
24867 driver = cyrus_sasl
24868 public_name = PLAIN
24869 server_set_id = $auth2
24870 .endd
24871 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24872 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24873 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24874 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24875 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24876
24877
24878
24879
24880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24882 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24883 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24884 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24885 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24886 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24887 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24888 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24889 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24890
24891 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24892
24893 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24894 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24895 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24896 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24897 .code
24898 dovecot_plain:
24899 driver = dovecot
24900 public_name = PLAIN
24901 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24902 server_set_id = $auth2
24903
24904 dovecot_ntlm:
24905 driver = dovecot
24906 public_name = NTLM
24907 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24908 server_set_id = $auth1
24909 .endd
24910 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24911 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24912 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24913 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24914 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24915 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24916 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24917 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24918
24919
24920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24922 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24923 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24924 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24925 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24926 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24927 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24928 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24929 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24930 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24931 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24932 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24933 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24934 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24935 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
24936 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24937 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24938 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24939 without code changes in Exim.
24940
24941
24942 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
24943 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24944 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24945 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24946 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24947 context.
24948
24949 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24950 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24951 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24952
24953 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24954 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24955 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24956
24957 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24958 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24959 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24960
24961
24962 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24963 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24964 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24965 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24966
24967
24968 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24969 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24970 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24971 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24972 example:
24973 .code
24974 sasl:
24975 driver = gsasl
24976 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24977 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24978 server_set_id = $auth1
24979 .endd
24980
24981
24982 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24983 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24984 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24985 the password itself.
24986
24987 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24988 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24989 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24990 if available, else the empty string.
24991 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24992 else the empty string.
24993
24994 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24995
24996 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24997 option to be simply "true".
24998
24999
25000 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25001 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25002 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25003
25004
25005 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25006 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25007 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25008 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25009
25010
25011 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25012 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25013 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25014 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25015
25016
25017 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25018 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25019 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25020
25021
25022 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25023 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25024 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25025 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25026
25027 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25028 meanings for these variables:
25029
25030 .ilist
25031 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25032 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25033 .next
25034 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25035 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25036 .next
25037 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25038 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25039 .endlist
25040
25041 On a per-mechanism basis:
25042
25043 .ilist
25044 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25045 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25046 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25047 .next
25048 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25049 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25050 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25051 .next
25052 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25053 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25054 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25055 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25056 .endlist
25057
25058 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25059 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25060 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25061
25062
25063 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25064 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25065 .code
25066 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25067 driver = gsasl
25068 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25069 server_realm = imap.example.org
25070 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25071 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25072 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25073 server_condition = yes
25074 .endd
25075
25076
25077 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25079
25080 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25081 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25082 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25083 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25084 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25085 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25086 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25087 reliably.
25088
25089 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25090 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25091 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25092 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25093
25094 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25095 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25096 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25097 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25098
25099 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25100 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25101 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25102 from the keytab.
25103
25104
25105 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25106 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25107 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25108 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25109
25110 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25111 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25112 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25113 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25114
25115 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25116 .ilist
25117 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25118 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25119 .next
25120 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25121 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25122 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25123 GSS Display Name.
25124 .endlist
25125
25126
25127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25128 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25129
25130 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25131 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25132 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25133 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25134 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25135 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25136 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25137 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25138 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25139 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25140 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25141 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25142 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25143 follows:
25144
25145 .ilist
25146 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25147 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25148 .next
25149 The server sends back a challenge.
25150 .next
25151 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25152 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25153 .endlist
25154
25155 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25156
25157
25158
25159 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25160 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25161 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25162
25163 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25164 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25165 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25166 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25167 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25168 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25169 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25170 for other things. For example:
25171 .code
25172 spa:
25173 driver = spa
25174 public_name = NTLM
25175 server_password = \
25176 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25177 .endd
25178 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25179 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25180
25181
25182
25183
25184
25185 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25186 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25187 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25188
25189
25190
25191 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25192 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25193
25194
25195 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25196 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25197
25198
25199 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25200 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25201 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25202 &'msn.com'&:
25203 .code
25204 msn:
25205 driver = spa
25206 public_name = MSN
25207 client_username = msn/msn_username
25208 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25209 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25210 .endd
25211 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25212 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25213
25214
25215
25216
25217
25218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25220
25221 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25222 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25223 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25224 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25225 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25226 .cindex "OpenSSL"
25227 .cindex "GnuTLS"
25228 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25229 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25230 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25231 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25232 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25233 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25234 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25235 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25236 certificates are used.
25237
25238 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25239 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25240 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25241 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25242 between them is encrypted.
25243
25244 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25245 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25246 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25247 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25248 encryption state.
25249
25250 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25251 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25252 in order to get TLS to work.
25253
25254
25255
25256 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25257 "SECID284"
25258 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25259 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25260 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25261 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25262 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25263 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25264 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25265 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25266 allocated for this purpose.
25267
25268 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25269 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25270 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25271 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25272 .code
25273 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25274 .endd
25275 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25276 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25277 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25278 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25279 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25280 defined elsewhere.
25281
25282 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25283 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25284
25285
25286
25287
25288
25289
25290 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25291 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25292 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25293 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25294 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25295 .code
25296 USE_GNUTLS=yes
25297 .endd
25298 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25299 .code
25300 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
25301 .endd
25302 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25303 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25304
25305 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25306
25307 .ilist
25308 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25309 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25310 .next
25311 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25312 .next
25313 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25314 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25315 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25316 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25317 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25318 .next
25319 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25320 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25321 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25322 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25323 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25324 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25325 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25326 option).
25327 .next
25328 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25329 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25330 .next
25331 .new
25332 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25333 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25334 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25335 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25336 .wen
25337 .next
25338 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25339 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25340 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25341 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25342 .endlist
25343
25344
25345 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25346 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25347 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25348 but not the chosen filename.
25349 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25350 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25351
25352 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25353 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25354 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25355 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25356 of bits requested.
25357 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25358 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25359 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25360 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25361 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25362 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25363 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25364
25365 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25366 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25367 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25368 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25369 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25370
25371 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25372 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25373 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25374 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25375 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25376 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25377
25378 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25379 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25380 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25381
25382 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25383 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25384 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25385 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25386 .code
25387 # ls
25388 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25389 # rm -f new-params
25390 # touch new-params
25391 # chown exim:exim new-params
25392 # chmod 0600 new-params
25393 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25394 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25395 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25396 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25397 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25398 # chmod 0400 new-params
25399 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25400 .endd
25401 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25402 stalling is removed.
25403
25404 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25405 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25406 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25407 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25408 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25409 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25410 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25411 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25412 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25413 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25414 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25415
25416 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25417 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25418 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25419 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25420
25421 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25422 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25423 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25424 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25425 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25426
25427
25428 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25429 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25430 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25431 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25432 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25433 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25434 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25435 directly to this function call.
25436 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25437 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25438 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25439 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25440
25441 .ilist
25442 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25443 .next
25444 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25445 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25446 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25447 SSL v3 algorithms.
25448 .next
25449 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25450 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25451 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25452 algorithms.
25453 .endlist
25454
25455 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25456 &`-`& or &`+`&.
25457 .ilist
25458 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25459 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25460 stated.
25461 .next
25462 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25463 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25464 .next
25465 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25466 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25467 .endlist
25468
25469 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25470 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25471 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25472 not be moved to the end of the list.
25473 .endlist
25474
25475 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25476 string:
25477 .code
25478 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25479 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25480 .endd
25481
25482 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25483 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25484 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25485 choice of clients used:
25486 .code
25487 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25488 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25489 {DEFAULT}\
25490 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
25491 .endd
25492
25493
25494
25495 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25496 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25497 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25498 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25499 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25500 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25501 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25502 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25503 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25504 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25505 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25506 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25507
25508 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25509
25510 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25511 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25512 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25513 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25514 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25515 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25516
25517 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25518 "Priority strings". This is online as
25519 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25520 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25521 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25522 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string.html, then the example code)
25523 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25524
25525 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25526 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25527 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25528
25529 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25530 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25531 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25532 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25533 used:
25534 .code
25535 # GnuTLS variant
25536 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25537 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
25538 {SECURE128}}
25539 .endd
25540
25541
25542 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25543 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25544 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25545 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25546 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25547 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25548 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25549 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25550
25551 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25552 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25553 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25554 with the error
25555 .code
25556 554 Security failure
25557 .endd
25558 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25559 rejected with a 554 error code.
25560
25561 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25562 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25563 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25564 without some further configuration at the server end.
25565
25566 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25567 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25568 .code
25569 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25570 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25571 .endd
25572 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25573 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25574 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25575 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25576 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25577 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25578 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25579 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25580 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25581 the server's certificate.
25582
25583 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25584 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25585 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25586
25587 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25588 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25589 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25590 transport.
25591
25592 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25593 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25594 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25595 .code
25596 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25597 .endd
25598 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25599 with the parameters contained in the file.
25600 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25601 available:
25602 .code
25603 tls_dhparam = none
25604 .endd
25605 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25606 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25607 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25608 documetnation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25609
25610 See the command
25611 .code
25612 openssl dhparam
25613 .endd
25614 for a way of generating file data.
25615
25616 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25617 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25618 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25619 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25620 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25621
25622 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25623 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25624 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25625 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25626 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25627 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25628 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25629 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25630 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25631
25632 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25633 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25634 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25635 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25636 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25637 documentation for more details.
25638
25639 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25640 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25641
25642
25643 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25644 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25645 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25646 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25647 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25648 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25649 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25650 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25651 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25652 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25653 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25654 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25655
25656 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25657 directory is used
25658 (OpenSSL only),
25659 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25660 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25661 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25662 .code
25663 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25664 .endd
25665 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25666
25667 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25668 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25669 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25670 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25671 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25672 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25673 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25674 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25675 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25676 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25677
25678 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25679 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25680 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25681 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25682
25683 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25684 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25685 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25686 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25687 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25688 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25689
25690
25691 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25692 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25693 .cindex "revocation list"
25694 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25695 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25696 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25697 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25698 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25699 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25700 CRL in PEM format.
25701
25702
25703 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25704 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25705 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25706 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25707 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25708 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25709 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25710 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25711 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25712
25713 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25714 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25715 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25716 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25717 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25718
25719 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25720 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25721 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25722 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25723 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25724 usual way.
25725
25726 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25727 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25728 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25729 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25730 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25731 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25732 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25733 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25734 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25735 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25736 unencrypted.
25737
25738 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25739 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25740 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25741 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25742
25743 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25744 must name a file or,
25745 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25746 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25747 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25748 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25749
25750 If
25751 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25752 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25753 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25754 alternative hosts, if any.
25755
25756 &*Note*&:
25757 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25758 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25759 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25760 client.
25761
25762 .vindex "&$host$&"
25763 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25764 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25765 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25766 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25767 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25768
25769 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25770 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
25771 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
25772 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
25773 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25774 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
25775 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25776 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25777 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25778 outgoing connection.
25779
25780
25781
25782 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25783 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25784 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
25785 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
25786 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25787 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25788 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25789 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25790 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25791 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25792 for this session.
25793
25794 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25795 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25796 address.
25797
25798 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25799 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25800 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25801 be of limited use in that environment.
25802
25803 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25804 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25805 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25806 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25807 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25808
25809 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25810 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25811 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25812 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25813 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25814
25815 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
25816 received from a client.
25817 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25818
25819 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25820 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25821 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25822
25823 .ilist
25824 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25825 &%tls_certificate%&
25826 .next
25827 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25828 &%tls_crl%&
25829 .next
25830 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25831 &%tls_privatekey%&
25832 .next
25833 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25834 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25835 .endlist
25836
25837 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25838 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25839 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25840 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25841
25842 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25843 are re-expanded.
25844
25845 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25846 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25847 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25848 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25849
25850 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25851 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25852 built, then you have SNI support).
25853
25854
25855
25856 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25857 "SECTmulmessam"
25858 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25859 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25860 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25861 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25862 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25863 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25864 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25865 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25866 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25867 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25868 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25869
25870 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25871 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25872 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25873 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25874 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25875 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25876 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25877 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25878 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25879
25880 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25881 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25882 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25883 information is recorded.
25884
25885 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25886 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25887 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25888
25889
25890
25891
25892 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25893 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25894 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25895 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25896 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25897 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25898 to Apache, currently at
25899 .display
25900 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25901 .endd
25902 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25903 links to further files.
25904 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25905 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25906 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25907 .display
25908 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25909 .endd
25910
25911
25912 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25913 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25914 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25915 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25916 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25917 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25918 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25919 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25920 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25921 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25922 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25923 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25924 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25925
25926
25927 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25928 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25929 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25930 with OpenSSL, like this:
25931 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
25932 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
25933 .code
25934 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25935 -days 9999 -nodes
25936 .endd
25937 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25938 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25939 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25940 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25941 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25942 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25943 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25944
25945 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
25946 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
25947 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
25948 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
25949 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
25950 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
25951 . ==== -pdp, 2012
25952 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
25953 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
25954 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
25955 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
25956 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
25957 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
25958 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
25959 be a sensible resolution).
25960
25961 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25962 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25963 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25964
25965 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25966 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25967 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25968 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25969 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25970 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25971
25972 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25973 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25974 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25975 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25976 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25977 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25978
25979
25980
25981 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25982 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25983
25984 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25985 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25986 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25987 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25988 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25989 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25990 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25991 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25992 one very small ACL:
25993 .code
25994 begin acl
25995 small_acl:
25996 accept hosts = one.host.only
25997 .endd
25998 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25999 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26000
26001 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26002 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26003 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26004 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26005 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26006 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26007 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26008 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26009
26010
26011 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26012 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26013 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26014 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26015 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26016
26017
26018
26019 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26020 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26021 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26022 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26023 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26024 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26025 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26026 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26027 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26028 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26029 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26030 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26031 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26032 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26033 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26034 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26035 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26036 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26037
26038 .table2 140pt
26039 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26040 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26041 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26042 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26043 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26044 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26045 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26046 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26047 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26048 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26049 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26050 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26051 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26052 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26053 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26054 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26055 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26056 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26057 .endtable
26058
26059 For example, if you set
26060 .code
26061 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26062 .endd
26063 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26064 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26065 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26066 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26067 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26068 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26069 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26070
26071
26072 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26073 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26074 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26075 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26076 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26077 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26078 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26079 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26080 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26081 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26082 in any of these ACLs.
26083
26084 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26085 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26086 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26087 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26088 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26089 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26090 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26091 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26092 .code
26093 control = suppress_local_fixups
26094 .endd
26095 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26096 run, it is too late.
26097
26098 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26099 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26100
26101 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26102 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26103 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26104
26105
26106 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26107 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26108 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26109 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26110 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26111 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26112 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26113 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26114 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26115
26116
26117 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26118 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26119 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26120 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26121 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26122 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26123 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26124 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26125 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26126
26127 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26128 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26129 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26130 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26131 an EHLO response.
26132
26133
26134 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26135 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26136 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26137 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26138 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26139 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26140 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26141 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26142 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26143 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26144
26145 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26146 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26147 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26148 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26149 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26150 associated with the DATA command.
26151
26152 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26153 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26154 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26155 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26156 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26157 your resources.
26158
26159 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after both the &%acl_smtp_dkim%& and
26160 the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26161
26162
26163 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26164 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26165 enabled (which is the default).
26166
26167 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26168 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26169 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26170
26171 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26172
26173 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26174
26175
26176 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26177 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26178 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26179
26180 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26181
26182
26183 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26184 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26185 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26186 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26187 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26188 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26189
26190 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26191 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26192 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26193 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26194
26195 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26196 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26197
26198 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26199 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26200 response to QUIT.
26201
26202 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26203 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26204 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26205 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26206 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26207
26208
26209 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26210 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26211 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26212 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26213 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26214 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26215 situation even worse.
26216
26217 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26218 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26219 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26220 and &%warn%&.
26221
26222 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26223 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26224 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26225 connection. The possible values are:
26226 .table2
26227 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26228 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26229 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26230 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26231 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26232 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26233 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26234 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26235 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26236 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26237 .endtable
26238 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26239 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26240 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26241 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26242 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26243 used.
26244
26245
26246 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26247 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26248 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26249 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26250 .code
26251 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26252 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26253 .endd
26254 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26255 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26256 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26257 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26258 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26259
26260 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26261 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26262 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26263
26264 .ilist
26265 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26266 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26267 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26268 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26269 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26270 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26271 .code
26272 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26273 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26274 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26275 .endd
26276 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26277 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26278 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26279 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26280 .next
26281 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26282 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26283 matches the string.
26284 .next
26285 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26286 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26287 want to have something like
26288 .code
26289 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26290 .endd
26291 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26292 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26293 .endlist
26294
26295
26296
26297
26298 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26299 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26300 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26301 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26302 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26303 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26304 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26305 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26306 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26307
26308 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26309 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26310 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26311
26312
26313 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26314 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26315 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26316 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26317
26318 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26319 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26320 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26321 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26322 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26323 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26324 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26325
26326
26327 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26328 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26329 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26330
26331
26332
26333 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26334 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26335 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26336 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26337 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26338 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26339
26340 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26341 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26342 used to accept or reject anything.
26343
26344 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26345 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26346 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26347 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26348
26349 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26350 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26351 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26352 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26353 configuration file.
26354
26355
26356
26357
26358 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26359 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26360 .vindex &$domain$&
26361 .vindex &$local_part$&
26362 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26363 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26364 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26365 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26366 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26367 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26368 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26369 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26370 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26371
26372 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26373 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26374 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26375 how it is used.
26376
26377 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26378 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26379 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26380 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26381 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26382 received).
26383
26384 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26385 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26386 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26387 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26388 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26389 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26390 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26391 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26392
26393
26394
26395
26396
26397 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26398 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26399 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26400 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26401 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26402 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26403 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26404 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26405 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26406 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26407 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26408 unencrypted connections.
26409 .code
26410 acl_check_auth:
26411 accept encrypted = *
26412 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26413 {CRAM-MD5}}
26414 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26415 .endd
26416 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26417 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26418 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26419 option to do this.)
26420
26421
26422
26423 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26424 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26425 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26426 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26427 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26428 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26429 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26430
26431 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26432 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26433 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26434 example:
26435 .code
26436 deny dnslists = list1.example
26437 dnslists = list2.example
26438 .endd
26439 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26440 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26441 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26442 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26443 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26444
26445
26446 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26447 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26448
26449 .ilist
26450 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26451 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26452 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26453 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26454 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26455 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26456 check a RCPT command:
26457 .code
26458 accept domains = +local_domains
26459 endpass
26460 verify = recipient
26461 .endd
26462 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26463 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26464 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26465 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26466 &%endpass%&.
26467
26468 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26469 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26470 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26471 configuration.
26472
26473 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26474 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26475 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26476 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26477 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26478 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26479 .display
26480 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26481 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26482 .endd
26483 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26484 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26485 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26486
26487 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26488 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26489 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26490 of &%endpass%&.
26491
26492
26493 .next
26494 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26495 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26496 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26497 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26498 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26499 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26500 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26501
26502
26503 .next
26504 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26505 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26506 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26507 example,
26508 .code
26509 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26510 .endd
26511 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26512
26513
26514 .next
26515 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26516 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26517 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26518 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26519 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26520 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26521 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26522 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26523 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26524
26525 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26526 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26527 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26528
26529
26530 .next
26531 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26532 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26533 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26534 .code
26535 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26536 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26537 .endd
26538 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26539 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26540
26541 .next
26542 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26543 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26544 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26545 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26546 .code
26547 require message = Sender did not verify
26548 verify = sender
26549 .endd
26550 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26551 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26552 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26553 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26554
26555 .next
26556 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26557 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26558 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26559 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26560 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26561 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26562 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26563
26564 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26565 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26566 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
26567 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26568 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26569
26570 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26571 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26572 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26573 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26574 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26575 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26576 onwards.
26577
26578
26579 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26580 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26581 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26582 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26583 .code
26584 warn !verify = sender
26585 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26586 .endd
26587 .endlist
26588
26589 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26590
26591 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26592 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26593 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26594 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26595 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26596
26597
26598
26599 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26600 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26601 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26602 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26603 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26604 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26605 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26606 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26607 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26608 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26609 .ilist
26610 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26611 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26612 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26613 on the same SMTP connection.
26614 .next
26615 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26616 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26617 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26618 .endlist
26619
26620 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26621 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26622 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26623 .code
26624 accept hosts = whatever
26625 set acl_m4 = some value
26626 accept authenticated = *
26627 set acl_c_auth = yes
26628 .endd
26629 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26630 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26631 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26632
26633 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26634 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26635 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26636 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26637 error is generated.
26638
26639 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26640 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26641
26642
26643 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26644 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26645 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26646 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26647 .code
26648 deny domains = *.dom.example
26649 !verify = recipient
26650 .endd
26651 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26652 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26653 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26654 two statements are equivalent:
26655 .code
26656 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26657 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26658 .endd
26659 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26660 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26661
26662 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26663 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26664 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26665 .code
26666 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26667 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26668 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26669 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26670 .endd
26671 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26672 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26673 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26674 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26675 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26676 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26677 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26678
26679 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26680 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26681 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26682 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26683 message is handled.
26684
26685 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
26686 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26687 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26688 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26689 .code
26690 require message = Can't verify sender
26691 verify = sender
26692 message = Can't verify recipient
26693 verify = recipient
26694 message = This message cannot be used
26695 .endd
26696 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26697 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26698 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26699 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26700 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26701 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26702
26703 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26704 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26705 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26706 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26707 .code
26708 deny hosts = ...
26709 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26710 message = Invalid sender from client host
26711 .endd
26712 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26713 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26714
26715
26716
26717 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26718 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26719 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26720
26721 .vlist
26722 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26723 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26724 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26725 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26726
26727 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26728 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26729 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26730 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26731 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26732 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26733 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26734 write rather ugly lines like this:
26735 .display
26736 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26737 .endd
26738 Instead, all you need is
26739 .display
26740 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26741 .endd
26742
26743 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26744 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26745 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26746 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26747 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26748 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26749 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26750 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26751
26752 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26753 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26754 in several different ways. For example:
26755
26756 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26757 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26758 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26759 . ==== way.
26760
26761 .ilist
26762 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26763 .code
26764 accept ...some conditions
26765 control = queue_only
26766 .endd
26767 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26768 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26769
26770 .next
26771 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26772 .code
26773 accept ...some conditions...
26774 control = queue_only
26775 ...some more conditions...
26776 .endd
26777 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26778 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26779 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26780 to be relevant.
26781
26782 .next
26783 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26784 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26785 example:
26786 .code
26787 warn ...some conditions...
26788 control = freeze
26789 accept ...
26790 .endd
26791 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26792 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26793 log entry.
26794
26795 .next
26796 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26797 &%require%& verb. For example:
26798 .code
26799 require control = no_multiline_responses
26800 .endd
26801 .endlist
26802
26803 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26804 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26805 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
26806 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
26807 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
26808 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
26809 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
26810 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
26811 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
26812
26813 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26814 example:
26815 .code
26816 deny ...some conditions...
26817 delay = 30s
26818 .endd
26819 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26820 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26821 .code
26822 deny delay = 30s
26823 ...some conditions...
26824 .endd
26825 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26826 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26827 .code
26828 warn ...some conditions...
26829 delay = 2m
26830 control = freeze
26831 accept ...
26832 .endd
26833
26834 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26835 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26836 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26837 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26838 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26839 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26840 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26841
26842
26843 .vitem &*endpass*&
26844 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26845 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26846 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26847 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26848 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26849 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26850 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26851
26852
26853 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26854 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26855 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26856 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26857 .code
26858 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
26859 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26860 .endd
26861 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26862 example:
26863 .display
26864 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26865 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26866 .endd
26867 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26868 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26869 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26870 message.
26871
26872 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26873 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26874 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26875 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26876 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26877 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26878 ignored.
26879
26880 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26881 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26882 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26883 error message.
26884
26885 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26886 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26887 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26888 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26889 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26890 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26891
26892 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26893 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26894 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26895 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26896 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26897 logging rejections.
26898
26899
26900 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26901 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26902 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26903 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26904 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26905 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26906 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26907 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26908 .display
26909 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26910 &` log_reject_target =`&
26911 .endd
26912 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26913 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26914 current ACL.
26915
26916
26917 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26918 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26919 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26920 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26921 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26922 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26923 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26924 ACLs. For example:
26925 .display
26926 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26927 &` control = freeze`&
26928 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26929 .endd
26930 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26931 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26932 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26933 example:
26934 .code
26935 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26936 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26937 .endd
26938
26939
26940 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26941 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26942 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26943 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26944 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26945 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26946 &%accept%& for details.)
26947
26948 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26949 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26950 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26951 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26952 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26953 .code
26954 require message = Host not recognized
26955 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
26956 .endd
26957 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26958 processed.)
26959
26960 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26961 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26962 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26963 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26964 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26965 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26966 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26967 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26968 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26969 EHLO options.
26970
26971 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26972 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26973 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26974 .code
26975 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26976 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26977 .endd
26978 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26979 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26980 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26981 2&'xx'&.
26982
26983 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26984 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26985
26986 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26987 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26988 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26989 response.
26990
26991 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26992 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26993 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26994 However, the original message is available in the variable
26995 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26996 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26997 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26998 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26999
27000 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27001 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27002 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27003 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27004 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27005 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27006 effect.
27007
27008
27009 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27010 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27011 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27012 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27013
27014
27015 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27016 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27017 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27018 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27019 .endlist
27020
27021
27022
27023
27024
27025 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27026 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27027 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27028
27029 .vlist
27030 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27031 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27032 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27033 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27034 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27035 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27036 not work without it. For example:
27037 .code
27038 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27039 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27040 .endd
27041 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27042 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27043 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27044 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27045 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27046
27047
27048 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27049 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27050 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27051 .cindex "case of local parts"
27052 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27053 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27054 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27055 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27056 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27057 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27058 is encountered.
27059
27060 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27061 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27062 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27063 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27064 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27065
27066 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27067 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27068 spam score:
27069 .code
27070 warn control = caseful_local_part
27071 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27072 $acl_m4 + \
27073 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27074 }
27075 control = caselower_local_part
27076 .endd
27077 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27078 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27079
27080
27081 .new
27082 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27083 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27084 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27085 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27086 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27087 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27088 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27089 after the ACL completes. Note that routers are used in verify mode.
27090
27091 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27092 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27093 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27094 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27095 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27096 line.
27097
27098 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27099 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27100 .wen
27101
27102
27103 .new
27104 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27105 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27106 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27107 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27108 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27109 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27110 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27111 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27112 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27113 contexts):
27114 .code
27115 control = debug
27116 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27117 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27118 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27119 .endd
27120 .wen
27121
27122
27123 .new
27124 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27125 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27126 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27127 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27128 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27129 .wen
27130
27131
27132 .new
27133 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27134 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27135 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27136 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27137 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27138 strings or to numeric value.
27139 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27140 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27141 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27142
27143 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27144 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27145 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27146 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27147 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27148 .wen
27149
27150
27151 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27152 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27153 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27154 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27155 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27156 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27157 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27158 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27159
27160 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27161 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27162 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27163 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27164 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27165 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27166 work with.
27167
27168
27169 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27170 .cindex "fake defer"
27171 .cindex "defer, fake"
27172 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27173 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27174 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27175 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27176 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27177
27178 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27179 .cindex "fake rejection"
27180 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27181 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27182 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27183 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27184 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27185 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27186 the same SMTP connection.
27187
27188 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27189 message is supplied, the following is used:
27190 .code
27191 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27192 550-kept for evaluation.
27193 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27194 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27195 .endd
27196 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27197
27198 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27199 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27200 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27201 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27202 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27203 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27204 SMTP connection.
27205
27206 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27207 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27208 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27209 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27210
27211 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27212 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27213 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27214 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27215 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27216 disables such output flushing.
27217
27218 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27219 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27220 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27221 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27222 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27223 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27224
27225 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27226 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27227 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27228 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27229 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27230 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27231 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27232 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27233 to be useful in production.
27234
27235 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27236 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27237 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27238 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27239 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27240
27241 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27242 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27243 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27244 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27245 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27246 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27247
27248 .ilist
27249 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27250 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27251 verification failed"&) is sent.
27252 .next
27253 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27254 line is output.
27255 .endlist
27256
27257 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27258 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27259
27260 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27261 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27262 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27263 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27264 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27265 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27266 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27267
27268 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27269 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27270 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27271 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27272 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27273 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27274 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27275 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27276 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27277 same SMTP connection.
27278
27279 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27280 .cindex "message" "submission"
27281 .cindex "submission mode"
27282 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27283 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27284 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27285 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27286 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27287 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27288 late (the message has already been created).
27289
27290 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27291 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27292 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27293 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27294 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27295
27296 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27297 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27298 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27299 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27300 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27301
27302 .ilist
27303 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27304 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27305 .next
27306 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27307 .next
27308 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27309 .endlist ilist
27310
27311 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27312 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27313 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27314 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27315 data is read.
27316
27317 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27318 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27319 .endlist vlist
27320
27321
27322 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27323 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27324
27325 .ilist
27326 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27327 .next
27328 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27329 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27330 .next
27331 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27332 .next
27333 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27334 .endlist
27335
27336
27337
27338 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27339 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27340 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27341 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
27342 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27343 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27344 .code
27345 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27346 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27347 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27348 .endd
27349 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27350 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27351 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27352 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27353 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27354 RCPT ACL).
27355
27356 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
27357 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
27358 contains one or more newlines that
27359 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27360 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27361 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27362
27363 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27364 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27365 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27366 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27367 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27368 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27369 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27370 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27371 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27372 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27373 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27374
27375 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27376 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
27377 of message headers
27378 until they are added to the
27379 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27380 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27381 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27382 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27383 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27384 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27385 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27386
27387 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
27388
27389 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27390 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27391 .display
27392 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27393 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27394
27395 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27396 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27397 .endd
27398 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27399 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27400 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27401 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27402 honoured.
27403
27404 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27405 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27406 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27407 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27408 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27409 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27410 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27411 specifications.
27412
27413 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27414 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27415 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27416 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27417 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27418
27419 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27420 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27421 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27422 to be a header name first.) For example:
27423 .code
27424 warn add_header = \
27425 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27426 .endd
27427 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27428 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27429 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27430 up in reverse order.
27431
27432 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27433 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27434 system filter or in a router or transport.
27435
27436
27437
27438 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
27439 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
27440 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
27441 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
27442 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
27443 from an incoming message, as in this example:
27444 .code
27445 warn message = Remove internal headers
27446 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27447 .endd
27448 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27449 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27450 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27451 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
27452 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
27453 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
27454
27455 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
27456 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
27457 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
27458 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
27459 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
27460 .code
27461 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
27462 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27463 warn message = Remove internal headers
27464 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
27465 .endd
27466 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27467 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27468 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
27469 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
27470 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
27471 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
27472 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
27473 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
27474 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
27475 would have been removed.
27476
27477 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
27478 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
27479 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
27480 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
27481 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
27482 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
27483 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
27484 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
27485 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27486
27487 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27488 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27489 .display
27490 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
27491 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27492
27493 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27494 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
27495 .endd
27496 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
27497 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
27498 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
27499 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
27500 are honoured.
27501
27502 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27503 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
27504 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
27505
27506
27507
27508
27509
27510 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27511 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27512 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27513 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27514 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27515 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27516
27517 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27518 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27519 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27520 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27521 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27522 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27523 The conditions are as follows:
27524
27525
27526 .vlist
27527 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27528 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27529 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27530 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27531 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27532 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27533 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27534 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27535 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27536 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27537 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27538 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27539
27540 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27541 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
27542 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
27543 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
27544 The name and values are expanded separately.
27545
27546 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27547 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27548 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27549 conditions are tested.
27550
27551 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27552 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27553 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27554 for different local users or different local domains.
27555
27556 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27557 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27558 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27559 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27560 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27561 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27562 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27563 .code
27564 authenticated = *
27565 .endd
27566
27567 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27568 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27569 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27570 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27571 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27572 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27573 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27574 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27575 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27576 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27577 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27578 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27579 negative.
27580
27581 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27582 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27583 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27584 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27585 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27586 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27587 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27588 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27589
27590 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27591 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27592 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27593 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27594 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27595
27596 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27597 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27598 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27599 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27600 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27601 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27602 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27603 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27604 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27605 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27606
27607 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27608 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27609 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27610 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27611 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27612 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27613 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27614 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27615 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27616 &%domains%& test.
27617
27618 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27619 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27620
27621
27622 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27623 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27624 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27625 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27626 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27627 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27628 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27629 .code
27630 encrypted = *
27631 .endd
27632
27633
27634 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
27635 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27636 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27637 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27638 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27639 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27640 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27641 .code
27642 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27643 .endd
27644 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27645 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27646 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27647
27648 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27649 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27650 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27651 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27652 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27653 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27654
27655 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27656 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27657 .code
27658 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27659 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27660 .endd
27661 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27662 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27663 statement can then check the IP address.
27664
27665 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27666 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27667 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27668 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27669 .code
27670 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27671 message = $host_data
27672 .endd
27673 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27674
27675 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27676 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27677 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27678 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27679 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27680 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27681 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27682 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27683 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27684 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27685
27686 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27687 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27688 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27689 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27690 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27691 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27692 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27693
27694 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27695 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27696 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27697 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27698 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27699 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27700 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27701 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27702
27703 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27704 .cindex "rate limiting"
27705 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27706 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27707
27708 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27709 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27710 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27711 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27712 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27713 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27714
27715 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27716 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27717 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27718 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27719 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27720 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27721 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27722
27723 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27724 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27725 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27726 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27727 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27728 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27729 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27730 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27731 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27732 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27733 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27734 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27735 influence the sender checking.
27736
27737 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27738 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27739
27740 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27741 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27742 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27743 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27744 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27745 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27746 .code
27747 senders = :
27748 .endd
27749 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27750 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27751
27752 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27753 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27754 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27755 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27756 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27757 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27758
27759 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27760 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27761 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27762 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27763 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27764 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27765 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27766 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27767 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27768 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27769
27770 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27771 .cindex "CSA verification"
27772 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27773 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27774 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27775
27776 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27777 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27778 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27779 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27780 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27781 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27782 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27783 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27784 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27785 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27786 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27787 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27788 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27789 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27790 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27791
27792 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27793 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27794 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27795 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27796 .code
27797 deny senders = :
27798 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27799 !verify = header_sender
27800 .endd
27801
27802 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27803 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27804 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27805 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27806 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27807 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27808 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27809 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27810 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27811 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27812 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27813 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27814 appropriate.
27815
27816 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27817 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27818 .code
27819 To: @
27820 .endd
27821 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27822 common as they used to be.
27823
27824 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27825 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27826 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27827 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27828 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27829 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27830 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27831 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27832 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27833 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27834 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27835 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27836 independently of this condition.
27837
27838 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27839 option), this condition is always true.
27840
27841
27842 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27843 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27844 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27845 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27846 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27847 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27848 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27849 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27850 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27851
27852 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27853 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27854
27855
27856 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27857 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27858 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27859 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27860 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27861 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27862 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27863 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27864 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27865 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27866 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27867 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27868 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27869 value for the child address.
27870
27871 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27872 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27873 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27874 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27875 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27876 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27877 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27878 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27879 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27880 original IP address.
27881
27882 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27883 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27884
27885 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27886 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27887 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27888 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27889 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27890 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27891 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27892 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27893 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27894
27895 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27896 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27897 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27898 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27899 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27900 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27901 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27902
27903 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27904 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27905 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27906
27907 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27908 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27909 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27910 verified as a sender.
27911 .endlist
27912
27913
27914
27915 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27916 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27917 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27918 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27919 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27920 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27921 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27922 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27923 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27924 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27925 .code
27926 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27927 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27928 .endd
27929 the following records are looked up:
27930 .code
27931 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27932 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27933 .endd
27934 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27935 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27936 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27937 use two separate conditions:
27938 .code
27939 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27940 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27941 .endd
27942 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27943 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27944 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27945 processed.
27946
27947 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27948 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27949 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27950 following special items in the list:
27951 .display
27952 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27953 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27954 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27955 .endd
27956 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27957 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27958 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27959 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27960 .code
27961 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27962 .endd
27963 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27964 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27965 .code
27966 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27967 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27968 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27969 .endd
27970 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27971 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27972 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27973 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27974
27975
27976
27977 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27978 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27979 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27980 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27981 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27982 .code
27983 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27984 .endd
27985 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27986 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27987 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27988 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27989
27990
27991
27992
27993 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27994 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27995 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27996 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27997 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27998 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27999 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28000 .code
28001 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28002 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28003 .endd
28004 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28005 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28006 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28007 up by this example is
28008 .code
28009 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28010 .endd
28011 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28012 addresses. For example:
28013 .code
28014 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28015 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28016 .endd
28017 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28018 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28019
28020
28021
28022
28023 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28024 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28025 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28026 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28027 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28028 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28029 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28030 either to double the separators like this:
28031 .code
28032 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28033 .endd
28034 or to change the separator character, like this:
28035 .code
28036 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28037 .endd
28038 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28039 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28040 occurs. Consider this condition:
28041 .code
28042 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28043 .endd
28044 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28045 .code
28046 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28047 a.domain.black.list.tld
28048 .endd
28049 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28050 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28051 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28052 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28053 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28054 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28055 error for a previous item.
28056
28057 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28058 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28059 .code
28060 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28061 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28062 .endd
28063 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28064 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28065 .code
28066 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28067 $sender_address_domain \
28068 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28069 see $dnslist_text.
28070 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28071 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28072 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28073 .endd
28074 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28075 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28076 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28077 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28078 .code
28079 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28080 .endd
28081 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28082 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28083
28084 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28085 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28086
28087
28088
28089
28090 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28091 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28092 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28093 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28094 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28095 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28096 .display
28097 127.1.0.1 RBL
28098 127.1.0.2 DUL
28099 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28100 127.1.0.4 RSS
28101 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28102 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28103 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28104 .endd
28105 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28106 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28107 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28108
28109
28110 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28111 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28112 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28113 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28114 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28115 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28116 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28117 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28118 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28119 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28120 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28121 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28122 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28123 cases, for example:
28124 .code
28125 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28126 .endd
28127 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28128 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28129 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28130 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28131 .code
28132 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28133 .endd
28134 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28135 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28136
28137 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28138 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28139 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28140 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28141 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28142 information.
28143
28144 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28145 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28146 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28147 .code
28148 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28149 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28150 at $dnslist_domain
28151 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28152 .endd
28153
28154
28155
28156 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28157 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28158 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28159 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28160 For example,
28161 .code
28162 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28163 .endd
28164 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28165 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28166 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28167 describes how multiple records are handled.
28168
28169 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28170 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28171 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28172 .code
28173 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28174 .endd
28175 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28176 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28177 first. For example:
28178 .code
28179 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28180 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28181 .endd
28182
28183 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28184 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28185 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28186 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28187 tested. For example:
28188 .code
28189 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28190 .endd
28191 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28192 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28193 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28194 .code
28195 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28196 .endd
28197 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28198 an odd number.
28199
28200
28201
28202 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28203 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28204 condition. Whereas
28205 .code
28206 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28207 .endd
28208 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28209 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28210 .code
28211 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28212 .endd
28213 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28214 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28215 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28216 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28217
28218 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28219 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28220
28221 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28222 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28223 .code
28224 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28225 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28226 .endd
28227 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28228 Consider this example:
28229 .code
28230 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28231 list.dsbl.org : \
28232 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28233 relays.ordb.org
28234 .endd
28235 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28236 .code
28237 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28238 list.dsbl.org
28239 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28240 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28241 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28242 .endd
28243 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28244
28245
28246
28247
28248 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28249 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28250 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28251 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28252 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28253 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28254 .code
28255 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28256 .endd
28257 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28258 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28259 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28260 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28261 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28262 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28263
28264 .ilist
28265 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28266 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28267 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28268 .next
28269 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28270 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28271 changed to:
28272 .code
28273 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28274 .endd
28275 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28276 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28277 .code
28278 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28279 .endd
28280 for the condition to be true.
28281 .endlist
28282
28283 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28284 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28285 .ilist
28286 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28287 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28288 .code
28289 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28290 .endd
28291 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28292 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28293 .next
28294 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28295 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28296 .code
28297 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28298 .endd
28299 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28300 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28301 .code
28302 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28303 .endd
28304 for the condition to be false.
28305 .endlist
28306 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28307 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28308
28309
28310
28311
28312 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28313 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28314 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28315 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28316 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28317 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28318 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28319 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28320 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28321 lists.
28322
28323 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28324 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28325 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28326 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28327 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28328 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28329 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28330 .code
28331 reject message = \
28332 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28333 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28334 dnslists = \
28335 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28336 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28337 .endd
28338 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28339 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28340 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28341 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28342 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28343 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28344
28345 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28346 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28347 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28348 .code
28349 reject dnslists = \
28350 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28351 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28352 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28353 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28354 .endd
28355 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28356 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28357 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28358
28359
28360
28361 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28362 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28363 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28364 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28365 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28366 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28367 .code
28368 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28369 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28370 .endd
28371 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28372 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28373 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28374 .code
28375 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28376 .endd
28377 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28378 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28379
28380 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28381 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28382 .code
28383 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28384 dnslists = some.list.example
28385 .endd
28386
28387 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28388 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28389 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28390 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28391 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28392 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28393 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28394 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28395 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28396 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28397 .display
28398 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28399 .endd
28400 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28401 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28402
28403 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28404 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28405 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28406 of &'p'&.
28407
28408 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28409 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28410 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28411 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28412 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28413 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28414 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28415 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28416 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28417
28418 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28419 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28420 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28421 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28422
28423 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28424 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28425 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28426 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28427 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28428 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28429 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28430 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28431 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28432 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28433
28434 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28435 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28436 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28437 ACL.
28438
28439 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28440 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28441 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28442 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28443 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28444 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28445
28446 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28447 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28448 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28449 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28450 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28451 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28452 the &%count=%& option.
28453
28454
28455 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28456 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28457 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28458 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28459 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28460
28461 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28462 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28463 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28464 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28465
28466 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28467 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28468 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28469 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28470 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28471 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28472 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28473
28474 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28475 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28476 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28477 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28478 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28479 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28480 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28481
28482 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28483 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28484 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28485 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28486 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
28487
28488 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28489 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28490 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28491 multiple different commands.
28492
28493 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28494 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28495 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28496 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28497 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28498
28499 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28500
28501
28502 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28503 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28504 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28505 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28506 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28507
28508 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28509 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28510
28511 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28512 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28513 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28514 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28515 new rate.
28516 .code
28517 acl_check_connect:
28518 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28519 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28520 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28521 # ...
28522 acl_check_mail:
28523 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28524 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28525 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28526 .endd
28527
28528 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28529 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28530 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28531 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28532 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28533 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28534 checks.
28535
28536 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28537 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28538 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28539 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28540 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28541
28542
28543 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28544 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28545 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28546 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28547 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28548 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28549 rest of the ACL.
28550
28551 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28552 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28553 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28554 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28555 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28556 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28557 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28558 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28559 from getting any email through.
28560
28561 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28562 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28563 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28564 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28565 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28566 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28567 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28568 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28569 .code
28570 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28571 .endd
28572
28573
28574 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28575 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28576 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28577 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28578 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28579 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28580 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28581 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28582 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28583
28584 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28585 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28586 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28587 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28588 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28589 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28590
28591 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28592 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28593 rate.
28594
28595 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28596 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28597 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28598 required increases with larger limits.
28599
28600 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28601 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28602 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28603 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28604 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28605 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28606 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28607 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28608 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28609 as intended.
28610
28611
28612 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28613 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28614 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28615 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28616 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28617 message. For example:
28618 .code
28619 # Log all senders' rates
28620 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28621 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28622
28623 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28624 # at the decimal point.
28625 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28626 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28627 $sender_rate_limit }s
28628
28629 # Keep authenticated users under control
28630 deny authenticated = *
28631 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28632
28633 # System-wide rate limit
28634 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28635 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28636
28637 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28638 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28639 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28640 messages per $sender_rate_period
28641 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28642 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28643 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28644 .endd
28645 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28646 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28647 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28648 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28649 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28650 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28651 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28652
28653
28654
28655 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28656 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28657 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28658 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28659 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28660 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28661 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28662 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28663 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28664 .code
28665 verify = sender/callout
28666 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28667 .endd
28668 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28669 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28670 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28671 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28672 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28673 The available options are as follows:
28674
28675 .ilist
28676 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28677 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28678 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28679 .next
28680 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28681 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28682 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28683 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28684 .next
28685 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28686 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28687 .next
28688 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28689 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28690 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28691 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28692 .endlist
28693
28694 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28695 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28696 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28697 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28698 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28699 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28700 coding like this:
28701 .code
28702 warn !verify = sender
28703 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28704 .endd
28705 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28706 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28707 verification failure.
28708
28709 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28710 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28711
28712 .ilist
28713 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28714 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28715 .next
28716 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28717 .next
28718 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28719 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28720 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28721 .next
28722 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28723 .next
28724 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28725 .endlist
28726
28727 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28728 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28729
28730
28731
28732
28733 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28734 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28735 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28736 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28737 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28738 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28739 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28740 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28741 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28742 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28743 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28744 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28745 sender's domain.
28746
28747 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28748 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28749 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28750 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28751 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28752 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28753
28754 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28755 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28756 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28757 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28758 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28759
28760 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28761 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28762 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28763 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28764 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28765 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28766 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28767 supplies a host list.
28768
28769 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28770 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28771 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28772 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28773 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28774 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28775 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28776
28777 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28778 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28779 following SMTP commands are sent:
28780 .display
28781 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28782 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
28783 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28784 &`QUIT`&
28785 .endd
28786 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28787 set to &"lmtp"&.
28788
28789 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28790 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28791 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28792 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28793 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28794 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28795
28796 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28797 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28798 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28799 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28800 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28801
28802 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28803 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28804 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28805 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28806 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28807
28808
28809
28810
28811 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28812 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28813 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28814 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28815 .code
28816 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28817 .endd
28818 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28819 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28820 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28821
28822
28823 .vlist
28824 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28825 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28826 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28827 For example:
28828 .code
28829 verify = sender/callout=5s
28830 .endd
28831 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28832 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28833 the &%connect%& parameter.
28834
28835
28836 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28837 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28838 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28839 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28840 .code
28841 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28842 .endd
28843 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28844
28845 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28846 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28847 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28848 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28849 updated in this circumstance.
28850
28851 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28852 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28853 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28854 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28855 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28856 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28857
28858
28859 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28860 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28861 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28862 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28863 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28864 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28865 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28866 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28867 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28868 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28869 .code
28870 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28871 .endd
28872 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28873
28874
28875 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28876 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28877 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28878 For example:
28879 .code
28880 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28881 .endd
28882 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28883 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28884 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28885 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28886 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28887
28888
28889 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28890 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28891 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28892 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28893
28894 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28895 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28896 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28897 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28898 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28899 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28900 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28901 made, until the cache record expires.
28902
28903 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28904 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28905 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28906 For example:
28907 .code
28908 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28909 .endd
28910 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28911 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28912 .code
28913 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28914 .endd
28915 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28916 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28917 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28918 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28919
28920
28921 .vitem &*random*&
28922 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28923 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28924 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28925 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28926 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28927 .code
28928 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28929 .endd
28930 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28931 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28932 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28933 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28934 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28935
28936 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28937 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28938 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28939 .code
28940 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28941 .endd
28942 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28943 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28944 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28945 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28946 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28947
28948 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28949 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28950 .code
28951 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28952 .endd
28953 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28954 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28955 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28956 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28957 usefulness of callout caching.
28958 .endlist
28959
28960 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28961 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28962 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28963 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28964 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28965 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28966 these circumstances.
28967
28968 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28969 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28970 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28971 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28972 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28973 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28974 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28975
28976 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28977 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28978 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28979 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28980
28981
28982
28983
28984 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28985 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28986 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28987 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28988 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28989 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28990 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28991 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28992 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28993 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28994
28995 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28996 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28997 is not available.
28998
28999 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29000 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29001 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29002
29003 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29004 commands up to and including
29005 .code
29006 MAIL FROM:<>
29007 .endd
29008 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29009 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29010 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29011 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29012 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29013 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29014 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29015
29016 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29017 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29018 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29019 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29020 will eventually be noticed.
29021
29022 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29023 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29024 behaviour will be the same.
29025
29026
29027
29028 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29029 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29030 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29031 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29032 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29033 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29034 you might see:
29035 .code
29036 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29037 250 OK
29038 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29039 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29040 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29041 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29042 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29043 550 Sender verification failed
29044 .endd
29045 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29046 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29047 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29048 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29049 example:
29050 .code
29051 verify = sender/no_details
29052 .endd
29053
29054 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29055 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29056 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29057 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29058 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29059 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29060 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29061
29062 .ilist
29063 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29064 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29065 verification also fails.
29066 .next
29067 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29068 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29069 .endlist
29070
29071 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29072 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29073 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29074 .code
29075 A.Wol: aw123
29076 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29077 .endd
29078 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29079 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29080 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29081 verification to succeed.
29082
29083 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29084 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29085 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29086 option. For example:
29087 .code
29088 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29089 .endd
29090 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29091 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29092
29093 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29094 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29095 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29096 address and a report is output for each of them.
29097
29098
29099
29100 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29101 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29102 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29103 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29104 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29105 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29106 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29107 .code
29108 verify = csa
29109 .endd
29110 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29111 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29112 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29113 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29114 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29115 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29116
29117 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29118 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29119 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29120 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29121
29122 .ilist
29123 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29124 .next
29125 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29126 .next
29127 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29128 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29129 .next
29130 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29131 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29132 .endlist
29133
29134 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29135 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29136 .code
29137 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29138 .endd
29139 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29140 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29141 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29142 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29143 meaningful to say:
29144 .code
29145 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29146 .endd
29147 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29148 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29149 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29150
29151 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29152 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29153 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29154 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29155 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29156 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29157 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29158 of legitimate HELO domains.
29159
29160 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29161 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29162 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29163 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29164 lookup such as:
29165 .code
29166 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29167 .endd
29168 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29169 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29170 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29171
29172
29173
29174
29175 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29176 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29177 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29178 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29179 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29180 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29181 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29182 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29183
29184 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29185 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29186 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29187 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29188 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29189 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29190 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29191
29192 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29193 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29194 like this:
29195 .code
29196 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29197 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29198 }{$value}}
29199 .endd
29200 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29201 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29202 use this:
29203 .code
29204 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29205 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29206 senders = :
29207 recipients = +batv_senders
29208
29209 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29210 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29211 senders = :
29212 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29213 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29214 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29215 .endd
29216 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29217 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29218 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29219 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29220 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29221
29222 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29223 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29224 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29225 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29226 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29227 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29228 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29229
29230 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29231 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29232 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29233 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29234 .code
29235 batv_redirect:
29236 driver = redirect
29237 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29238 .endd
29239 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29240 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29241 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29242 local addresses.
29243
29244 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29245 can be used:
29246 .code
29247 external_smtp_batv:
29248 driver = smtp
29249 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29250 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29251 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29252 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29253 {$value}fail}}}
29254 .endd
29255 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29256
29257
29258
29259 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29260 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29261 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29262 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29263 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29264 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29265 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29266 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29267 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29268 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29269
29270 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29271 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29272 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29273 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29274 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29275 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29276 . ///
29277 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29278 . ///
29279 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29280 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29281 system to arbitrary domains.
29282
29283
29284 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29285 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29286 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29287 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29288
29289 .ilist
29290 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29291 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29292 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29293 .next
29294 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29295 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29296 .next
29297 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29298 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29299 .endlist
29300
29301
29302 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29303 .code
29304 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29305 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29306 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29307 .endd
29308 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29309 command:
29310 .code
29311 acl_check_rcpt:
29312 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29313 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29314 .endd
29315 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29316 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29317 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29318 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29319 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29320 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29321 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29322
29323
29324
29325 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29326 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29327 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29328 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29329 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29330
29331 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29332 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29333 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29334 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29335 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29336 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29337 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29338 .ecindex IIDacl
29339
29340
29341
29342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29343 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29344
29345 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29346 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29347 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29348 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29349 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29350 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29351 specification.
29352
29353 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29354 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29355 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29356 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29357 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29358
29359 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29360 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29361 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29362
29363 .ilist
29364 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29365 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29366 .next
29367 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29368 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29369 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29370 .next
29371 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29372 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29373 .next
29374 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29375 conditions.
29376 .next
29377 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29378 .endlist
29379
29380 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29381 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29382 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29383
29384 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29385 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29386 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29387 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29388 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29389 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29390
29391 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29392 temporarily created in a file called:
29393 .display
29394 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29395 .endd
29396 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29397 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29398 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29399 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29400 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29401 .code
29402 control = no_mbox_unspool
29403 .endd
29404 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29405 same directory by default.
29406
29407
29408
29409 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29410 .cindex "virus scanning"
29411 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29412 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29413 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29414 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29415 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29416 in memory and thus are much faster.
29417
29418
29419 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29420 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29421 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29422 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29423 .display
29424 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29425 .endd
29426 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29427 .code
29428 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29429 .endd
29430 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29431 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29432
29433 .vlist
29434 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29435 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29436 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29437 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29438 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29439 example:
29440 .code
29441 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29442 .endd
29443
29444
29445 .vitem &%clamd%&
29446 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29447 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29448 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29449 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29450 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29451 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29452 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29453 .code
29454 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29455 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29456 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29457 .endd
29458 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29459 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29460 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29461 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29462 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29463 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29464 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29465 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29466 contributing the code for this scanner.
29467
29468 .vitem &%cmdline%&
29469 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29470 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29471 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29472 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29473
29474 .olist
29475 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29476 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29477
29478 .next
29479 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29480 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29481 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29482 the &"trigger"& expression.
29483
29484 .next
29485 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29486 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29487 &"name"& expression.
29488 .endlist olist
29489
29490 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29491 .code
29492 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29493 .endd
29494 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29495 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29496 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29497 configuration setting:
29498 .code
29499 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29500 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29501 found in file:'(.+)'
29502 .endd
29503 .vitem &%drweb%&
29504 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29505 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29506 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29507 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29508 .code
29509 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29510 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29511 .endd
29512 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29513 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29514
29515 .vitem &%fsecure%&
29516 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29517 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29518 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29519 .code
29520 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29521 .endd
29522 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29523 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29524
29525 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29526 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29527 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29528 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29529 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29530 For example:
29531 .code
29532 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29533 .endd
29534 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29535
29536 .vitem &%mksd%&
29537 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29538 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29539 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29540 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29541 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29542 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29543 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29544 .code
29545 av_scanner = mksd:2
29546 .endd
29547 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29548
29549 .vitem &%sophie%&
29550 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29551 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29552 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29553 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29554 client communication. For example:
29555 .code
29556 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29557 .endd
29558 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29559 the option.
29560 .endlist
29561
29562 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29563 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29564 ACL.
29565
29566 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29567 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29568 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29569 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29570 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29571 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29572 message.
29573
29574 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29575 use. It can then be one of
29576
29577 .ilist
29578 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29579 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29580 recommended usage.
29581 .next
29582 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29583 the condition fails immediately.
29584 .next
29585 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29586 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29587 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29588 .endlist
29589
29590 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29591 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29592 causes the ACL to defer.
29593
29594 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29595 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29596 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29597 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29598 logging data.
29599
29600 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29601 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29602 &%malware%& condition.
29603
29604 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29605 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29606
29607 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29608 .code
29609 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29610 demime = *
29611 malware = *
29612 .endd
29613 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29614 .code
29615 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29616 demime = *
29617 malware = */defer_ok
29618 .endd
29619 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29620 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29621 .code
29622 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29623 .endd
29624 in the main Exim configuration.
29625 .code
29626 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29627 set acl_m0 = sophie
29628 malware = *
29629
29630 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29631 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29632 malware = *
29633 .endd
29634
29635
29636 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29637 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29638 .cindex "spam scanning"
29639 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29640 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29641 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29642 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29643 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29644 .code
29645 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29646 .endd
29647 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29648 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29649 nicely, however.
29650
29651 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29652 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29653 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29654 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29655 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29656 .code
29657 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29658 .endd
29659 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29660 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29661 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29662 address/port pair:
29663 .code
29664 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29665 .endd
29666 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29667 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29668 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29669 option, separated with colons:
29670 .code
29671 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29672 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29673 192.168.2.12 783
29674 .endd
29675 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29676 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29677 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29678 condition defers.
29679
29680 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29681 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29682
29683 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29684 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29685 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29686 expansion.
29687
29688 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29689 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29690 .code
29691 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29692 spam = joe
29693 .endd
29694 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29695 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29696 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29697 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29698 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29699
29700 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29701 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29702 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29703 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29704 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29705 are not set.
29706
29707 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29708 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29709 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29710
29711
29712 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29713 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29714 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29715 example:
29716 .code
29717 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29718 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29719 spam = nobody
29720 .endd
29721
29722 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29723 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29724 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29725 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29726
29727 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29728 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29729 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29730 available for use at delivery time.
29731
29732 .vlist
29733 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29734 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29735 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29736
29737 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29738 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29739 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29740 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29741 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29742
29743 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29744 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29745 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29746 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29747 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29748
29749 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29750 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29751 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29752 .endlist
29753
29754 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29755 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29756 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29757
29758 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29759 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29760 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29761 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29762 spam condition, like this:
29763 .code
29764 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29765 spam = joe/defer_ok
29766 .endd
29767 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29768
29769 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29770 condition:
29771 .code
29772 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29773 warn spam = nobody:true
29774 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29775 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29776
29777 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29778 # is over threshold
29779 warn spam = nobody
29780 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29781
29782 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29783 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29784 spam = nobody:true
29785 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29786 .endd
29787
29788
29789
29790 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29791 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29792 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29793 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29794 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29795 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29796 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29797 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29798 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29799 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29800 cases.
29801
29802 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29803 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29804 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29805 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29806 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29807 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29808 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29809
29810 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29811 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29812 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29813 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29814 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29815
29816 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29817 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29818 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29819 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29820 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29821 syntax is:
29822 .display
29823 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29824 .endd
29825 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29826 the value can be:
29827
29828 .olist
29829 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29830 .next
29831 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29832 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29833 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29834 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29835 .next
29836 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29837 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29838 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29839 the full path and file name.
29840 .next
29841 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29842 filename, and the default path is then used.
29843 .endlist
29844 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29845 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29846 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29847 .code
29848 decode = $mime_filename
29849 .endd
29850 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29851 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29852 automatically unlinked.
29853
29854 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29855 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29856 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29857 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29858 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29859
29860 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29861 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29862 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29863
29864 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29865 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29866 available in the MIME ACL:
29867
29868 .vlist
29869 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29870 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29871 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29872 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29873 contains the empty string.
29874
29875 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29876 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29877 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29878 .code
29879 us-ascii
29880 gb2312 (Chinese)
29881 iso-8859-1
29882 .endd
29883 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29884 case-insensitively.
29885
29886 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29887 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29888 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29889 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29890 only used for display purposes.
29891
29892 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29893 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29894 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29895
29896 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29897 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29898 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29899
29900 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29901 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29902 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29903 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29904 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29905
29906 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29907 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29908 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29909 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29910
29911 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29912 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29913 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29914 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29915 .code
29916 text/plain
29917 text/html
29918 application/octet-stream
29919 image/jpeg
29920 audio/midi
29921 .endd
29922 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29923 empty string.
29924
29925 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29926 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29927 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29928 containing the decoded data.
29929 .endlist
29930
29931 .cindex "RFC 2047"
29932 .vlist
29933 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29934 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29935 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29936 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29937 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29938 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29939
29940 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29941 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29942 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29943 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29944
29945 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29946 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29947 follows:
29948
29949 .olist
29950 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29951
29952 .next
29953 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29954 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29955
29956 .next
29957 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29958 and the rest are attachments.
29959
29960 .next
29961 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29962 .endlist olist
29963
29964 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29965 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29966 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29967 .code
29968 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29969 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29970 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29971 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29972 .endd
29973 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29974 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29975 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29976 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29977 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29978
29979 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29980 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29981 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29982 decoding is fully recursive.
29983
29984 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29985 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29986 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29987 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29988 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29989 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29990 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29991 .endlist
29992
29993
29994
29995 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29996 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29997 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29998 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29999 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30000
30001 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30002 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30003 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30004 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30005 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30006
30007 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30008 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30009 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30010 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30011 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30012 32K characters are checked.
30013
30014 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30015 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30016 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30017 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30018 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30019 .code
30020 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30021 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30022 .endd
30023 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30024 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30025 matching regular expression.
30026
30027 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30028 CPU-intensive.
30029
30030
30031
30032
30033 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30034 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30035 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30036 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30037 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30038 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30039 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30040 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30041 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30042 use the &%demime%& condition.
30043
30044 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30045 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30046 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30047 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30048 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30049 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30050
30051 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30052 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30053 example:
30054 .code
30055 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30056 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30057 .endd
30058 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30059 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30060 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30061 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30062
30063 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30064 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30065 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30066
30067 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30068
30069 .vlist
30070 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30071 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30072 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30073 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30074 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30075 zero, no error occurred.
30076
30077 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30078 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30079 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30080 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30081 .endlist
30082
30083 .vlist
30084 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30085 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30086 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30087 extension it found.
30088 .endlist
30089
30090 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30091 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30092
30093 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30094 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30095 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30096 facility:
30097 .code
30098 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30099 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30100 demime = *
30101 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30102
30103 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30104 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30105 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30106 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30107
30108 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30109 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30110 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30111 demime = exe:doc
30112 control = freeze
30113 .endd
30114 .ecindex IIDcosca
30115
30116
30117
30118
30119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30121
30122 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30123 "Local scan function"
30124 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30125 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30126 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30127 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30128 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30129
30130 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30131 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30132 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30133 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30134 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30135
30136 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30137 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30138 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30139 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30140
30141 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30142 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30143 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30144 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30145
30146 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30147 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30148 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30149 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30150 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30151 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30152 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30153 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30154 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30155
30156
30157
30158 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30159 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30160 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30161 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30162 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30163 directory, so you might set
30164 .code
30165 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30166 .endd
30167 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30168 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30169 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30170 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30171 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30172 _src/local_scan.c_.
30173
30174 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30175 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30176 .code
30177 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30178 .endd
30179 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30180
30181
30182
30183
30184 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30185 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30186 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30187 .code
30188 #include "local_scan.h"
30189 .endd
30190 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30191 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30192 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30193 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30194 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30195 strings and pointers to character strings:
30196 .code
30197 #define CS (char *)
30198 #define CCS (const char *)
30199 #define CSS (char **)
30200 #define US (unsigned char *)
30201 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30202 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30203 .endd
30204 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30205 .code
30206 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30207 .endd
30208 The arguments are as follows:
30209
30210 .ilist
30211 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30212 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30213 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30214
30215 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30216 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30217 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30218 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30219 case this changes in some future version.
30220 .next
30221 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30222 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30223 .endlist
30224
30225 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30226
30227 .vlist
30228 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30229 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30230 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30231 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30232 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30233 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30234
30235 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30236 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30237 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30238
30239 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30240 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30241 queued without immediate delivery.
30242
30243 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30244 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30245 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30246 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30247 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30248 used.
30249
30250 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30251 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30252 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30253 problem"& is used.
30254
30255 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30256 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30257 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30258 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30259 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30260 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30261 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30262
30263 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30264 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30265 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30266 .endlist
30267
30268 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30269 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30270 &%-oe%& command line options.
30271
30272
30273
30274 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30275 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30276 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30277 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30278 want to do this, you must have the line
30279 .code
30280 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30281 .endd
30282 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30283 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30284 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30285 to define them.
30286
30287 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30288 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30289 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30290 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30291 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30292 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30293 .code
30294 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30295 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30296
30297 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30298 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30299 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30300 };
30301
30302 int local_scan_options_count =
30303 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30304 .endd
30305 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30306 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30307 .code
30308 begin local_scan
30309 my_integer = 99
30310 my_string = some string of text...
30311 .endd
30312 The available types of option data are as follows:
30313
30314 .vlist
30315 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30316 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30317 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30318 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30319 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30320 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30321 values.)
30322
30323 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30324 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30325 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30326 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30327
30328 .vitem &*opt_int*&
30329 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30330 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30331 Exim.
30332
30333 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30334 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30335 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30336 printed with the suffix K or M.
30337
30338 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30339 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30340 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30341 always output in octal.
30342
30343 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30344 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30345 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30346
30347 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30348 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30349 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30350 .endlist
30351
30352 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30353 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30354
30355
30356
30357 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30358 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30359 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30360 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30361 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30362 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30363 C variables are as follows:
30364
30365 .vlist
30366 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30367 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30368
30369 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30370 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30371
30372 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30373 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30374 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30375 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30376
30377 .ilist
30378 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30379 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30380 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30381
30382 .next
30383 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30384 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30385 of debugging bits.
30386 .endlist ilist
30387
30388 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30389 selected, you should use code like this:
30390 .code
30391 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30392 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30393 .endd
30394 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30395 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30396 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30397
30398 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30399 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30400 discussed below.
30401
30402 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30403 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30404
30405 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30406 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30407
30408 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30409 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30410 &%-bh%& command line option.
30411
30412 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30413 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30414 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30415
30416 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30417 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30418 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30419 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30420
30421 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30422 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30423 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30424
30425 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30426 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30427
30428 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30429 The number of accepted recipients.
30430
30431 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30432 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30433 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30434 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30435 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30436 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30437 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30438 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30439 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30440 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30441 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30442 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30443
30444 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30445 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30446
30447 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30448 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30449 locally-submitted messages.
30450
30451 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30452 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30453 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30454
30455 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30456 The name of the sending host, if known.
30457
30458 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30459 The port on the sending host.
30460
30461 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30462 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30463
30464 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30465 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30466
30467 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30468 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30469 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30470 .endlist
30471
30472
30473 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30474 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30475 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30476 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30477 their type to *.
30478
30479
30480 .vlist
30481 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30482 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30483
30484 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30485 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30486 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30487 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30488 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30489 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30490 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30491
30492 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30493 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30494 internal newlines.
30495
30496 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30497 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30498 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30499 .endlist
30500
30501
30502
30503 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30504 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30505
30506 .vlist
30507 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30508 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30509
30510 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30511 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30512 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30513 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30514
30515 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30516 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30517 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30518 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30519 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30520 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30521 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30522 is NULL for all recipients.
30523 .endlist
30524
30525
30526
30527 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30528 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30529 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30530 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30531 release:
30532
30533 .vlist
30534 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30535 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30536
30537 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30538 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30539 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30540 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30541
30542 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30543 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30544 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30545 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30546 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30547
30548 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30549
30550 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30551 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30552 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30553 return value is as follows:
30554
30555 .ilist
30556 >= 0
30557
30558 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30559 ending status.
30560
30561 .next
30562 < 0 and > &--256
30563
30564 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30565 signal number.
30566
30567 .next
30568 &--256
30569
30570 The process timed out.
30571 .next
30572 &--257
30573
30574 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30575 .endlist
30576
30577 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30578 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30579 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30580 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30581 forks a subprocess that is running
30582 .code
30583 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30584 .endd
30585 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30586 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30587 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30588 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30589
30590 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30591 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30592 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30593 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30594
30595
30596 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30597 *sender_authentication)*&
30598 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30599 that it runs is:
30600 .display
30601 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30602 .endd
30603 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30604
30605
30606 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30607 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30608 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30609 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30610 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30611 .code
30612 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30613 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30614 .endd
30615
30616 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30617 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30618 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30619 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30620 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30621 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30622 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30623 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30624
30625 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30626 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30627 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30628 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30629 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30630 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30631
30632 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30633 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30634 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30635 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30636
30637 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30638 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30639 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30640 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30641 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30642 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30643 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30644 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30645 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30646 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30647 .code
30648 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30649 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30650 .endd
30651 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30652 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30653
30654
30655 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30656 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30657 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30658 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30659 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30660
30661
30662 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30663 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30664 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30665 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30666 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30667 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30668 .code
30669 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30670 .endd
30671 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30672 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30673 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30674 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30675 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30676 zero-terminated.
30677
30678 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30679 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30680 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30681 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30682 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30683 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30684 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30685 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30686
30687 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30688 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30689 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30690 .display
30691 &`OK `& match succeeded
30692 &`FAIL `& match failed
30693 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30694 .endd
30695 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30696 inability to contact a database.
30697
30698 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30699 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30700 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30701 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30702 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30703
30704 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30705 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30706 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30707 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30708 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30709
30710 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30711 uschar&~*list)*&"
30712 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30713 expected to be
30714 .code
30715 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30716 .endd
30717 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30718 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30719 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30720 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30721 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30722 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30723 failed.
30724
30725 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30726 *format,&~...)*&"
30727 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30728 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30729 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30730 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30731 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30732 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30733
30734
30735 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30736 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30737 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30738 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30739
30740 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30741 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30742 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30743 value afterwards. For example:
30744 .code
30745 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30746 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30747 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30748 .endd
30749
30750 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30751 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30752 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30753 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30754 address.
30755 .endlist
30756
30757
30758 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30759 .vlist
30760 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30761 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30762 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30763 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30764 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30765 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30766 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30767 binary string is returned with an error message.
30768
30769 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30770 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30771 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30772
30773 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30774 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30775 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30776 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30777 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30778
30779 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30780 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30781 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30782
30783 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30784 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30785 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30786 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30787 with translation.
30788
30789
30790 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30791 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30792 below.
30793
30794 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30795 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30796 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30797 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30798 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30799 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30800 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30801 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30802 is involved.
30803
30804 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30805 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30806
30807 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30808 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30809 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30810 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30811 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30812 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30813 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30814 .code
30815 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30816 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30817 .endd
30818 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30819 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30820 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30821 multiple output lines.
30822
30823 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30824 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30825 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30826 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30827 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30828 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30829 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30830 is an error.
30831
30832 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30833 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30834 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30835 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30836
30837 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30838 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30839 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30840
30841 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30842 See below.
30843
30844 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30845 See below.
30846
30847 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30848 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30849 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30850 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30851 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30852 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30853 more discussion.
30854 .endlist
30855
30856
30857
30858 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30859 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30860 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30861 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30862 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30863 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30864 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30865 terminates.
30866
30867 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30868 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30869 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30870 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30871
30872 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30873 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30874 .code
30875 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30876 .endd
30877 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30878 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30879 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30880 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30881
30882 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30883 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30884 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30885 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30886 &%store_pool%&.
30887 .ecindex IIDlosca
30888
30889
30890
30891
30892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30894
30895 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30896 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30897 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30898 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30899 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30900 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30901 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30902 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30903
30904 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30905 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30906 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30907 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30908 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30909
30910 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30911 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30912 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30913 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30914 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30915 prevent it happening on retries.
30916
30917 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30918 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30919 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30920 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30921 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30922 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30923 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30924 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30925
30926
30927 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30928 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30929 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30930 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30931 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30932 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30933 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30934 .code
30935 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30936 system_filter_user = exim
30937 .endd
30938 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30939 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30940 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30941 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30942 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30943 by the &%reply%& command.
30944
30945
30946 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30947 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30948 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30949 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30950
30951 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30952 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30953
30954
30955
30956 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30957 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30958 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30959 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30960 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30961 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30962 they cause errors.
30963
30964 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30965 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30966 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30967 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30968 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30969 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30970 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30971
30972 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30973 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30974 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30975 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30976 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30977
30978 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30979 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30980 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30981 to which users' filter files can refer.
30982
30983
30984
30985 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30986 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30987 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30988 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30989 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30990
30991
30992
30993 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30994 .cindex "freezing messages"
30995 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30996 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30997 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30998 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30999 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31000 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31001 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31002 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31003 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31004 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31005 .code
31006 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31007 .endd
31008 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31009
31010 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31011 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31012 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31013 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31014 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31015 run.
31016
31017 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31018 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31019 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31020 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31021
31022 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31023 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31024 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31025 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31026 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31027 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31028 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31029 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31030 message. For example:
31031 .code
31032 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31033 because it contains attachments that we are \
31034 not prepared to receive."
31035 .endd
31036
31037 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31038 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31039 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31040 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31041 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31042 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31043 use, for example
31044 .code
31045 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31046 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31047 .endd
31048 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31049 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31050 generated by the filter.
31051
31052 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31053 &%defer%&,
31054 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31055 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31056 as
31057 .code
31058 mail ...
31059 freeze
31060 .endd
31061 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31062 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31063 take place.
31064
31065
31066
31067 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31068 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31069 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31070 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31071 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31072 .code
31073 headers add <string>
31074 headers remove <string>
31075 .endd
31076 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31077 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31078 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31079 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31080 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31081
31082 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31083 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31084 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31085 example:
31086 .code
31087 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31088 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31089 X-header-2: ...."
31090 .endd
31091 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31092 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31093 space after input continuations is ignored.
31094
31095 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31096 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31097 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31098 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31099 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31100
31101 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31102 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31103 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31104 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31105 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31106 used for all recipients of the message.
31107
31108 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31109 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31110 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31111 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31112 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31113 until the message is actually being written (see section
31114 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31115
31116 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31117 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31118 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31119 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31120 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31121 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31122 modified more than once.
31123
31124 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31125 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31126 For example:
31127 .code
31128 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31129 headers remove "Subject"
31130 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31131 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31132 .endd
31133
31134
31135
31136 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31137 .cindex "envelope sender"
31138 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31139 .code
31140 errors_to <some address>
31141 .endd
31142 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31143 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31144 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31145 might use
31146 .code
31147 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31148 .endd
31149 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31150 address if its delivery failed.
31151
31152
31153
31154 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31155 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31156 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31157 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31158 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31159 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31160 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31161 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31162 which implements such a filter:
31163 .code
31164 central_filter:
31165 check_local_user
31166 driver = redirect
31167 domains = +local_domains
31168 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31169 no_verify
31170 allow_filter
31171 allow_freeze
31172 .endd
31173 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31174 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31175 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31176 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31177
31178 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31179 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31180 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31181 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31182 normal way.
31183 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31184 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31185 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31186
31187
31188
31189
31190
31191
31192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31193 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31194
31195 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31196 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31197 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31198 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31199 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31200 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31201 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31202 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31203
31204 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31205 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31206 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31207 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31208 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31209
31210 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31211 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31212 loopback interface specially in any way.
31213
31214 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31215 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31216
31217
31218
31219
31220 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31221 .cindex "message" "submission"
31222 .cindex "submission mode"
31223 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31224 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31225 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31226 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31227 .code
31228 control = submission
31229 .endd
31230 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31231 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31232 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31233 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31234 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31235 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31236 .code
31237 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31238 control = submission
31239 .endd
31240 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31241 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31242 is used to separate options. For example:
31243 .code
31244 control = submission/sender_retain
31245 .endd
31246 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31247 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31248 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31249 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31250 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31251 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31252 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31253
31254 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31255 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31256 example:
31257 .code
31258 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31259 .endd
31260 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31261 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31262 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31263 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31264 .code
31265 accept authenticated = *
31266 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31267 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31268 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31269 .endd
31270 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31271 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31272 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31273 .code
31274 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31275 .endd
31276 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31277 line would be:
31278 .code
31279 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31280 .endd
31281 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31282 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31283 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31284 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31285
31286 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31287 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31288 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31289 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31290 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31291 spoof another's address.
31292
31293 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31294 .cindex "line endings"
31295 .cindex "carriage return"
31296 .cindex "linefeed"
31297 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31298 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31299 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31300 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31301 use CRLF or just CR.
31302
31303 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31304 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31305 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31306 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31307 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31308 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31309 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31310 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31311 follows:
31312
31313 .ilist
31314 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31315 .next
31316 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31317 is ignored.
31318 .next
31319 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31320 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31321 terminator.
31322 .next
31323 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31324 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31325 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31326 people trying to play silly games.
31327 .next
31328 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31329 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31330 line.
31331 .endlist
31332
31333
31334
31335
31336
31337 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31338 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31339 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31340 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31341 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31342 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31343 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31344 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31345
31346 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31347 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31348 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31349 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31350 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31351
31352 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31353 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31354 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31355 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31356 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31357 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31358 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31359 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31360
31361
31362
31363
31364 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31365 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31366 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31367 .cindex "sender" "address"
31368 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31369 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31370 .cindex "envelope sender"
31371 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31372 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31373 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31374 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31375 .code
31376 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31377 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31378 .endd
31379 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31380 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31381 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31382 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31383 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31384 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31385 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31386 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31387 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31388
31389 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31390 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31391 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31392 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31393 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31394 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31395 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31396
31397 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31398 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31399 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31400
31401 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31402 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31403 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31404 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31405
31406
31407
31408 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31409 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31410 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31411 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31412 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31413 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31414 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31415
31416 .blockquote
31417 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31418 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31419 .endblockquote
31420
31421 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31422 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31423 follows:
31424
31425 .ilist
31426 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31427 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31428 .next
31429 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31430 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31431 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31432 .next
31433 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31434 also removed.
31435 .next
31436 For a locally-submitted message,
31437 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31438 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31439 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31440 included in log lines in this case.
31441 .next
31442 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31443 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31444 .endlist
31445
31446
31447
31448
31449 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31450 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31451 includes the header line:
31452 .code
31453 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31454 .endd
31455
31456 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31457 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31458 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31459 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31460 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31461 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31462
31463
31464 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31465 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31466 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31467 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31468 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31469
31470 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31471 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31472 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31473 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31474 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31475 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31476 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31477 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31478 messages.
31479
31480
31481 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31482 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31483 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31484 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31485 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31486 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31487 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31488 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31489 messages.
31490
31491
31492 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31493 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31494 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31495 .cindex "message" "submission"
31496 .cindex "submission mode"
31497 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31498 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31499
31500 .ilist
31501 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31502 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31503 .next
31504 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31505 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31506 .olist
31507 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31508 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31509 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31510 .next
31511 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31512 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31513 .next
31514 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31515 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31516 .endlist
31517 .endlist
31518
31519 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31520
31521 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31522 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31523 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31524 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31525 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31526 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31527 &%qualify_domain%&.
31528
31529 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31530 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31531 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31532 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31533
31534
31535 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31536 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31537 .cindex "message" "submission"
31538 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31539 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31540 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31541 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31542 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31543 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31544 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31545 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31546 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31547 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31548
31549
31550 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31551 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31552 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31553 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31554 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31555
31556 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31557 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31558 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31559 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31560
31561 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31562 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31563 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31564
31565
31566 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31567 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31568 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31569 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31570 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31571 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31572 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31573 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31574 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31575 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31576 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31577
31578
31579
31580 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31581 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31582 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31583 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31584 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31585 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31586 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31587 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31588
31589
31590
31591 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31592 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31593 .cindex "message" "submission"
31594 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31595 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31596 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31597 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31598 control setting.
31599
31600 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31601 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31602 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31603 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31604 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31605 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31606 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31607 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31608 line is added to the message.
31609
31610 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31611 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31612 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31613 options true at the same time.
31614
31615 .cindex "submission mode"
31616 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31617 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31618 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31619 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31620
31621 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31622 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31623 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31624 created as follows:
31625
31626 .ilist
31627 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31628 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31629 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31630 .next
31631 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31632 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31633 .next
31634 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31635 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31636 .endlist
31637
31638 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31639 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31640 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31641 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31642
31643 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31644 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31645 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31646 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31647
31648
31649
31650 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31651 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31652 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31653 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31654 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31655 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31656 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31657 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31658 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31659
31660 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31661 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31662 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31663 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31664 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31665 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31666
31667 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31668 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31669 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31670
31671 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31672 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31673 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31674 .code
31675 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31676 X-added-second: another added header line
31677 .endd
31678 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31679
31680 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
31681 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating newline
31682 added) before expansion.
31683
31684 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31685 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31686 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31687 not part of the names. For example:
31688 .code
31689 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31690 .endd
31691
31692 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
31693 specified; the values will be concatenated (with a separating colon
31694 added) before expansion.
31695
31696 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31697 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31698 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31699 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31700 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31701
31702 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31703 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31704 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31705 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31706
31707 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31708 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31709 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31710 requirements.
31711
31712 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31713 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31714 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31715 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31716 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31717 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31718 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31719
31720 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31721 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31722 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31723 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31724
31725 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31726 the following consequences:
31727
31728 .ilist
31729 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31730 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31731 to it, at all times.
31732 .next
31733 Header lines that are added by a router's
31734 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31735 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31736 .next
31737 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31738 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31739 .next
31740 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31741 a later router or by a transport.
31742 .next
31743 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31744 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31745 .code
31746 headers_remove = subject
31747 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31748 .endd
31749 .endlist
31750
31751 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31752 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31753
31754
31755
31756
31757
31758 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31759 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31760 .cindex "constructed address"
31761 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31762 the form
31763 .display
31764 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31765 .endd
31766 For example:
31767 .code
31768 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31769 .endd
31770 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31771 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31772 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31773 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31774 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31775 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31776 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31777 there is no password file entry.
31778
31779 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31780 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31781 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31782 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31783 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31784 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31785 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31786 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31787 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31788
31789
31790
31791 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31792 .cindex "case of local parts"
31793 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31794 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31795 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31796 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31797 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31798 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31799 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31800 router option.
31801
31802 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31803 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31804 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31805 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31806 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31807 .code
31808 correct_case:
31809 driver = redirect
31810 domains = +local_domains
31811 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31812 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31813 @$domain
31814 .endd
31815 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31816 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31817 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31818 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31819 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31820
31821
31822
31823 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31824 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31825 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31826 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31827 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31828 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31829 empty components for compatibility.
31830
31831
31832
31833 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31834 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31835 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31836 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31837 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31838 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31839
31840 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31841 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31842 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31843 example, a header such as
31844 .code
31845 To: hare@teaparty
31846 .endd
31847 might get rewritten as
31848 .code
31849 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31850 .endd
31851 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31852 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31853 been routed.
31854
31855 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31856 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31857 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31858 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31859 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31860 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31861 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31862
31863
31864
31865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31867
31868 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31869 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31870 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31871 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31872 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31873 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31874 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31875
31876 .ilist
31877 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31878 .next
31879 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31880 .next
31881 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31882 .endlist
31883
31884 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31885
31886 .ilist
31887 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31888 .next
31889 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31890 &"lmtp"&);
31891 .next
31892 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31893 transport);
31894 .next
31895 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31896 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31897 .endlist
31898
31899 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31900 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31901 used to contain the envelope information.
31902
31903
31904
31905 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31906 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31907 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31908 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31909 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31910 .cindex "EHLO"
31911 .cindex "HELO"
31912 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31913 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31914 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31915 processing is the same in both cases.
31916
31917 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31918 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31919 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31920 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31921 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31922 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31923 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31924 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31925 suppressed.
31926
31927 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31928 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31929 required for the transaction.
31930
31931 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31932 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31933 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31934 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
31935 is called for verification.
31936
31937 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31938 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31939 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31940
31941 .cindex "carriage return"
31942 .cindex "linefeed"
31943 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31944 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31945 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31946 line terminator.
31947
31948 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31949 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31950 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31951 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31952 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31953 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31954 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31955 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31956 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31957
31958 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31959 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31960 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31961 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31962
31963 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31964 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31965 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31966 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31967
31968 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31969 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31970 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31971 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31972 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31973 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31974 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31975 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31976 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31977 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31978
31979 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31980 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31981
31982 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31983 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31984 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31985 square bracket of the IP address.
31986
31987
31988
31989
31990 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31991 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31992 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31993 .cindex "host" "error"
31994 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31995 message errors, and recipient errors.
31996
31997 .vlist
31998 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31999 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32000 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32001
32002 .ilist
32003 Connection refused or timed out,
32004 .next
32005 Any error response code on connection,
32006 .next
32007 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32008 .next
32009 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32010 .next
32011 I/O errors at any time,
32012 .next
32013 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32014 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32015 .endlist ilist
32016
32017 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32018 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32019 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32020 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32021 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32022 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32023 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32024 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32025
32026 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32027 .cindex "message" "error"
32028 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32029 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32030 message errors are:
32031
32032 .ilist
32033 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32034 the data,
32035 .next
32036 Timeout after MAIL,
32037 .next
32038 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32039 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32040 connection at any other time.
32041 .endlist ilist
32042
32043 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32044 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32045 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32046 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32047 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32048 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32049 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32050 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32051 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32052 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32053
32054 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32055 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32056 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32057 response to MAIL.
32058
32059 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32060 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32061 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32062 recipient errors are:
32063
32064 .ilist
32065 Any error response to RCPT,
32066 .next
32067 Timeout after RCPT.
32068 .endlist
32069
32070 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32071 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32072 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32073 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32074 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32075 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32076 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32077 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32078 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32079 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32080 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32081 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32082 the retry clock is reset.
32083
32084 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32085 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32086 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32087 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32088 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32089 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32090 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32091 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32092 recipient's retry time.
32093 .endlist
32094
32095 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32096 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32097 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32098 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32099 until the next delivery attempt.
32100
32101 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32102 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32103 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32104 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32105 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32106 is created.
32107
32108 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32109 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32110 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32111 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32112 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32113 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32114 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32115
32116 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32117 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32118 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32119 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32120 then to be treated as a host error.
32121
32122 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32123 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32124 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32125 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32126 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32127
32128
32129
32130
32131 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32132 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32133 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32134 .cindex "inetd"
32135 .cindex "daemon"
32136 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32137 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32138 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32139 .code
32140 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32141 .endd
32142 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32143 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32144 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32145 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32146 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32147 stream and exits with an error code.
32148
32149 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32150 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32151 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32152 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32153
32154 .cindex "carriage return"
32155 .cindex "linefeed"
32156 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32157 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32158 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32159 line terminator.
32160 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32161 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32162 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32163
32164 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32165 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32166 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32167 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32168 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32169 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32170 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32171 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32172
32173 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32174 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32175 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32176 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32177 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32178 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32179 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32180 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32181 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32182
32183 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32184 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32185 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32186
32187 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32188 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32189 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32190 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32191 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32192
32193 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32194 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32195 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32196 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32197 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32198 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32199 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32200
32201 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32202 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32203 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32204 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32205 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32206
32207 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32208 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32209 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32210 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32211 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32212 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32213 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32214 a delivery process.
32215
32216 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32217 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32218 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32219 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32220 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32221
32222 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32223 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32224 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32225 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32226
32227 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32228 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32229 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32230
32231
32232
32233 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32234 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32235 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32236 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32237 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32238 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32239 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32240 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32241
32242
32243 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32244 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32245 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32246 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32247 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32248 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32249 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32250 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32251 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32252 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32253 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32254
32255
32256
32257 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32258 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32259 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32260 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32261 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32262 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32263 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32264 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32265
32266 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32267 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32268 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32269 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32270 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32271 counted.
32272
32273 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32274 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32275 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32276
32277 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32278 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32279 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32280 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32281 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32282
32283
32284
32285
32286 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32287 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32288 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32289 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32290 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32291
32292 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32293 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32294 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32295
32296 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32297 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32298 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32299 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32300 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32301 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32302 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32303 RCPT failures.
32304
32305
32306
32307 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32308 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32309 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32310 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32311 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32312 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32313 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32314
32315 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32316 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32317 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32318 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32319 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32320 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32321 argument. For example,
32322 .code
32323 ETRN #brigadoon
32324 .endd
32325 runs the command
32326 .code
32327 exim -R brigadoon
32328 .endd
32329 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32330 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32331 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32332 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32333 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32334
32335 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32336 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32337 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32338 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32339 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32340 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32341 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32342 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32343
32344 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32345 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32346 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32347 whatever the form of its argument. For
32348 example:
32349 .code
32350 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32351 $sender_host_address
32352 .endd
32353 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32354 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32355 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32356 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32357 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32358 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32359 for it to change them before running the command.
32360
32361
32362
32363 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32364 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32365 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32366 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32367 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32368 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32369 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32370 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32371 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32372 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32373 runs for RCPT commands:
32374 .code
32375 accept hosts = :
32376 .endd
32377 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32378
32379
32380
32381 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32382 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32383 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32384 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32385 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32386 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32387 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32388 envelope along with the message.
32389
32390 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32391 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32392 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32393 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32394 can be used to specify it.
32395
32396 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32397 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32398 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32399 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32400 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32401
32402 .vindex "&$host$&"
32403 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32404 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32405 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32406 router:
32407 .code
32408 begin routers
32409 route_append:
32410 driver = manualroute
32411 transport = smtp_appendfile
32412 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32413
32414 begin transports
32415 smtp_appendfile:
32416 driver = appendfile
32417 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32418 batch_max = 1000
32419 use_bsmtp
32420 user = exim
32421 .endd
32422 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32423 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32424 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32425
32426
32427
32428 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32429 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32430 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32431 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32432 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32433 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32434 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32435 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32436 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32437 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32438
32439 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32440 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32441
32442 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32443 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32444 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32445 make some use of automatically, for example:
32446 .code
32447 554 Unexpected end of file
32448 Transaction started in line 10
32449 Error detected in line 14
32450 .endd
32451 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32452 file, for example:
32453 .code
32454 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32455 The error message was:
32456
32457 501 '>' missing at end of address
32458
32459 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32460 The error was detected in line 12.
32461 The SMTP command at fault was:
32462
32463 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32464
32465 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32466 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32467 .endd
32468 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32469 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32470 accepted.
32471 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32472 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32473
32474
32475
32476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32478
32479 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32480 "Customizing messages"
32481 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32482 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32483 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32484 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32485 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32486
32487 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32488 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32489 option. Exim also adds the line
32490 .code
32491 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32492 .endd
32493 to all warning and bounce messages,
32494
32495
32496 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32497 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32498 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32499 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32500 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32501 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32502 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32503
32504 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32505 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32506 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32507 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32508 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32509 item.
32510
32511 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32512 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32513 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32514 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32515 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32516 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32517 option, rounded to a whole number.
32518
32519 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32520
32521 .ilist
32522 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32523 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32524 .next
32525 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32526 failing addresses with their error messages.
32527 .next
32528 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32529 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32530 .next
32531 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32532 as part of the error report.
32533 .next
32534 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32535 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32536 .next
32537 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32538 .endlist
32539
32540 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32541 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32542 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32543 .code
32544 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32545 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32546 {: returning message to sender}}
32547 ****
32548 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32549
32550 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32551 {that you sent }{sent by
32552
32553 <$sender_address>
32554
32555 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32556 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32557 ****
32558 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32559 ****
32560 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32561 ------
32562 ****
32563 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32564 only the first
32565 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32566 ****
32567 .endd
32568 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32569 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32570 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32571 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32572 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32573 text sections:
32574
32575 .ilist
32576 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32577 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32578 .next
32579 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32580 the delayed addresses.
32581 .next
32582 The third item then ends the message.
32583 .endlist
32584
32585 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32586 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32587 .code
32588 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32589 $warn_message_delay
32590 ****
32591 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32592
32593 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32594 {that you sent }{sent by
32595
32596 <$sender_address>
32597
32598 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32599 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32600
32601 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32602 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32603 The date of the message is: $h_date
32604
32605 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32606 ****
32607 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32608 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32609 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32610 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32611 the message will be returned to you.
32612 .endd
32613 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32614 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32615 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32616 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32617 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32618 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32619 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32620 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32621 handled them.
32622
32623
32624
32625
32626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32628
32629 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32630 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32631 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32632
32633
32634
32635 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32636 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32637 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32638 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32639 routing explicitly:
32640 .code
32641 send_to_smart_host:
32642 driver = manualroute
32643 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32644 transport = remote_smtp
32645 .endd
32646 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32647 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32648 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32649 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32650 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32651
32652
32653
32654
32655 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32656 .cindex "mailing lists"
32657 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32658 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32659 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32660
32661 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32662 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32663 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32664 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32665 .code
32666 lists:
32667 driver = redirect
32668 domains = lists.example
32669 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32670 forbid_pipe
32671 forbid_file
32672 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32673 no_more
32674 .endd
32675 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32676 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32677 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32678 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32679
32680 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32681 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32682 a mailing list.
32683
32684 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32685 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32686 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32687 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32688 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32689
32690 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32691 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32692 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32693 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32694 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32695 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32696 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32697 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32698 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32699
32700
32701
32702 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32703 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32704 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32705 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32706 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32707 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32708 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32709
32710 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32711 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32712 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32713 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32714 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32715
32716
32717
32718 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32719 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32720 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32721 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32722 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32723 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32724 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32725 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32726 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32727 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32728
32729 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32730 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32731 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32732 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32733 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32734 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32735 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32736 pre-existing messages.
32737
32738 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32739 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32740 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32741 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32742 one level of expansion anyway.
32743
32744
32745
32746 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32747 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32748 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32749 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32750 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32751 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32752
32753 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32754 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32755 .code
32756 lists_request:
32757 driver = redirect
32758 domains = lists.example
32759 local_part_suffix = -request
32760 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32761 no_more
32762
32763 lists_post:
32764 driver = redirect
32765 domains = lists.example
32766 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32767 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32768 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32769 forbid_pipe
32770 forbid_file
32771 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32772 no_more
32773
32774 lists_closed:
32775 driver = redirect
32776 domains = lists.example
32777 allow_fail
32778 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32779 .endd
32780 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32781 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32782 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32783 mailing list.
32784
32785 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32786 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32787 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32788 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32789 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32790 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32791 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32792 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32793 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32794
32795 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32796 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32797 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32798
32799
32800
32801
32802 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32803 .cindex "VERP"
32804 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32805 .cindex "envelope sender"
32806 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32807 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32808 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32809 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32810 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32811 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32812
32813 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32814 .oindex &%return_path%&
32815 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32816 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32817 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32818 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32819 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32820 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32821 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32822 .code
32823 verp_smtp:
32824 driver = smtp
32825 max_rcpt = 1
32826 return_path = \
32827 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32828 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32829 .endd
32830 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32831 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32832 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32833 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32834 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32835 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32836 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32837 rewritten as
32838 .code
32839 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32840 .endd
32841 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32842 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32843 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32844 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32845 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32846 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32847
32848 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32849 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32850 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32851 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32852 .code
32853 dnslookup:
32854 driver = dnslookup
32855 domains = ! +local_domains
32856 transport = \
32857 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32858 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32859 no_more
32860 .endd
32861 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32862 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32863 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32864 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32865 address.
32866
32867 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32868 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32869 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32870 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32871 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32872 .code
32873 verp_dnslookup:
32874 driver = dnslookup
32875 domains = ! +local_domains
32876 transport = remote_smtp
32877 errors_to = \
32878 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32879 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32880 no_more
32881 .endd
32882 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32883 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32884 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32885 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32886 them.
32887
32888 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32889 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32890 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32891 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32892 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32893 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32894 used).
32895
32896
32897
32898
32899
32900
32901 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32902 .cindex "virtual domains"
32903 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32904 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32905 meanings:
32906
32907 .ilist
32908 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32909 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32910 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32911 .next
32912 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32913 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32914 have login accounts on that host.
32915 .endlist
32916
32917 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32918 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32919 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32920 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32921 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32922 to a router of this form:
32923 .code
32924 virtual:
32925 driver = redirect
32926 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32927 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32928 no_more
32929 .endd
32930 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32931 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32932 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32933 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32934 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32935 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32936
32937 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32938 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32939 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32940 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32941
32942 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32943 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32944 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32945 .code
32946 my_domains:
32947 driver = accept
32948 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32949 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32950 transport = my_mailboxes
32951 .endd
32952 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32953 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32954 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32955 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32956 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32957 follows:
32958 .code
32959 my_mailboxes:
32960 driver = appendfile
32961 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32962 user = mail
32963 .endd
32964 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32965 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32966
32967 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32968 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32969 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32970 information about the domains.
32971
32972
32973
32974 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32975 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32976 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32977 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32978 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32979 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32980 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32981 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32982 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32983 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32984 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32985 example, consider this router:
32986 .code
32987 userforward:
32988 driver = redirect
32989 check_local_user
32990 file = $home/.forward
32991 local_part_suffix = -*
32992 local_part_suffix_optional
32993 allow_filter
32994 .endd
32995 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32996 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32997 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32998 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32999 .code
33000 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33001 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33002 endif
33003 .endd
33004 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33005 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33006 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33007 control over which suffixes are valid.
33008
33009 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33010 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33011 another MTA:
33012 .code
33013 userforward:
33014 driver = redirect
33015 check_local_user
33016 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33017 local_part_suffix = -*
33018 local_part_suffix_optional
33019 allow_filter
33020 .endd
33021 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33022 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33023 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33024 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33025 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33026
33027
33028
33029 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33030 .cindex "vacation processing"
33031 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33032 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33033 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33034 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33035 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33036
33037 .ilist
33038 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33039 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33040 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33041 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33042 .code
33043 spqr, vacation-spqr
33044 .endd
33045 .next
33046 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33047 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33048 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33049 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33050 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33051 message.
33052 .endlist
33053
33054 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33055 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33056
33057
33058
33059 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33060 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33061 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33062 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33063 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33064 each day's messages.
33065
33066 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33067 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33068 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33069 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33070
33071
33072
33073 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33074 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33075 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33076 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33077 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33078 permanently connected.
33079
33080 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33081 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33082 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33083
33084
33085 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33086 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33087 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33088 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33089 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33090 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33091 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33092 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33093
33094 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33095 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33096 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33097 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33098 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33099 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33100 if required.
33101
33102 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33103 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33104 intermittent host. For example:
33105 .code
33106 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33107 .endd
33108 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33109 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33110 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33111 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33112 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33113 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33114 immediately.
33115
33116 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33117 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33118 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33119 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33120 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33121 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33122 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33123
33124
33125
33126 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33127 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33128 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33129 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33130 delivered immediately.
33131
33132 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33133 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33134 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33135 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33136 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33137 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33138 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33139 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33140 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33141 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33142 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33143 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33144 single SMTP connection.
33145
33146
33147
33148 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33150
33151 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33152 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33153 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
33154 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33155 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33156 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33157 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33158 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33159 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33160 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33161 messages this way.
33162
33163 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33164 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33165 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33166 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33167 email is not desirable.
33168
33169 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33170 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33171 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33172 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33173 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33174 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33175 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33176
33177 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33178 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33179 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33180 before sending a message to the smart host.
33181
33182 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33183 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33184 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33185
33186 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33187 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33188 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33189 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33190 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33191 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33192 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33193
33194 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33195 following ways:
33196
33197 .ilist
33198 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33199 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33200 .next
33201 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33202 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33203 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33204 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33205 successful, a zero return code is given.
33206 .next
33207 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33208 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33209 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33210 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33211 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33212 are.
33213 .next
33214 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33215 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33216 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33217 .next
33218 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33219 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33220 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33221 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33222 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33223 .next
33224 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33225 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33226 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33227 .next
33228 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33229 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33230 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33231 are ever generated.
33232 .next
33233 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33234 .next
33235 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33236 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33237 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33238 .endlist
33239
33240 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33241 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33242 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33243 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33244 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33245 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33246
33247
33248
33249
33250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33251 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33252
33253 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33254 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33255 .cindex "log" "types of"
33256 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33257 and the panic log:
33258
33259 .ilist
33260 .cindex "main log"
33261 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33262 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33263 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33264 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33265 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33266 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33267 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33268 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33269 .next
33270 .cindex "reject log"
33271 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33272 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33273 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33274 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33275 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33276 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33277 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33278 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33279 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33280 false.
33281 .next
33282 .cindex "panic log"
33283 .cindex "system log"
33284 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33285 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33286 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33287 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33288 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33289 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33290 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33291 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33292 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33293 .endlist
33294
33295 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33296 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33297 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33298 .code
33299 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33300 by QUIT
33301 .endd
33302 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33303 ways of changing this:
33304
33305 .ilist
33306 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33307 you set
33308 .code
33309 timezone = UTC
33310 .endd
33311 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33312 .next
33313 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33314 example:
33315 .code
33316 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33317 .endd
33318 .endlist
33319
33320 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33321 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33322 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33323 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33324 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33325 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33326
33327
33328
33329
33330 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33331 .cindex "log" "destination"
33332 .cindex "log" "to file"
33333 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33334 .cindex "syslog"
33335 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33336 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33337 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33338 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33339 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33340 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33341 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33342
33343 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33344 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33345 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33346 references to the host name:
33347 .code
33348 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33349 .endd
33350 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33351 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33352 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33353 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33354 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33355 log at all.
33356
33357 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33358 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33359 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33360 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33361 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33362 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33363 implying the use of a default path.
33364
33365 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33366 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33367 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33368 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33369 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33370 equivalent to the setting:
33371 .code
33372 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33373 .endd
33374 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33375 logs are written.
33376
33377 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33378 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33379
33380 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33381 .display
33382 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33383 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33384 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33385 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33386 .endd
33387 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33388 error is logged.
33389
33390
33391
33392 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33393 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33394 .cindex "cycling logs"
33395 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33396 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33397 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33398 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33399 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33400 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33401 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33402
33403 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33404 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33405 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33406 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33407 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33408 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33409 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33410 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33411 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33412 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33413 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33414 renamed.
33415
33416
33417
33418 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33419 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33420 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33421 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33422 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33423 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33424 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33425 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33426 .code
33427 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33428 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33429 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33430 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33431 .endd
33432 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33433 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33434 .code
33435 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33436 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33437 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33438 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33439 .endd
33440 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33441 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33442 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33443 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33444
33445 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33446 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33447 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33448 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33449 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33450 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33451 log names:
33452 .code
33453 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33454 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33455 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33456 /var/log/exim/panic
33457 .endd
33458
33459
33460 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33461 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33462 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33463 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33464 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33465 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33466 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33467 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33468 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33469 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33470 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33471 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33472 the time and host name to each line.
33473 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33474
33475 .ilist
33476 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33477 .next
33478 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33479 .next
33480 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33481 .endlist
33482
33483 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33484 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33485 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33486 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33487
33488 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33489 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33490 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33491 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33492 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33493 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33494 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33495 RFC 3164, you should set
33496 .code
33497 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33498 .endd
33499 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33500 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33501
33502 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33503 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33504 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33505 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33506 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33507 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33508 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33509 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33510 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33511 .code
33512 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33513 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33514 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33515 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33516 [5/5] mple>)
33517 .endd
33518 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33519 (LOG_NOTICE):
33520 .code
33521 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33522 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33523 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33524 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33525 [5\18] .example>)
33526 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33527 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33528 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33529 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33530 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33531 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33532 [12\18] F From: <>
33533 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33534 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33535 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33536 [16\18] le>
33537 [17\18] B Bcc:
33538 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33539 .endd
33540 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33541 without modification.
33542
33543 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33544 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33545 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33546 where it is.
33547
33548
33549
33550 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33551 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33552 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33553 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33554 timestamp. The flags are:
33555 .display
33556 &`<=`& message arrival
33557 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33558 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33559 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
33560 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33561 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33562 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33563 .endd
33564
33565
33566 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33567 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33568 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33569 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33570 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33571 .code
33572 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33573 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33574 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33575 .endd
33576 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33577 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33578 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33579 .code
33580 R=<message id>
33581 .endd
33582 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33583
33584 .cindex "HELO"
33585 .cindex "EHLO"
33586 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33587 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33588 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33589 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33590 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33591 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33592 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33593 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33594 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33595 name in parentheses.
33596
33597 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33598 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33599 the log containing text like these examples:
33600 .code
33601 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33602 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33603 .endd
33604 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33605 on.
33606
33607 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33608 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33609 of Exim.
33610
33611 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33612 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33613 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33614 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33615 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33616 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33617 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33618 suite that was used.
33619
33620 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33621 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33622 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33623 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33624 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33625 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33626 authenticator name.
33627
33628 .cindex "size" "of message"
33629 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33630 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33631 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33632 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33633 other).
33634
33635 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33636 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33637
33638
33639
33640 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33641 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33642 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33643 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33644 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33645 to fit it on the page:
33646 .code
33647 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33648 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33649 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33650 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33651 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33652 .endd
33653 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33654 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33655 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33656 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33657 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33658
33659 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
33660 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
33661 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
33662 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
33663
33664 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33665 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33666 .display
33667 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33668 .endd
33669 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33670 parentheses afterwards.
33671
33672 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33673 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33674 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33675 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33676 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33677 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33678
33679 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
33680 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
33681 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
33682 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
33683 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
33684
33685 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33686 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33687
33688 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33689 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33690
33691
33692 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33693 .cindex "discarded messages"
33694 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33695 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33696 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33697 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33698 .code
33699 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33700 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33701 .endd
33702 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33703 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33704 .code
33705 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33706 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33707 .endd
33708
33709
33710 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33711 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33712 .code
33713 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33714 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33715 .endd
33716 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33717 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33718 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33719 .code
33720 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33721 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33722 .endd
33723 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33724 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33725 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33726
33727
33728
33729 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33730 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33731 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33732 following form is logged:
33733 .code
33734 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33735 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33736 .endd
33737 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33738 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33739 .code
33740 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33741 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33742 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33743 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33744 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33745 .endd
33746 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33747 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33748 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33749 flagged with &`**`&.
33750
33751
33752
33753 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33754 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33755 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33756 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33757 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33758
33759
33760
33761 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33762 A line of the form
33763 .code
33764 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33765 .endd
33766 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33767 at the end of its processing.
33768
33769
33770
33771
33772 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33773 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33774 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33775 the following table:
33776 .display
33777 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
33778 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33779 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33780 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33781 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33782 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33783 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33784 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33785 &`H `& host name and IP address
33786 &`I `& local interface used
33787 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33788 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33789 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33790 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33791 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33792 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33793 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33794 &`S `& size of message
33795 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33796 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33797 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33798 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33799 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33800 .endd
33801
33802
33803 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33804 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33805 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33806
33807 .ilist
33808 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33809 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33810 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33811 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33812 during the first delivery attempt.
33813 .next
33814 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33815 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33816 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33817 .next
33818 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33819 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33820 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33821 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33822 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33823 doing.
33824 .next
33825 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33826 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33827 message:
33828 .olist
33829 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33830 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33831 .next
33832 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33833 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33834 .next
33835 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33836 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33837 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33838 .code
33839 errors_to = <>
33840 .endd
33841 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33842 .endlist olist
33843 .endlist ilist
33844
33845
33846
33847
33848
33849 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33850 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33851 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33852 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33853 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33854 example:
33855 .code
33856 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33857 .endd
33858 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33859 selection marked by asterisks:
33860 .display
33861 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
33862 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33863 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33864 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33865 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33866 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33867 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33868 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33869 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33870 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33871 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33872 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33873 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33874 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33875 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33876 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33877 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33878 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33879 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33880 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33881 &` pid `& Exim process id
33882 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33883 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33884 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33885 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33886 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33887 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33888 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33889 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33890 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33891 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33892 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33893 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33894 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
33895 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33896 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33897 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33898 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33899 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33900 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33901 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33902 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33903 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33904
33905 &` all `& all of the above
33906 .endd
33907 More details on each of these items follows:
33908
33909 .ilist
33910 .cindex "8BITMIME"
33911 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
33912 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
33913 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
33914 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
33915 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
33916 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
33917 .next
33918 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33919 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33920 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33921 this log selector is set.
33922 .next
33923 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33924 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33925 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33926 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33927 such users cannot access the log).
33928 .next
33929 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33930 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33931 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33932 parentheses between them.
33933 .next
33934 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33935 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33936 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33937 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33938 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33939 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33940 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33941 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33942 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33943 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33944 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33945 between the caller and Exim.
33946 .next
33947 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33948 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33949 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33950 .next
33951 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33952 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33953 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33954 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33955 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33956 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33957 .next
33958 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33959 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33960 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33961 .next
33962 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33963 .cindex "size" "of message"
33964 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33965 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33966 .next
33967 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33968 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33969 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33970 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33971 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33972 .next
33973 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33974 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33975 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33976 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33977 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33978 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33979 .next
33980 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33981 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33982 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33983 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33984 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33985 .next
33986 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33987 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33988 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33989 client's ident port times out.
33990 .next
33991 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33992 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33993 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33994 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33995 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33996 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33997 rejection lines.
33998 .next
33999 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34000 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34001 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34002 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34003 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34004 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34005 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34006 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34007 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34008 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34009 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34010 .next
34011 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34012 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34013 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34014 .next
34015 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34016 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34017 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34018 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34019 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34020 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34021 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34022 .next
34023 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34024 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34025 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34026 immediately after the time and date.
34027 .next
34028 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34029 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34030 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34031 .next
34032 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34033 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34034 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34035 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34036 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34037 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34038 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34039 message has been successfully received.
34040 .next
34041 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34042 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34043 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34044 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34045 .next
34046 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34047 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34048 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34049 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34050 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34051 has taken place.
34052 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34053 in the list.
34054 .next
34055 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34056 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34057 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34058 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34059 .next
34060 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34061 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34062 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34063 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34064 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34065 .next
34066 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34067 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34068 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34069 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34070 attempt.
34071 .next
34072 .cindex "log" "return path"
34073 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34074 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34075 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34076 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34077 .next
34078 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34079 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34080 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34081 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34082 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34083 .next
34084 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34085 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34086 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34087 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34088 detail is lost.
34089 .next
34090 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34091 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34092 it is too big.
34093 .next
34094 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34095 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34096 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34097 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34098 it.
34099 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34100 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34101 .next
34102 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34103 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34104 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
34105 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34106 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34107 response.
34108 .next
34109 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34110 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34111 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34112 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34113 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34114 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34115 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34116 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34117 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34118 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34119
34120 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34121 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34122 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34123 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34124 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34125 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34126 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34127 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34128 .next
34129 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34130 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34131 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34132 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34133 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34134 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34135 .next
34136 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34137 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34138 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34139 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34140 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34141 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34142 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34143 already have their own log lines.
34144
34145 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34146 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34147 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34148 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34149 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34150 the same logging options.
34151
34152 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34153 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34154 .code
34155 C=EHLO,QUIT
34156 .endd
34157 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34158 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34159 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34160 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34161 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34162 .next
34163 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34164 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34165 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34166 was accepted or used.
34167 .next
34168 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34169 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34170 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34171 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34172 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34173 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34174 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34175 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34176 .next
34177 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34178 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34179 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34180 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34181 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34182 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34183 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34184 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34185 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34186 .next
34187 .cindex "log" "subject"
34188 .cindex "subject, logging"
34189 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34190 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34191 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34192 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34193 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34194 .next
34195 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34196 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34197 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34198 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34199 .next
34200 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34201 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34202 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34203 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34204 .next
34205 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34206 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34207 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34208 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34209 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34210 .next
34211 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34212 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34213 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34214 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34215 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34216 .next
34217 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34218 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34219 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34220 .endlist
34221
34222
34223 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34224 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34225 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34226 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34227 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34228 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34229 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34230 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34231 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34232 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34233 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34234 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34235 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34236
34237 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34238 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34239 &%message_logs%& option false.
34240 .ecindex IIDloggen
34241
34242
34243
34244
34245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34247
34248 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34249 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34250 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34251 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34252 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34253
34254 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34255 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34256 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34257 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34258 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34259 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34260 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34261 various criteria"
34262 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34263 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34264 "extract statistics from the log"
34265 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34266 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34267 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34268 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34269 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34270 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34271 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34272 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34273 .endtable
34274
34275 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34276 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34277 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34278
34279
34280
34281
34282 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34283 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34284 .cindex "process, querying"
34285 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
34286 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34287 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34288 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34289 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34290 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34291 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34292 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34293 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34294
34295 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34296 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34297 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34298
34299
34300 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34301 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34302 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34303 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34304 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34305 options:
34306 .display
34307 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34308 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34309 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34310 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34311 .endd
34312 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34313 .code
34314 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34315 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34316 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34317 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34318 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34319 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34320 .endd
34321 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34322 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34323
34324
34325
34326 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34327 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34328 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34329 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34330 .code
34331 exim -bpu
34332 .endd
34333 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34334 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34335 options are available:
34336
34337 .vlist
34338 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34339 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
34340 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34341 .code
34342 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
34343 .endd
34344 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34345 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
34346 brackets.
34347
34348 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34349 Match against the size field.
34350
34351 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34352 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34353
34354 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34355 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34356
34357 .vitem &*-z*&
34358 Match only frozen messages.
34359
34360 .vitem &*-x*&
34361 Match only non-frozen messages.
34362 .endlist
34363
34364 The following options control the format of the output:
34365
34366 .vlist
34367 .vitem &*-c*&
34368 Display only the count of matching messages.
34369
34370 .vitem &*-l*&
34371 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34372 the default.
34373
34374 .vitem &*-i*&
34375 Display message ids only.
34376
34377 .vitem &*-b*&
34378 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34379
34380 .vitem &*-R*&
34381 Display messages in reverse order.
34382 .endlist
34383
34384 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34385
34386
34387
34388 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34389 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34390 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34391 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34392 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34393 running a command such as
34394 .code
34395 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34396 .endd
34397 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34398 it, as in the following example:
34399 .code
34400 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34401 .endd
34402 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34403 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34404 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34405 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34406
34407 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34408 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34409 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34410 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34411 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34412 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34413 sender.
34414
34415 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34416 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34417 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34418 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34419 level"& addresses).
34420
34421
34422
34423
34424 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34425 "SECTextspeinf"
34426 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34427 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34428 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34429 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34430 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34431 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34432 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34433 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34434 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34435 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34436 .display
34437 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34438 .endd
34439 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34440
34441 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34442 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34443 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34444
34445 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34446 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34447 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34448 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34449 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34450
34451 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34452 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34453 regular expression.
34454
34455 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34456 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34457
34458 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34459 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34460 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34461
34462
34463 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34464 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34465 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34466 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34467 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34468 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34469 the &%--help%& option.
34470
34471
34472 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34473 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34474 .cindex "cycling logs"
34475 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34476 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34477 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34478 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34479 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34480 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34481 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34482 .ilist
34483 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34484 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34485 .next
34486 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34487 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34488 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34489 configuration.
34490 .endlist
34491
34492 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34493 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34494 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34495 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34496 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34497 logs are handled similarly.
34498
34499 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34500 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34501 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34502 any existing log files.
34503
34504 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34505 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34506 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34507 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34508 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34509 .code
34510 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34511 .endd
34512 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34513 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34514
34515
34516
34517 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34518 .cindex "statistics"
34519 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34520 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34521 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34522 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34523 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34524
34525 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34526 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34527 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34528 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34529 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34530 .code
34531 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34532 .endd
34533 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34534 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34535 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34536 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34537 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34538 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34539 also produced per user.
34540
34541 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34542 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34543 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34544 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34545 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34546
34547 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34548 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34549 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34550 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34551 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34552 an entirely separate message.
34553
34554 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34555 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34556 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34557 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34558 least one address that failed.
34559
34560 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34561 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34562 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34563 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34564 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34565 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34566 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34567
34568 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34569 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34570 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34571
34572 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34573 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34574 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34575 .code
34576 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34577 .endd
34578
34579 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34580 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34581 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34582 .cindex "checking access"
34583 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34584 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34585 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34586 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34587 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34588 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34589
34590 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34591 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34592 .code
34593 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34594 .endd
34595 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34596 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34597 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34598 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34599 .code
34600 Rejected:
34601 550 Relay not permitted
34602 .endd
34603 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34604 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34605 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34606 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34607 you can use:
34608 .code
34609 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34610 -f himself@there.example
34611 .endd
34612 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34613 mandatory arguments.
34614
34615 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34616 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34617 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34618
34619
34620
34621 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34622 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34623 .cindex "building DBM files"
34624 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34625 .cindex "lower casing"
34626 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34627 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34628 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34629 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34630 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34631 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34632
34633 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34634 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34635 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34636 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34637 files.
34638
34639 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34640 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34641 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34642 well.
34643
34644 .cindex "USE_DB"
34645 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34646 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34647 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34648 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34649 .code
34650 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34651 .endd
34652 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34653 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34654
34655 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34656 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34657 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34658 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34659 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34660 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34661
34662 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34663 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34664 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34665 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34666 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34667 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34668 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34669 return code is 2.
34670
34671
34672
34673
34674 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34675 .cindex "retry" "times"
34676 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34677 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34678 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34679 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34680 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34681 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34682 output. For example:
34683 .code
34684 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34685 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34686 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34687 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34688 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34689 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34690 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34691 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34692 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34693 past final cutoff time
34694 .endd
34695 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34696 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34697 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34698 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34699 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34700 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34701 run very often.
34702
34703 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34704 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34705 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34706 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34707 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34708 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34709
34710
34711
34712 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34713 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34714 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34715 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34716 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34717 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34718 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34719
34720 .ilist
34721 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34722 .next
34723 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34724 for remote hosts
34725 .next
34726 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34727 .next
34728 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34729 .next
34730 &'misc'&: other hints data
34731 .endlist
34732
34733 The &'misc'& database is used for
34734
34735 .ilist
34736 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34737 .next
34738 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34739 &(smtp)& transport)
34740 .endlist
34741
34742
34743
34744 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34745 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34746 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34747 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34748 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34749 .code
34750 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34751 .endd
34752 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34753 .code
34754 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34755 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34756 .endd
34757 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34758 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34759 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34760 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34761 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34762 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34763 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34764 and a textual description of the error.
34765
34766 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34767 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34768 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34769 exceeded.
34770
34771 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34772 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34773 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34774 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34775 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34776 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34777 cross-references.
34778
34779
34780
34781 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34782 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34783 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34784 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34785 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34786 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34787 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34788 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34789 updated sufficiently often.
34790
34791 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34792 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34793 the retry database:
34794 .code
34795 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34796 .endd
34797 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34798 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34799 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34800 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34801 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34802 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34803 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34804 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34805 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34806 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34807 whenever it removes information from the database.
34808
34809 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34810 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34811 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34812 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34813 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34814
34815 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34816 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34817 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34818 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34819 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34820 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34821 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34822 tidied.
34823
34824 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34825 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34826
34827
34828
34829
34830 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34831 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34832 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34833 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34834 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34835 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34836 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34837 displayed.
34838
34839 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34840 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34841 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34842 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34843 by new data, for example:
34844 .code
34845 > 4 951102:1000
34846 .endd
34847 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34848 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34849 used as optional separators.
34850
34851
34852
34853
34854 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34855 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34856 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34857 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34858 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34859 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34860 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34861 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34862 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34863 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34864 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34865 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34866 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34867
34868 .vlist
34869 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
34870 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34871
34872 .vitem &%-flock%&
34873 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34874 supports it.
34875
34876 .vitem &%-interval%&
34877 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34878 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34879
34880 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34881 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34882
34883 .vitem &%-mbx%&
34884 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34885
34886 .vitem &%-q%&
34887 Suppress verification output.
34888
34889 .vitem &%-retries%&
34890 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34891 the lock (default 10).
34892
34893 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34894 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34895 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34896 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34897 subsequently sees.
34898
34899 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34900 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34901 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34902 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34903
34904 .vitem &%-v%&
34905 Generate verbose output.
34906 .endlist
34907
34908 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34909 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34910 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34911 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34912 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34913 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34914 more than 30 minutes old.
34915
34916 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34917 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34918 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34919 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34920 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34921 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34922
34923 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34924 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34925 suppresses all output except error messages.
34926
34927 A command such as
34928 .code
34929 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34930 .endd
34931 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34932 .display
34933 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34934 <&'some commands'&>
34935 &`End`&
34936 .endd
34937 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34938 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34939 such as
34940 .code
34941 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34942 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34943 .endd
34944 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34945 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34946 .ecindex IIDutils
34947
34948
34949 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34951
34952 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34953 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34954 .cindex "X-windows"
34955 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34956 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34957 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34958 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34959 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34960 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34961 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34962 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34963
34964
34965
34966 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34967 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34968 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34969 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34970 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34971 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34972 parameters are for.
34973
34974 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34975 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34976 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34977 .code
34978 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34979 .endd
34980 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34981 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34982 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34983 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34984 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34985
34986 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34987 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34988 .code
34989 Eximon*background: gray94
34990 .endd
34991 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34992 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34993 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34994 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34995 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34996 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34997 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34998 .code
34999 xrdb -merge <<End
35000 Eximon*highlight: gray
35001 End
35002 .endd
35003 .cindex "admin user"
35004 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35005 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35006
35007 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35008 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35009 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35010 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35011 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35012
35013 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35014 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35015 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35016 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35017 different parts of the display.
35018
35019
35020
35021
35022 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35023 .cindex "stripchart"
35024 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35025 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35026 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35027 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35028 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35029 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35030 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35031 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35032 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35033
35034 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35035 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35036 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35037 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35038
35039 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35040 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35041 to a single partition.
35042
35043 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35044 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35045 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35046 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35047 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35048 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35049 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35050
35051
35052
35053
35054 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35055 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35056 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35057 .cindex "window size"
35058 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35059 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35060 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35061 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35062 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35063 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35064
35065 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35066 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35067 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35068 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35069
35070 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35071 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35072 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35073 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35074 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35075 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35076
35077 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35078 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35079 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35080
35081
35082
35083 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35084 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35085 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35086 the main log is maintained.
35087 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35088 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35089 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35090 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35091 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35092
35093 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35094 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35095 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35096 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35097 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35098 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35099 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35100 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35101 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35102 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35103 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35104
35105 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35106 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35107 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35108 It cannot go further back up the log.
35109
35110 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35111 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35112 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35113 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35114 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35115 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35116
35117 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35118 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35119 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35120 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35121 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35122 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35123
35124 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35125 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35126 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35127 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35128 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35129 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35130 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35131 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35132 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35133 window.
35134
35135
35136
35137 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35138 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35139 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35140 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35141 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35142 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35143 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35144 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35145 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35146 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35147
35148 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35149 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35150 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35151 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35152 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35153 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35154 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35155
35156 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35157 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35158 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35159 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35160 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35161 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35162 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35163
35164 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35165 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35166 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35167 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35168
35169 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35170 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35171 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35172 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35173 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35174 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35175 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35176 not shown.
35177
35178 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35179 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35180
35181 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35182 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35183 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35184 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35185 display is updated.
35186
35187
35188
35189 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35190 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35191 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35192 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35193 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35194 any selected text.
35195
35196 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35197 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35198 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35199 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35200 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35201 .code
35202 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35203 .endd
35204 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35205 follows:
35206
35207 .ilist
35208 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35209 in a new text window.
35210 .next
35211 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35212 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35213 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35214 .next
35215 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35216 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35217 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35218 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35219 .next
35220 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35221 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35222 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35223 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35224 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35225 .next
35226 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35227 that the message be frozen.
35228 .next
35229 .cindex "thawing messages"
35230 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35231 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35232 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35233 that the message be thawed.
35234 .next
35235 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35236 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35237 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35238 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35239 .next
35240 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35241 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35242 message.
35243 .next
35244 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35245 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35246 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35247 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35248 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35249 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35250 which case no action is taken.
35251 .next
35252 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35253 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35254 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35255 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35256 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35257 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35258 case no action is taken.
35259 .next
35260 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35261 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35262 .next
35263 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35264 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35265 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35266 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35267 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35268 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35269 the address is qualified with that domain.
35270 .endlist
35271
35272 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35273 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35274 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35275 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35276 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35277 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35278 if no output is generated.
35279
35280 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35281 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35282 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35283 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35284
35285 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35286 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35287 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35288 .ecindex IIDeximon
35289
35290
35291
35292
35293
35294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35295 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35296
35297 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35298 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35299 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35300 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35301
35302 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35303 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35304 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35305 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35306 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35307 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35308
35309 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35310 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35311 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35312 as soon as possible.
35313
35314
35315 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35316 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35317 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35318 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35319 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35320 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35321
35322 .ilist
35323 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35324 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35325 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35326 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35327 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35328 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35329
35330 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35331 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35332 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35333 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35334 .next
35335
35336 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35337 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35338 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35339 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35340 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35341 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35342 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35343 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35344 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35345 separate commands.
35346
35347 .next
35348 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35349 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35350 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35351 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35352 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35353 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35354 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35355 .next
35356 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35357 is disabled.
35358 .next
35359 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35360 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35361 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35362 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35363 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35364 .endlist
35365
35366
35367
35368 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35369 .cindex "setuid"
35370 .cindex "root privilege"
35371 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35372 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35373 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35374 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35375 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35376 is required for two things:
35377
35378 .ilist
35379 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35380 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35381 not required.
35382 .next
35383 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35384 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35385 configuration.
35386 .endlist
35387
35388 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35389 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35390 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35391 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35392 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35393 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35394 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35395 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35396
35397 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35398 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35399 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35400
35401 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35402 uid and gid in the following cases:
35403
35404 .ilist
35405 .oindex "&%-C%&"
35406 .oindex "&%-D%&"
35407 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35408 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35409 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35410 the calling process.
35411 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35412 option may not be used at all.
35413 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35414 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35415 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35416 .next
35417 .oindex "&%-be%&"
35418 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
35419 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
35420 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35421 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35422 calling process.
35423 .next
35424 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35425 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35426 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35427 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35428 testing address verification
35429 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
35430 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
35431 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35432 option).
35433 .next
35434 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35435 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35436 .endlist
35437
35438 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35439
35440 .ilist
35441 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35442 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35443 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35444 will be used during message reception.
35445 .next
35446 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35447 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35448 .next
35449 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35450 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35451 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35452 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35453 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35454 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35455 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35456 generating bounce and warning messages.
35457
35458 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35459 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35460 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35461 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35462 .next
35463 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35464 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35465 .endlist
35466
35467
35468
35469
35470 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35471 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35472 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35473 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35474 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35475 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35476 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35477 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35478 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35479 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35480 to any other uid.
35481
35482 .cindex SIGHUP
35483 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35484 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35485 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35486 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35487
35488 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35489 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35490 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35491 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35492 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35493
35494 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35495 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35496 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35497 effect.
35498
35499 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35500 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35501 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35502
35503 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35504 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35505 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35506 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35507 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35508 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35509 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35510 address this problem at this time.
35511
35512 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35513 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35514 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35515 be used in the most straightforward way.
35516
35517 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35518 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35519
35520 .ilist
35521 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35522 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35523 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35524 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35525 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35526 .next
35527 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35528 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35529 .next
35530 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35531 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35532 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35533 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35534 .next
35535 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35536 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35537
35538 .olist
35539 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35540 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35541 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35542 .next
35543 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35544 owned by the Exim user.
35545 .next
35546 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35547 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35548 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35549 .endlist olist
35550 .endlist ilist
35551
35552
35553 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35554 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35555 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35556 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35557
35558 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35559 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35560
35561
35562
35563
35564 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35565 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35566 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35567
35568
35569
35570 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35571 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35572 .cindex "IP source routing"
35573 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35574 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35575 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35576 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35577
35578
35579
35580 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35581 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35582 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35583
35584
35585
35586
35587 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35588 .cindex "trusted users"
35589 .cindex "admin user"
35590 .cindex "privileged user"
35591 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35592 .cindex "user" "admin"
35593 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35594 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35595 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35596 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35597 permit a remote host to be specified.
35598
35599 .oindex "&%-f%&"
35600 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35601 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35602 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35603 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35604 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35605 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35606
35607 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35608 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35609 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35610 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35611 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35612
35613 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35614 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35615 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35616 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35617 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35618
35619 .oindex "&%-M%&"
35620 .oindex "&%-q%&"
35621 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35622 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35623 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35624 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35625 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35626 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35627
35628 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35629 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35630 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35631 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35632 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35633 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35634 files.
35635
35636
35637
35638 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35639 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35640 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35641 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35642 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35643 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35644
35645
35646
35647 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35648 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35649 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35650 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35651 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35652 this.
35653
35654
35655
35656 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35657 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35658 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35659 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35660 converted output.
35661
35662
35663
35664 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35665 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35666 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35667 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35668 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35669
35670
35671
35672 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35673 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35674 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35675 loading it.
35676
35677
35678 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35679 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35680 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35681 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35682 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35683 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35684 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35685
35686 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35687 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35688 string.
35689
35690
35691
35692 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35693 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35694 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35695 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35696
35697
35698
35699 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35700 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35701 enough to hold the result.
35702 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35703
35704
35705
35706
35707 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35709
35710 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35711 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35712 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35713 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35714 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35715 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35716 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35717 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35718 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35719 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35720 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35721 themselves are recoverable.
35722
35723 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35724 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35725 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35726
35727 .ilist
35728 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35729 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35730 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35731 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35732 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35733 .next
35734 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35735 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35736 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35737 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35738 will always be the case.
35739 .next
35740 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35741 .next
35742 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35743 signature.
35744 .endlist
35745 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35746
35747 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35748 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35749 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35750 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35751 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35752 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35753 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35754 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35755 attempt.
35756
35757 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35758 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35759 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35760 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35761 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35762 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35763 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35764 normally the Exim user.
35765
35766 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35767 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35768 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35769 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35770 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35771 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35772 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35773 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35774
35775 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35776 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35777 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35778 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35779
35780 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35781 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35782
35783 .vlist
35784 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35785 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35786 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35787 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35788 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35789 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35790 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35791 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35792 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35793 newlines.
35794
35795 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35796 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35797 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35798 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35799 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35800 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35801
35802 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35803 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35804 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35805 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35806 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35807 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35808
35809 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35810 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35811 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35812
35813 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35814 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35815 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35816 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35817 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35818
35819 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35820 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35821 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35822 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35823 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35824
35825 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35826 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35827 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35828
35829 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35830 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35831 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35832
35833 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35834 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35835 present.
35836
35837 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35838 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35839 present if the number is greater than zero.
35840
35841 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35842 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35843 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35844
35845 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35846 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35847 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35848
35849 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35850 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35851 command.
35852
35853 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35854 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35855 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35856 messages.
35857
35858 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35859 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35860 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35861 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35862
35863 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35864 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35865 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35866
35867 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35868 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35869 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35870 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35871 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35872 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35873
35874 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35875 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35876 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35877 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35878 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35879
35880 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35881 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35882 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35883 generated messages.
35884
35885 .vitem &%-local%&
35886 The message is from a local sender.
35887
35888 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35889 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35890
35891 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35892 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35893 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35894 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35895
35896 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35897 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35898 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35899
35900 .vitem &%-N%&
35901 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35902 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35903 &%-N%& is assumed.
35904
35905 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35906 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35907 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35908
35909 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35910 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35911 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35912
35913 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35914 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35915 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35916
35917 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35918 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35919 certificate was verified by the server.
35920
35921 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35922 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35923 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35924
35925 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35926 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35927 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35928 certificate.
35929 .endlist
35930
35931 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35932 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35933 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35934 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35935 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35936 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35937 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35938 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35939 addresses are complete.
35940
35941 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35942 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35943 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35944 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35945 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35946 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35947 .code
35948 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35949 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35950 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35951 .endd
35952 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35953 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35954 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35955 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35956 example:
35957 .code
35958 4
35959 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35960 darcy@austen.fict.example
35961 rdo@foundation
35962 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35963 .endd
35964 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35965 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35966 line is of the following form:
35967 .display
35968 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35969 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35970 .endd
35971 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35972 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35973 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35974 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35975 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35976 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35977 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35978 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35979
35980
35981 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35982 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35983 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35984 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35985 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35986 following:
35987
35988 .table2 50pt
35989 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35990 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35991 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35992 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35993 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35994 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35995 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35996 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35997 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35998 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35999 .endtable
36000
36001 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36002 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36003 typical set of headers:
36004 .code
36005 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36006 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36007 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36008 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36009 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36010 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36011 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36012 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36013 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36014 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36015 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36016 .endd
36017 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36018 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36019 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36020 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36021 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36022 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36023
36024 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36025 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36026
36027 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36028 "DKIM Support"
36029 .cindex "DKIM"
36030
36031 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36032 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36033 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36034 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36035
36036 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36037 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36038
36039 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36040 .olist
36041 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36042 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
36043 .next
36044 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36045 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36046 different signature contexts.
36047 .endlist
36048
36049 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36050 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36051 Exim's standard controls.
36052
36053 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36054 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36055 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36056 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36057 .code
36058 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36059 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36060 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36061 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36062 .endd
36063 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36064 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36065 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36066 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36067 senders).
36068
36069
36070 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36071 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36072
36073 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36074 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36075
36076 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36077 MANDATORY:
36078 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36079 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36080
36081 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36082 MANDATORY:
36083 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36084 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36085 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36086 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36087
36088 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36089 MANDATORY:
36090 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36091 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36092 The result can either
36093 .ilist
36094 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36095 .next
36096 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36097 the private key.
36098 .next
36099 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36100 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36101 is set.
36102 .endlist
36103
36104 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36105 OPTIONAL:
36106 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36107 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36108 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36109 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36110
36111 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36112 OPTIONAL:
36113 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36114 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36115 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36116 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36117 variables here.
36118
36119 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36120 OPTIONAL:
36121 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36122 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36123 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36124 used.
36125
36126
36127 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36128 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36129
36130 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36131 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36132 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36133
36134 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36135 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36136 runtime of the ACL.
36137
36138 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36139 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36140 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36141 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36142
36143 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36144 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36145 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36146 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36147 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36148 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36149 it defaults as:
36150 .code
36151 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36152 .endd
36153 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36154 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36155 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36156 .code
36157 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
36158 .endd
36159 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
36160 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
36161 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
36162 .code
36163 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
36164 .endd
36165
36166 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
36167 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
36168
36169
36170 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
36171 available (from most to least important):
36172
36173
36174 .vlist
36175 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
36176 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
36177 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
36178 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
36179 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
36180 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
36181 .ilist
36182 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
36183 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36184 .next
36185 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
36186 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36187 .next
36188 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
36189 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36190 .next
36191 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
36192 .endlist
36193 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
36194 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
36195 "fail" or "invalid". One of
36196 .ilist
36197 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
36198 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
36199 .next
36200 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
36201 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
36202 .next
36203 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
36204 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
36205 means that the message body was modified in transit.
36206 .next
36207 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
36208 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
36209 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
36210 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36211 .endlist
36212 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36213 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36214 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36215 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36216 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36217 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36218 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36219 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36220 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36221 The key record selector string.
36222 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36223 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36224 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36225 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36226 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36227 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36228 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36229 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36230 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36231 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36232 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36233 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36234 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36235 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36236 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36237 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36238 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36239 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36240 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36241 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36242 integer size comparisons against this value.
36243 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36244 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36245 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36246 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36247 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
36248 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36249 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36250 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36251 in the key record.
36252 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36253 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36254 in the key record.
36255 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36256 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36257 .endlist
36258
36259 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36260
36261 .vlist
36262 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36263 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36264 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36265 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36266 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36267
36268 .code
36269 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36270 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36271 sender_domains = gmail.com
36272 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36273 dkim_status = none
36274 .endd
36275
36276 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
36277 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36278 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36279 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36280
36281 .code
36282 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36283 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36284 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36285 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36286 .endd
36287
36288 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36289 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36290 for more information of what they mean.
36291 .endlist
36292
36293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36295
36296 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36297 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36298 .cindex "adding drivers"
36299 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36300 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36301 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36302 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36303
36304 .olist
36305 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36306 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36307 .next
36308 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36309 .display
36310 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36311 .endd
36312 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36313 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36314 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36315 .next
36316 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36317 .code
36318 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36319 .endd
36320 .next
36321 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36322 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36323 .next
36324 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36325 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36326 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36327 .next
36328 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36329 &_src_&.
36330 .next
36331 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36332 as for other drivers and lookups.
36333 .endlist
36334
36335 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36336 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36337 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36338 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36339 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36340
36341 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36342 the interface that is expected.
36343
36344
36345
36346
36347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36348 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36349
36350 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36351 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36352 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36353 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36354 . processors.
36355 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36356
36357 .literal xml
36358 <?sdop
36359 format="newpage"
36360 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36361 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36362 ?>
36363 .literal off
36364
36365 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36366 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36367 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36368
36369
36370 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36371 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////